650i xDrive Convertible (2012) - Car BMW - Free user manual and instructions
Find the device manual for free 650i xDrive Convertible (2012) BMW in PDF.
User questions about 650i xDrive Convertible (2012) BMW
0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.
Ask a new question about this device
Download the instructions for your Car in PDF format for free! Find your manual 650i xDrive Convertible (2012) - BMW and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. 650i xDrive Convertible (2012) by BMW.
USER MANUAL 650i xDrive Convertible (2012) BMW
Owner's Manual for Vehicle

The Ultimate Driving Machine
Contel
A-7

natural_image
Exterior view of a modern silver convertible car with license plate (no visible text or symbols on body)650i Owner's Manual for Vehicle
Thank you for choosing a BMW.
The more familiar you are with your vehicle, the better control you will have on the road. We therefore strongly suggest:
Read this Owner's Manual before starting off in your new BMW. Also use the Integrated Owner's Manual in your vehicle. It contains important information on vehicle operation that will help you make full use of the technical features available in your BMW. The manual also contains information designed to enhance operating reliability and road safety, and to contribute to maintaining the value of your BMW.
Any updates made after the editorial deadline for the printed or integrated Owner's Manual are located in the appendix of the printed quick reference for the vehicle.
Supplementary information can be found in the additional brochures in the onboard literature.
We wish you a safe and enjoyable drive.
BMW AG
Reprinting, including excerpts, only with the written consent of BMW AG, Munich.
US English II/11, 03 11 490
Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleached without chlorine, suitable for recycling.
Contents
The fastest way to find information on a particular topic or item is by using the index, refer to page 272.
Using this Owner's Manual
6 Notes
At a glance
12 Cockpit
19 iDrive
25 Voice activation system
27 Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle
Controls
32 Opening and closing
53 Adjusting
62 Transporting children safely
65 Driving
74 Displays
84 Lamps
88 Safety
101 Driving stability control systems
106 Driving comfort
123 Climate control
128 Interior equipment
132 Storage compartments
Driving tips
138 Things to remember when driving
Navigation
146 Navigation
Entertainment
164 Tone
166 Radio
173 CD/multimedia
Communication
196 Telephone
207 Office
216 Contacts
218 BMW ConnectedDrive
Mobility
226 Refueling
228 Fuel
229 Wheels and tires
236 Engine compartment
238 Engine oil
241 Maintenance
243 Replacing components
248 Breakdown assistance
254 Care
Reference
260 Technical data
263 Short commands of the voice activation system
272 Everything from A to Z
Notes
Using this Owner's Manual
The fastest way to find information on a particular topic is by using the index.
An initial overview of the vehicle is provided in the first chapter.
Updates made after the editorial deadline
Any updates made after the editorial deadline for the Owner's Manuals are located in the appendix of the printed quick reference for the vehicle.
Additional sources of information
Should you have any questions, your service center will be glad to advise you at any time.
Information on BMW, e.g., on technology, is available on the Internet: bmwusa.com.
Symbols
Indicates precautions that must be followed precisely in order to avoid the possibility of personal injury and serious damage to the vehicle.
Marks the end of a specific item of information.
* Indicates special equipment, country-specific equipment and optional accessories, as well as equipment and functions not yet available at the time of printing.
"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions.
...< Verbal instructions to use with the voice activation system.
»...« Identifies the answers generated by the voice activation system.
Refers to measures that can be taken to help protect the environment.
Symbols on vehicle components
i Indicates that you should consult the relevant section of this Owner's Manual for information on a particular part or assembly.
Your individual vehicle
You have decided in favor of a vehicle with individualized equipment and features.
This Owner's Manual describes the entire array of options and equipment available for a specific model.
As a result, the manual may contain accessories and equipment that you may not have specified for your own vehicle.
All options and special equipment are marked with an asterisk *.
For options and equipment not described in this Owner's Manual, please refer to the Supplementary Owner's Manuals.
On right-hand drive vehicles, some controls are arranged differently than shown in the illustrations.
Status of the Owner's Manual
The manufacturer of your vehicle pursues a policy of constant development that is conceived to ensure that our vehicles continue to embody the highest quality and safety standards. In rare cases, therefore, the features described in this Owner's Manual may differ from those in your vehicle.
Updates made after the editorial deadline
Any updates made after the editorial deadline for the Owner's Manuals are located in the appendix of the printed quick reference for the vehicle.
For your own safety
Maintenance and repairs
Advanced technology, e.g., the use of modern materials and high-performance electronics, requires suitable maintenance and repair methods.
Therefore, have this work performed only by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with appropriately trained personnel.
If this work is not carried out properly, there is the danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.
Parts and Accessories
For your own safety, use genuine parts and accessories approved by BMW. When you purchase accessories tested and approved by BMW and Genuine BMW Parts, you simultaneously acquire the assurance that they have been thoroughly tested by BMW to ensure optimum performance when installed on your vehicle. BMW warrants these parts to be free from defects in material and workmanship. BMW will not accept any liability for damage resulting from installation of parts and accessories not approved by BMW. BMW cannot test every product made by other manufacturers to verify if it can be used on a BMW safely and without risk to either the vehicle, its operation, or its occupants. Genuine BMW Parts, BMW Accessories and other products approved by BMW, together with professional advice on using these items, are available from all BMW centers. Installation and operation of non-BMW approved accessories such as alarms, radios, amplifiers, radar detectors, wheels, suspension components, brake dust shields, telephones, including operation of any mobile phone from within the vehicle without using an externally mounted antenna, or transceiver equipment, for instance, CBs, walkie-talkies, ham radios or similar accessories, may cause extensive damage to the vehicle, compromise its safety, interfere with the vehicle's electrical system or affect the validity of the BMW Limited Warranty. See your BMW center for additional information. Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emission control devices and systems may be performed by any automotive repair establishment or individual using any certified automotive part.
California Proposition 65 Warning
California laws require us to state the following warning:
Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components and parts, including components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling. Used engine oil contains chemicals that have caused cancer in laboratory animals. Always protect your skin by washing thoroughly with soap and water.
Service and warranty
We recommend that you read this publication thoroughly. Your vehicle is covered by the following warranties:
▶ New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
▶ Rust Perforation Limited Warranty.
▶ Federal Emissions System Defect Warranty.
▶ Federal Emissions Performance Warranty.
▶ California Emission Control System Limited Warranty.
Detailed information about these warranties is listed in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models or in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.
Your vehicle has been specifically adapted and designed to meet the particular operating conditions and homologation requirements in your country and continental region in order to deliver the full driving pleasure while the vehicle is operated under those conditions. If you wish to op-
erate your vehicle in another country or region, you may be required to adapt your vehicle to meet different prevailing operating conditions and homologation requirements. You should also be aware of any applicable warranty limitations or exclusions for such country or region. In such case, please contact Customer Relations for further information.
Reporting safety defects
For US customers
The following only applies to vehicles owned and operated in the US.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration NHTSA, in addition to notifying BMW of North America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, Westwood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone 1-800-831-1117.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or BMW of North America, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov
For Canadian customers
Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investigations and Recalls, may telephone the toll-free hotline 1-800-333-0510. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety.

text_image
Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 606 521 - 03 11 490At a glance
These overviews of buttons, switches and displays are intended to familiarize you with your vehicle. You will also become quickly acquainted with the available control concepts and options.
Cockpit
All around the steering wheel

text_image
8 9 10 11 12 13 7 6 16 15 14 5 4 3 2 18 1 171 Opening and closing the rear window 44
2 Open and close windows together 44
3 Open and close rear windows 43
4 Open and close front windows 43
5 Exterior mirror operation 59
6 Driver assistance systems*

Active Blind Spot Detection* 98

Lane departure warning* 97

Night Vision with pedestrian detection* 118

Head-up Display* 121
7 Lamps

Front fog lamps* 87

Parking lamps 84

Low beams 84

Automatic headlamp control* 85
Daytime running lights* 85
Adaptive light control* 85
High-beam Assistant* 86
Instrument lighting 87

8 Steering column stalk, left

Turn signal 69

High beams, head-lamp flasher 69

High-beam Assistant* 86

Roadside parking lamps 85

Computer 76
9 Steering wheel buttons, left

Store speed* 106

Resume speed 107

Cruise control on/off, interrupt 106
10 Instrument cluster 14
11 Steering wheel buttons, right

Entertainment source

Volume

Voice activation* 25

Telephone* 196
12 Steering column stalk, right

Windshield wipers 69

Rain sensor* 70

Clean the windshields and head-lamps* 70
13 START/STOP the engine and switch the ignition on/off 66
14 Horn
15 Stetring wheel heating* 61
16 Adjust the steering wheel 61
17 Unlocking the hood
18 Open the trunk lid 40
Instrument cluster

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 1/2 1 km/h mph 0 358 mls 200 400 ms Time 8:35 am Miles 34235 343.4 Temp +74.0 °F 10 9 8 7 6 100 120 140 160 180 200 220 240 260 140 160 120 80 60 40 20 100 DTC PARK OFF AUTO H 1/min x 1000 M41 Fuel gauge 74
2 Speedometer
3 Indicator/warning lamps 14
4 Tachometer 75
5 Engine oil temperature 75
6 External temperature 75
7 Electronic displays 16
8 Miles, trip miles 76
9 Clock 79
10 Reset miles 76
Indicator/warning lamps
Instrument cluster

text_image
Control panel display with dual gauges and directional indicators, showing vehicle status and speed settingsThe indicator and warning lamps can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.
Several of the lamps are checked for proper functioning when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on, and light up briefly in the process.
Overview: indicator/warning lamps
Symbol Function or system

Turn signal

Parking brake

Parking brake in Canadian models

Automatic Hold*

Front fog lamps*
Symbol Function or system

High beams

High-beam Assistant*

Parking lamps, headlamp control

Cruise control*

Lane departure warning*

DSC Dynamic Stability Control

DSC Dynamic Stability Control or DTC Dynamic Traction Control

Tire Pressure Monitor* Flat Tire Monitor

Safety belts

Airbag system

Steering system
Symbol Function or system

Emissions

Brake system

Brake system in Canadian models

Antilock Brake System ABS

Antilock Brake System ABS in Canadian models
Text messages
Text messages in combination with a symbol in the instrument cluster explain a Check Control message and the meaning of the indicator and warning lamps.
Supplementary text messages
Additional information on the Control Display, e.g., on the cause of a malfunction or the required action, can be called up via Check Control, refer to page 82.
The text of urgent messages is displayed automatically.
Instrument cluster, electronic displays

text_image
1/min x 1000 1/min x 1000 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 801 Symbols and messages, e.g., warnings 14
5 Selection list, e.g., radio 76
2 Range 74
6 Transmission displays 73
3 Computer 76
4 Navigation display* 146
Service display 81
All around the center console

text_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with numbered component labels pointing to various parts such as airbags, infotainment, and control switches.1 All around the interior rearview mirror 18
2 Control Display 19
3 Glove compartment 132
4 Air vent 126
5 Hazard warning system 248


Central locking system 39
6 Radio 166
CD/multimedia 173
7 Automatic climate control 123
8 Controller with buttons 19
9 Parking brake 67


Automatic Hold* 67
10 Opening and closing the convertible top 46
11 PDC Park Distance Control* 107
Top View* 112
Backup camera* 110
Parking assistant* 115
Side View* 114

12 Dynamic Driving Control* 103


DSC Dynamic Stability Control 101
13 Transmission selector lever
All around the interior rearview mirror

text_image
1 2 3 2 SOS PASS AR BAG OFF 41 Emergency Request* 248 SOS
2 Reading lamps* 87
3 Interior lamps 87
4 Indicator lamp, front passenger airbag* 90
iDrive
The concept
TheiDrive combines the functions of a multitude of switches. Thus, these functions can be operated from a central location.

Using the iDrive during a trip
To avoid becoming distracted and posing an unnecessary hazard to your vehicle's occupants and to other road users, never attempt to use the controls or enter information unless traffic and road conditions allow this.
Controls at a glance
Controls

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)1 Control Display
2 Controller with buttons
The buttons can be used to open the menus directly. The controller can be used to select menu items and create the settings.
Control Display
Notes
To clean the Control Display, follow the care instructions.
Do not place objects close to the Control Display; otherwise, the Control Display can be damaged.
Switching off

Press the button.
- "Switch off control display"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display Profile settings Display Owner's Manual Reset current profile Rename current profileSwitching on
Press the controller again to switch the screen back on.
Controller
Select menu items and create settings.
- Turn.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical knob with directional arrows indicating rotation or movement (no text or symbols)- Press.

natural_image
Close-up of a black mechanical knob with a white arrow pointing downward, mounted on a gray surface (no text or symbols visible)3. Move in four directions.

natural_image
Close-up of a black rotary knob with directional arrows indicating rotation or movement (no text or symbols)Buttons on controller
Press the button Function
MENU Open the main menu.
RADIO Opens the Radio menu.
CD Opens the CD/Multimedia menu.
NAV Opens the Navigation map view.
TEL Opens the Telephone menu.
BACK Displays the previous panel.
OPTION Opens the Options menu.
Operating concept
Opening the main menu

Press the button.

text_image
Main menu CD/Multimedia Radio Telephone Navigation Office ConnectedDrive Vehicle Info SettingsThe main menu is displayed.
All iDrive functions can be called up via the main menu.
Selecting menu items
Menu items shown in white can be selected.
- Turn the controller until the desired menu item is highlighted.

text_image
Main menu CD/Multimedia Radio Telephone Navigation Office ConnectedDrive Vehicle Info Settings- Press the controller.
Menu items in the Owner's Manual
In the Owner's Manual, menu items that can be selected are set in quotation marks, e.g., "Settings".
Changing between panels
After a menu item is selected, e.g., "Radio", a new panel is displayed. Panels can overlap.
▶ Move the controller to the left.
The current panel is closed and the previous panel is displayed.
The previous panel is opened again by pressing the BACK button. In this case, the current panel is not closed.
▶ Move the controller to the right.
A new panel is opened on top of the previous display.

text_image
FM Manual CARIVARI ENERGY GONG96.3 KLASSIK 100.0 MHz 101.3 MHzWhite arrows pointing to the left or right indicate that additional panels can be opened.
View of an opened menu
When a menu is opened, it generally opens with the panel that was last selected in that menu. To display the first panel of a menu:
▶ Move the controller to the left repeatedly until the first panel is displayed.
▶ Press the menu button on the controller twice.
Opening the Options menu

Press the button.
The "Options" menu is displayed.

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display FM Display Owner's Manual HD Radio Reception RDS RadioAdditional options: move the controller to the right repeatedly until the "Options" menu is displayed.
Options menu
The "Options" menu consists of various areas:
▶ Screen settings, e.g., "Split screen".
This area remains unchanged.
▶ Control options for the selected main menu, e.g., for "Radio".
▶ If applicable, further operating options for the selected menu, e.g., "Store station".
Changing settings
-
Select a field.
-
Turn the controller until the desired setting is displayed.

text_image
Volume settings Speed volume Volume setting: PDC Gong- Press the controller.
Activating/deactivating the functions
Several menu items are preceded by a checkbox. It indicates whether the function is activated or deactivated. Selecting the menu item activates or deactivates the function.

The function is activated.

The function is deactivated.
Example: setting the clock
Setting the clock

- Turn the controller until "Settings" is highlighted, and then press the controller.

text_image
Main menu CD/Multimedia Radio Telephone Navigation Office ConnectedDrive Vehicle Info Settings-
If necessary, move the controller to the left to display "Time/Date".
-
Turn the controller until "Time/Date" is highlighted, and then press the controller.

text_image
Settings ✓ Time/Date Language/Units Tone Speed Climate Lighting Door locks- Turn the controller until "Time:" is highlighted, and then press the controller.

text_image
Time/Date Time: 09:30 Format: 24 h Date: 27.05.2012 Format: tt.mm.jjjj- Turn the controller to set the hours and press the controller.
- Turn the controller to set the minutes and press the controller.
Status information
Status field
The following information is displayed in the status field at the top right:
Time.
▶ Current entertainment source.
▶ Sound output, on/off.
▶ Wireless network reception strength.
▶ Telephone status.
▶ Traffic bulletin reception*.
Status field symbols
The symbols are grouped as follows.
Radio symbols
Symbol Meaning
T Traffic bulletins* are switched on.
HD HD Radio™* is switched on.
Satellite radio* is switched on.
Telephone symbols
Symbol Meaning
Incoming or outgoing call*.
Missed call*.
... Wireless network reception strength* Symbol flashes: searching for network.
Wireless network is not available*.
Bluetooth* is switched on.
▲ Roaming* is active.
Text message* was received.
Check the SIM card*.
SIM card* is blocked.
SIM card* is missing.
Enter the PIN*.
Entertainment symbols
Symbol Meaning
CD/DVD* player.
Music collection*.
gracenote Gracenote® database*.
AUX-IN port.
USB audio interface*.
Mobile phone audio interface*.
Additional symbols
Symbol Meaning

Spoken instructions* are switched off.

Request of the current vehicle position*.
Split screen\*
General information
Additional information can be displayed on the right side of the split screen, e.g., information from the computer.
In the divided screen view, the so-called split screen, this information remains visible even when you change to another menu.
Switching the split screen on and off
- OPTION Press the button.
- "Split screen"
Selecting the display
- OPTION Press the button.
- "Split screen"
- Move the controller until the split screen is selected.
- Press the controller or select "Split screen content".
- Select the desired menu item.

text_image
Split screen content ✓ Split screen Map facing north Map direction of travel Map view with perspective Position ✓ Onboard info Trip computerProgrammable memory buttons
General information
The iDrive functions can be stored on the programmable memory buttons and called up directly, e.g., radio stations, navigation destinations, phone numbers and entry points into the menu.
The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
Saving a function
-
Highlight the function via the iDrive.
-
1...8 Press the desired button for more than 2 seconds.
Running a function
1...8 Press the button. The function will run immediately. This means, for example, that the number is dialed when a phone number is selected.
Displaying the button assignment
Use a finger to touch the buttons. Do not wear gloves or use objects.
The key assignment is displayed at the top edge of the screen.

text_image
CD/Multimedia Radio Telephone Navigation ConnectedDrive Vehicle Info SettingsTo display short information: touch the button.
To display detailed information: touch the button for an extended period.
Deleting the button assignments
- Press buttons 1 and 8 simultaneously for approx. five seconds.
- "OK"
Entering letters and numbers
- Turn the controller: select letters or numbers.
- Select additional letters or numbers if needed.
- "OK": confirm the entry.
Symbol Function

Press the controller: delete the letter or number.

Press the controller for an extended period: delete all letters or numbers.

Enter a blank space.
Switching between letters and numbers
Depending on the menu, you can switch between entering letters and numbers:
Symbol Function

Enter the letters.

Enter the numbers.
Switching between upper and lower case letters
Depending on the menu, you can switch between entering upper and lower case letters:
Symbol Function

above the controller up: switch from upper to lower case letters.

ABc move the controller up: switch from lower to upper case letters.
Entry comparison
Entry of names and addresses: the selection is narrowed down every time a letter is entered and letters may be added automatically.
The entries are continuously compared to the data stored in the vehicle.
▶ Only those letters are offered during the entry for which data is available.
Destination search: town/city names can be entered using the spelling of language available on the Control Display.
Voice activation system\*
The concept
The voice activation system can be used to operate functions by means of spoken commands.
▶ Most menu items on the Control Display can be voiced as commands. The system prompts you to make your entries.
▶ Functions that can only be used when the vehicle is stationary cannot be operated using the voice activation system.
The system uses a special microphone on the driver's side.
▶ ...« Verbal instructions in the Owner's Manual to use with the voice activation system.
Requirements
Via the Control Display, set a language that is also supported by the voice activation system so that the spoken commands can be identified. Set the language, refer to page 80.
Using voice activation
Activating the voice activation system

Press the button on the steering
-
Wait for the signal.
-
Say the command.
The command is displayed in the instrument cluster.
This symbol in the instrument cluster indicates that the voice activation system is active.
If no other commands are available, continue operating the function via iDrive.
Terminating the voice activation system
Briefly press the button on the steering wheel or >Cancel.
Possible commands
Having possible commands read aloud
The commands available in each case depend on the menu item selected on the Control Display.
To have the available commands read out loud: »Voice commands«
For example, if the "Settings" menu is displayed, the commands for the settings are read out loud.
Help dialog for the voice activation system
Calling up help dialog: »Help«
Additional commands for the help dialog:
▶ Help with examples: information about the current operating options and the most important commands for them are announced.
▶ Help with voice activation: information about the principle of operation for the voice activation system is announced.
Executing functions using short commands
Functions on the main menu can be performed directly by means of short commands, irrespective of which menu item is currently selected, e.g., >Vehicle status.
List of short commands of the voice activation system, refer to page 263.
Example: playing back a CD
- Switch on the Entertainment sound output if necessary.

-
Press the button on the steering wheel.
-
C D and multimedia
The medium last played is played back.

-
P is the button on the steering wheel.
-
C D track ...< e.g., CD track 4.
Setting the voice dialog
You can set whether the system should use the standard dialog or a shorter version.
In the shorter variant of the voice dialog, the announcements from the system are issued in an abbreviated form.
On the Control Display:
- "Settings"
- "Language/Units"
- "Speech mode:"
- Select the setting.

text_image
Speech mode ✓ Default ShortAdjusting the volume
Turn the volume button while giving an instruction until the desired volume is set.
The volume remains constant even if the volume of other audio sources is changed.
The volume is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Notes on Emergency Requests
Do not use the voice activation system to initiate an Emergency Request. In stressful situations, the voice and vocal pitch can change. This can unnecessarily delay the establishment of a telephone connection.
Instead, use the SOS button*, refer to page 248, in the vicinity of the interior mirror.
Environmental conditions
▷ Say the commands, numbers, and letters smoothly and with normal volume, emphasis, and speed.
▶ Always say commands in the language of the voice activation system.
When selecting a radio station, use the common pronunciation of the station name.
▷ Keep the doors, windows, and convertible top closed to prevent noise interference.
▶ Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.
Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle
The integrated Owner's Manual can be displayed on the Control Display. The equipment and functions that are in the vehicle are described therein.
Components of the integrated Owner's Manual
The integrated Owner's Manual consists of three parts, which offer various levels of information or access possibilities.
Quick Reference Guide
Located in the Quick Reference is important information for the operation of the vehicle, the operation of basic vehicle functions or for what to do in the event of a flat tire. This information can also be displayed during driving.
Search by pictures
Information and descriptions based on illustrations can be searched via search by pictures. This is helpful, for example, if the description of an outfitting package that cannot be named is needed.
Owner's Manual
Information and descriptions can be searched by direct entry of a search term via the index.
Select components

Press the button.
-
Turn the controller: open "Vehicle Info".
-
Press the controller.
-
Selecting desired range:
▶ "Quick reference"
▶ "Search by pictures"
▶ "Owner's Manual"

text_image
Vehicle Info Quick reference Search by pictures ✓ Owner's Manual Onboard info Trip computer Vehicle statusLeafing through the Owner's Manual
Page by page with link access
Turn the controller until the next or previous page is displayed.
Page by page without link access
Leaf through the pages directly while skipping the links.
Highlight the symbol once. Now simply press the controller to leaf from page to page.

Leaf back.

Leaf forward.
Context help - Owner's Manual to the temporarily selected function
The relevant information can be opened directly.
Opening during operation via iDrive
To move directly from the application on the Control Display to the options menu:

- Press the button or move the controller to the right repeatedly until the "Options" menu is displayed.
- "Display Owner's Manual"
Opening when a Check Control message is displayed
Directly from the Check Control message on the Control Display:
"Display Owner's Manual"
Changing between a function and the Owner's Manual
To change from a function, e.g., radio, to the Owner's Manual on the Control Display and to switch between the two displays:

-
☐ Press the button or move the controller to the right repeatedly until the "Options" menu is displayed.
-
"Display Owner's Manual"
-
Select the desired page in the Owner's Manual.

- ☐ Press the button again to return to the function displayed last.

- BACK Press the button to return to the page of the Owner's Manual displayed last.
To switch back and forth repeatedly between the function displayed last and the page of the Owner's Manual displayed last, repeat steps 4 and 5. This opens a new panel every time.
Programmable memory buttons
General information
The Owner's Manual can be stored on the programmable memory buttons and called up directly.
Storing
- Select "Owner's Manual" via the iDrive.

- Press the desired button for more than 2 seconds.
Executing


Press the button.
The Owner's Manual is displayed immediately.

text_image
START STOP ENGINE Online Edition for Part no. 01:40 2 606 521 - 03:11:490Controls
This chapter is intended to provide you with information that will give you complete control of your vehicle. All features and accessories that are useful for driving and your safety, comfort and convenience are described here.
Opening and closing
Remote control/key
Buttons on the remote control

text_image
1 2 3 41 Unlocking
2 Locking
3 Trunk lid
4 Panic mode*, headlamp courtesy delay feature
General information
The vehicle is supplied with two remote controls with keys.
Every remote control contains a replaceable battery.
The settings called up and implemented when the vehicle is unlocked depend on which remote control is used to unlock the vehicle, Personal Profile, refer to page 33.
In addition, information about service requirements is stored in the remote control, Service data in the remote control, refer to page 241.
Integrated key

natural_image
Diagram of a car door handle with two labeled parts (1 and 2), showing internal components without any text or symbols.Press the button on the back of the remote control, arrow 1, and pull out the key, arrow 2.
The integrated key fits the following locks:
▶ Driver's door.
Storage compartment in the center armrest.
The storage compartment contains a switch for the hotel function, refer to page 39.
Replacing the battery

text_image
Diagram of a car door handle with numbered parts indicating internal components- Take the integrated key out of the remote control.
- Push in the catch with the key, arrow 1.
- Remove the cover of the battery compartment; see arrow 2.
- Insert a battery of the same type with the positive side facing upwards.
- Press the cover closed.

Take the used battery to a recycling center or to your service center.
New remote controls
You can obtain new remote controls from your service center.
Loss of the remote controls
Lost remote controls can be blocked by your service center.
Emergency detection of remote control
It is possible to switch on the ignition or start the engine in situations such as the following:
▶ Interference of radio transmission to remote control by external sources.
▶ Discharged battery in the remote control.
A Check Control message is displayed if an attempt is made to switch on the ignition or start the engine.
Starting the engine in case of emergency detection of remote control

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seatbelt and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)Automatic transmission: if a corresponding Check Control message appears, hold the remote control, as shown, against the marked area on the steering column and press the Start/Stop button within 10 seconds while pressing the brake.
Manual transmission: if a corresponding Check Control message appears, hold the remote control, as shown, against the marked area on the steering column and press the Start/Stop button within 10 seconds while pressing the clutch.
Personal Profile
The concept
Personal Profile concept
You can set several of your vehicle's functions to suit your personal needs and preferences.
The settings are automatically saved in the profile currently activated.
When the vehicle is unlocked, the profile that was last detected and called up with the remote control is used.
Your personal settings will be recognized and called up again even if the vehicle has been used in the meantime by someone else with another remote control.
The individual settings are stored for three Personal Profiles and one guest profile.
Transmitting the settings
Your personal settings can be taken with you to another vehicle equipped with the Personal Profile function. For more information, contact your service center.
Transmission takes place via:
The USB interface*, refer to page 132, in the glove compartment onto a USB device.
Profile management
Opening the profiles
A different profile can be called up than the one associated with the remote control currently in use.
-
"Settings"
-
"Profiles"

text_image
Settings Tone Speed Climate Lighting Door locks ✓ Profiles Allow rear control- Select a profile.
The profile that is opened is assigned to the remote control currently in use.
Renaming profiles
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
The current profile is selected.
- Open "Options".
- "Rename current profile"

text_image
Options ✓ Split screen Switch off control display Profile settings Display Owner's Manual Reset current profile Rename current profile ✓ Display user list at startupResetting profiles
The settings of the active profile are reset to their default values.
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
The current profile is selected.
- Open "Options".
- "Reset current profile"
Importing profiles
Existing settings and contacts are overwritten with the imported profile.
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
- "Import profile"

text_image
Profiles Import profile Export profile Guest- USB interface, refer to page 132: "USB device"
Exporting profiles
Most settings of the active profile and the saved contacts can be exported.
This can be useful for storing and opening personal settings, for instance if settings are accidentally changed or deleted.
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
- "Export profile"
- USB interface, refer to page 132: "USB device"
Using the guest profile
The guest profile can be used to make individual settings without affecting the three Personal Profiles.
This can be useful for drivers who are using the vehicle temporarily and do not have their own profile.
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
- The current profile is selected.
- Open "Guest".
- Create the settings.
Note: the guest profile cannot be renamed.
Display profile list during start
The profile list can be displayed during each start for selecting the desired profile.
- "Settings"
- "Profiles"
- Open "Options".
- "Display user list at startup"
Personal Profile settings
The following functions and settings can be stored in a profile.
More information on the settings can be found under:
▶ Exterior mirror position, refer to page 59.
CD/Multimedia, refer to page 173: audio source listened to last.
▷ Dynamic Driving Control: sport program, refer to page 104.
▶ Driver's seat position, refer to page 37: automatic retrieval after unlocking.
Programmable memory buttons, refer to page 23: assignment.
▶ Head-up Display, refer to page 121: selection, brightness and position of the display.
▶ Headlamp courtesy delay feature, refer to page 84: time setting.
▶ Tone, refer to page 164: tone settings.
▶ Automatic climate control, refer to page 123: settings.
▶ Steering wheel position, refer to page 60.
▶ Navigation, refer to page 146: map views, route criteria, voice output on/off.
Night Vision with pedestrian detection, refer to page 118: selection of functions and type of display.
Daytime running lights*, refer to page 85: current setting.
▶ Park Distance Control PDC, refer to page 165: adjusting the signal tone volume.
▷ Radio, refer to page 166: stored stations, station listened to last, special settings.
▶ Backup camera, refer to page 110: selection of functions and type of display.
▶ Side View, refer to page 114: selection of the display type.
▷ Language on the Control Display, refer to page 80.
▶ Lane departure warning, refer to page 97: last setting, on/off.
Active Blind Spot Detection, refer to page 98: last setting, on/off.
▶ Triple turn signal activation, refer to page 69.
▶ Locking the vehicle, refer to page 39: after a brief period or after starting to drive.
Central locking system
The concept
The central locking system becomes active when the driver's door is closed.
The system simultaneously engages and releases the locks on the following:
▶ Doors.
▶ Compartment in the center armrest.
Trunk lid.
▶ Fuel filler flap.
Operating from the outside
▶ Via the remote control.
▶ Via the driver's door lock*.
▶ Via the door handles*.
▶ Via the button in the trunk lid*.
The following takes place simultaneously when locking/unlocking the vehicle via the remote control:
Anti-theft protection is switched on/off. Doors cannot be unlocked using the lock buttons or the door opener.
The welcome lamps, interior lamps and courtesy lamps* are switched on and off.
The alarm system*, refer to page 42, is armed or disarmed.
Operating from the inside

natural_image
Top-down view of a car air intake console with control panel and driver (no visible text or symbols)Via the button for the central locking system.
If the vehicle has been locked from inside, the fuel filler flap and the compartment in the center armrest remain unlocked.
If an accident of a certain severity occurs, the central locking system unlocks automatically.
The hazard warning system and interior lamps come on.
Opening and closing: from the outside
Using the remote control
General information

Take the remote control with you
People or animals left unattended in a parked vehicle can lock the doors from the inside. Always take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that the vehicle can then be opened from the outside.
Unlocking

Press the button.
The vehicle is unlocked.
You can set how the vehicle is to be unlocked.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
- "Settings"
- "Door locks"
3. "Unlock button:"

text_image
Door locks Unlock button: All doors □ Last seat position auto. □ Lock if no door is opened □ Lock after start. to drive □ Acoustic sig. lock/unlock □ Flash when lock/unlock4. Select the desired function:
▶ "Driver's door only"
Only the driver's door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. Pressing again unlocks the entire vehicle.
▶ "All doors"
The entire vehicle is unlocked.
Convenient opening

Press and hold the button on the remote control.
The side windows and the rear window are fully opened.
With Comfort Access*, the remote control can be used to open the convertible top when in the vicinity of the vehicle.

Press and hold the button on the remote control until the convertible top is
fully opened and the convertible top well storage cover is fully closed.

Danger of pinching
Monitor the opening process to ensure that no one becomes trapped; otherwise, injuries may result.
Releasing the button stops the motion.
Leaving the vicinity of the vehicle stops the motion of the convertible top.
After a short period, the convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are lowered slowly. The convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are not locked. Press the button again until the convertible top operation is completed.
Locking

Press the button on the remote control.

Do not lock from the outside
Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if there are people in it, as the vehicle cannot be unlocked from inside without special knowledge.
Convenient closing\*
With Comfort Access*, the remote control can be used to close the convertible top, the side windows, and the rear window when in the vicinity of the vehicle.

Hold down the remote control button until the closing operation is completed.
The convertible top, the side windows, and the rear window close.

Monitor the closing process
Monitor the closing process to ensure that no one becomes trapped.
Releasing the button or leaving the vicinity of the vehicle stops the motion.
After a short period, the convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are lowered slowly. The convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are not locked. Press the button again until the convertible top operation is completed.
Switching on the interior lamps, courtesy lamps\*, and welcome lamps

Press the button on the remote control with the vehicle locked.
Panic mode\*
You can trigger the alarm system if you find yourself in a dangerous situation.

Press the button on the remote control for at least 3 seconds.
To switch off the alarm: press any button.
Switching on the headlamp courtesy delay feature

Briefly press the button on the remote control.
The duration can be set in the Control Display.
Opening the trunk lid

Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second and release.
The trunk lid opens, regardless of whether it was previously locked or unlocked.
In some vehicle equipment variants, the trunk lid can only be opened using the remote control if the vehicle was unlocked first.
To avoid locking yourself out of the vehicle, do not place the remote control into the cargo area. The trunk lid is locked again as soon as it is pushed closed.
Confirmation signals from the vehicle
-
"Settings"
-
"Door locks"
-
Deactivate or activate the desired confirmation signals.
▶ "Acoustic sig. lock/unlock"
▶ "Flash when lock/unlock"

text_image
Door locks Unlock button: All doors □ Last seat position auto. □ Lock if no door is opened □ Lock after start. to drive □ Acoustic sig. lock/unlock □ Flash when lock/unlockRetrieving the seat, mirror, and steering wheel settings
The driver's seat, exterior mirror, and steering wheel positions selected last are stored for the currently used remote control.
When the vehicle is unlocked, these positions are automatically retrieved if this function was activated.

Pinch hazard when moving back the seat If this function is used, first make sure that the footwell behind the driver's seat is empty.
Otherwise, people can be injured or objects damaged when the seat is moved back.
The adjustment procedure is interrupted:
▷ When a seat position switch is pressed.
When a button of the seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory is pressed briefly.
Activating the setting
- "Settings"
- "Door locks"
- "Last seat position auto."

text_image
Door locks Unlock button: All doors □ Last seat position auto. □ Lock if no door is opened □ Lock after start. to drive □ Acoustic sig. lock/unlock □ Flash when lock/unlockMalfunction
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or unlocked with the remote control, the battery may be discharged or there may be interference from external sources such as mobile phones, metal objects, overhead power lines, transmission towers, etc.
If this occurs, unlock or lock the vehicle at the door lock using the key.
For US owners only
The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communication Commission regulations. Operation is governed by the following:
FCC ID:
▷ LX8766S.
LX8766E.
▷ LX8CAS.
▷ LX8CAS2.
MYTCAS4.
Compliance statement:
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
This device may not cause harmful interference, and
- this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Using the door lock
General information

natural_image
Close-up of a car door clip with a small circular button on the side (no text or symbols visible)
Do not lock from the outside
Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if there are people in it, as the vehicle cannot be unlocked from inside without special knowledge.

Remove the key before pulling the door handle
Before pulling the outside door handle, remove the key to avoid damaging the paintwork and the key.
In some country-specific versions, the alarm system* is triggered if the vehicle is unlocked via the door lock.
Manual operation
If an electrical malfunction occurs, lock or unlock the vehicle using a key via the door lock on the driver's door.
Locking the doors and trunk lid at once\*
In some vehicle equipment versions, only the driver's door can be locked via the door lock.
To lock all doors and the trunk lid at once:
-
With the doors closed, lock the vehicle using the button for the central locking system in the interior.
-
Unlock and open the driver's or front passenger door.
-
Lock the vehicle.
▶ Lock the driver's door using the integrated key in the door lock, or
▶ Press down the lock button of the front passenger door and close the door from the outside.
The fuel filler flap can only be locked using the remote control.
Opening and closing: from the inside

natural_image
Top-down view of a car air intake console with control panel and fan (no visible text or symbols)Unlocking and opening\*
Either unlock the doors together using the button for the central locking system and then pull the door handle above the armrest or
▶ Pull the door opener twice individually on each door: the first time unlocks the door, the second time opens it.
Locking and unlocking

Press the button in the vehicle.
The doors and the trunk lid are locked or unlocked when the doors are closed, but they are not secured against theft.
The fuel filler flap remains unlocked.
Automatic locking
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
- "Settings"
- "Door locks"
- Select the desired function:
▶ "Lock if no door is opened"
The vehicle locks automatically after a short period of time if a door is not opened.
"Lock after start. to drive"
The vehicle locks automatically after you drive away.

text_image
Door locks Unlock button: All doors □ Last seat position auto. □ Lock if no door is opened □ Lock after start. to drive □ Acoustic sig. lock/unlock □ Flash when lock/unlockHotel function
With the hotel function, the compartment in the center armrest and the trunk lid is separately latched and decoupled by the central locking system.

▶ Compartment in the center armrest and trunk lid locked, arrow 1.
▷ Compartment in the center armrest and trunk lid unlocked, arrow 2.
Slide the switch into the arrow 1 position. Therefore, the compartment in the center armrest and the trunk lid are locked and decoupled from the central locking system.
If the compartment in the center armrest is locked, it is not possible to open the trunk lid.
This is beneficial when the vehicle is parked using valet service.
Unlock or lock the compartment in the center armrest with a key.
Hand over remote control without the key.
Doors
Automatic Soft Closing\*
To close the doors, push lightly.
It is closed automatically.

Danger of pinching
Make sure that the closing path of the doors is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.
Trunk lid
Opening
During opening, the trunk lid pivots back and up.
Ensure that adequate clearance is available before opening.
Opening from the outside

natural_image
Close-up of a car's rear bumper with a white arrow pointing to the nose area (no text or symbols visible)▶ Press on the top half of the BMW emblem.
▶ Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second and release.
The trunk lid cannot be opened if the convertible top is not fully opened or closed.
Opening from the inside

Push the button in the driver's footwell.
If the vehicle is stationary, the trunk lid opens if it is not locked.
Closing

natural_image
Top-down view of a car front panel showing internal compartments and mounting points (no text or symbols visible)Recessed grips in the interior trim of the trunk lid make it easier to pull down the lid.

Danger of pinching
Make sure that the closing path of the trunk lid is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.

Do not place the remote control in the cargo area
Take the remote control with you and do not leave it in the cargo area; otherwise, the remote control may be locked inside the vehicle when the trunk lid is closed.
Locking the vehicle\*

natural_image
Black rectangular button with a white lock icon and an upward arrow pointing to a stack of books (no text or symbols)Press the button on the inside of the trunk lid. The vehicle is locked completely.
Emergency unlocking\*

natural_image
Close-up of a car front panel with a triangular warning symbol on the side (no text or labels visible)Pull the handle inside the cargo area. The trunk lid unlocks.
Comfort Access\*
The concept
The vehicle can be accessed without activating the remote control.
All you need to do is to have the remote control with you, e.g., in your jacket pocket.
The vehicle automatically detects the remote control when it is nearby or in the passenger compartment.
Comfort Access supports the following functions:
▶ Unlocking/locking of the vehicle.
▶ Convenient closing.
▶ Unlocking of the trunk lid separately.
Starting the engine.
Functional requirements
There are no external sources of interference nearby.
To lock the vehicle, the remote control must be located outside of the vehicle.
The next unlocking and locking cycle is not possible until after approx. 2 seconds.
The engine can only be started if the remote control is inside the vehicle.
Comparison with ordinary remote control
The functions can be controlled by pressing the buttons or via Comfort Access.
Unlocking

text_image
Diagram showing a car door with two directional arrows labeled 1 and 2 pointing to the interior area.Fully grasp a door handle, arrow 1. This corresponds to pressing the button.
Locking

text_image
Diagram showing a car door with labeled parts 1 and 2, indicating parts of the door.Press the area on the door handle, arrow 2, with your finger for approx. 1 second.
This corresponds to pressing the 🎨 button.
To save battery power, ensure that the ignition and all electronic systems and/or power con-
sumers are switched off before locking the vehicle.
Convenient closing
Press the area, arrow 2, with your finger and hold.
In addition to locking, the convertible top, the side windows, and the rear window close as well.
Press the area, arrow 2, and hold until the convertible top is fully closed.

Monitor the closing process
Monitor the closing process to ensure that no one becomes trapped.
Releasing the area, arrow 2, stops the motion.
After a short period, the convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are lowered slowly. The convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are not locked. Press the area, arrow 2, again until the convertible top operation is completed.
Unlocking the trunk lid separately
Press on the top half of the BMW emblem on the trunk lid.
This corresponds to pressing the 🎨 button.

Do not place the remote control in the cargo area
Take the remote control with you and do not leave it in the cargo area; otherwise, the remote control may be locked inside the vehicle when the trunk lid is closed.
Malfunction
Comfort Access may not function properly if it experiences interference from external sources such as mobile phones, metal objects, overhead power lines, transmission towers, etc.
If this occurs, open or close the vehicle using the buttons on the remote control or use a key in the door lock.
To subsequently start the engine, hold the remote control against the marked area on the steering column, refer to page 33.
Alarm system\*
The concept
The vehicle alarm system responds to:
▶ Opening of a door, the hood or the trunk lid.
▶ Movements in the vehicle: interior motion sensor, refer to page 43.
Changes in the vehicle tilt, e.g., during attempts to steal a wheel or when towing the car.
▶ Interruptions in battery voltage.
The alarm system briefly indicates tampering:
▶ By sounding an acoustic alarm.
▷ By switching on the hazard warning system.
▷ By flashing the high beams.
Arming and disarming the alarm system
General information
When you lock or unlock the vehicle, either with the remote control or at the door lock*, the alarm system is armed or disarmed at the same time.
Door lock and armed alarm system
Unlocking via the door lock will trigger the alarm on some country-specific versions.
Trunk lid and armed alarm system
The trunk lid can be opened using the remote control, even if the alarm system is armed.

Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second and release.
After the trunk lid is closed, it is locked and monitored again by the alarm system. The hazard warning system flashes once.
In some vehicle equipment variants, the trunk lid can only be opened using the remote control if the vehicle was unlocked first.
Panic mode\*

Press the button on the remote control for at least 3 seconds.
Switching off the alarm
▶ Unlock the vehicle using the remote control.
With Comfort Access: If you are carrying the remote control with you, pull on the door handle.
Indicator lamp on the interior rearview mirror

natural_image
Top-down view of a car rearview mirror with a black button and an upward arrow pointing to the lens (no text or symbols)The indicator lamp flashes briefly every 2 seconds:
The system is armed.
The indicator lamp flashes after locking:
The doors, hood or trunk lid is not closed properly, but the rest of the vehicle is secured.
After 10 seconds, the indicator lamp flashes continuously. The interior motion sensor is not active.
The indicator lamp goes out after unlocking:
The vehicle has not been tampered with.
The indicator lamp flashes after unlocking until the engine is started, but no longer than approx. 5 minutes:
An alarm has been triggered.
Tilt alarm sensor
The tilt of the vehicle is monitored.
The alarm system responds in situations such as attempts to steal a wheel or tow the car.
Interior motion sensor
The interior is monitored to the height of the seat cushions. The alarm system is armed together with the interior motion sensor even when the convertible top is open. Falling objects such as leaves can trigger the alarm unintentionally.
Avoiding unintentional alarms
The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor can be switched off together, such as in the following situations:
In automatic car washes
▷ In duplex garages.
During transport on car-carrying trains, at sea or on a trailer.
When animals are to remain in the vehicle.
Switching off the tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor

Press the button on the remote control twice in succession.
The indicator lamp lights up for approx. 2 seconds and then flashes continuously.
The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor are switched off until the vehicle is locked again.
Power windows
General information

Take the remote control with you
Take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that children, for example, cannot operate the power windows and injure themselves.

Closing the windows when driving
To close the side windows when driving, first close the rear windows or all four windows at the same time; otherwise, the windows may not close tightly at high speeds.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)Opening individually
Press the switch to the resistance point. The window opens while the switch is held.
▶ Does the switch beyond the resistance point.
The window opens automatically.
Pressing again stops the motion.
Closing individually
Danger of pinching Monitor the closing process and make sure that the closing path of the window is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.
Pull the switch to the resistance point. The window closes while the switch is held.
Pull the switch beyond the resistance point.
The window closes automatically.
Pressing the switch stops the motion.
Convenient operation, refer to page 36, via the remote control.
Convenient closing, refer to page 42, with Comfort Access*.
Opening/closing together
Press the switch to the resistance point.
All side windows open while the switch is being pressed.
Similarly, the windows close while the switch is being pulled.
Press the switch beyond the resistance point.
All side windows open automatically.
Pressing again stops the motion.
Similarly, the windows are automatically closed when the switch is pulled past the resistance point.
Rear window
Opening
▶ Is the switch to the resistance point. The rear window opens while the switch is being held.
▶ Is the switch beyond the resistance point.
The rear window opens automatically.
Pressing again stops the motion.
The rear window opens and closes automatically when the convertible top is opened or closed.
Closing
Pull the switch. The rear window closes while the switch is being held.
Pinch protection
If the closing force exceeds a specific value as a window closes, the closing action is interrupted. The window reopens slightly.
The rear window is not equipped with pinch protection.
Danger of pinching even with pinch protection
Even with the pinch protection system, check that the window's closing path is clear; other-
wise, the closing action may not stop in certain situations, e.g., if thin objects are present.

Window accessories
Do not install any accessories in the range of movement of the windows; otherwise, the pinch protection system will be impaired.
Closing without the pinch protection system

Danger of pinching
Monitor the closing process and make sure that the closing path of the window is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.
For example, if there is an external danger or if ice on the windows prevents a window from closing normally, proceed as follows:
- Pull the switch past the resistance point and hold it there.
Pinch protection is limited and the window reopens slightly if the closing force exceeds a certain value. - Pull the switch past the resistance point again within approx. 4 seconds and hold it there.
The window closes without pinch protection.
Convertible top
General information
The convertible top can be opened or closed at speeds up to approx. 25 mph/40 km/h.
If the vehicle is accelerated above a speed of approx. 30 mph/50 km/h while the convertible top is being moved, the convertible top movement stops.
Tips about the convertible top:
▶ If possible, close the convertible top when the vehicle is parked. A closed convertible top protects it from weather-related damage and to some extent from theft.
Event when the convertible top is closed, onlystore valuables in the locked cargo area.
At higher speeds, vacuum produced in the passenger compartment cause the convertible top to begin to flatten. Increase the amount of air via the automatic climate control so that no vacuum is produced in the vehicle.
Notes
The trunk lid cannot be opened if the convertible top is not fully opened or closed.

Safety information about the convertible top
With temperatures below +14 °F/-10 °C do not open the convertible top; otherwise damages could result.
Do not leave the open convertible top in the convertible top well longer than one day while the top is still wet; otherwise, damage could result due to moisture.
The convertible top pivots up during opening and closing. When the top is moved, e.g. in garages, make sure that there is a minimum height of 79 inches/2 meters; otherwise, it damages may result.
Do not place any objects on the convertible top, otherwise, they could fall and cause damage or injuries.
▶ When the rollover protection system is extended, do not under any circumstances move the convertible top.
▶ Always open or close the convertible top completely. Convertible top and convertible top well storage cover are locked in the final positions. Driving with the convertible tope or convertible top well storage cover unlocked can result in damage.
Do not reach into the convertible top mechanism during the opening and closing operation. Keep children away from the opening path of the convertible top, otherwise, there is a risk of injury.
When the convertible top is opened during driving, be alert to traffic; otherwise, it may result in an accident. If possible, do not move the convertible top while driving in reverse because rearward vision is severely impaired while the convertible top is in motion. During windy conditions, do not operate the convertible top while driving. Do not drive faster than 30 mph/50 km/h; otherwise, vehicle damage may occur.
Do not attach any roof carrier systems; otherwise, an accident may occur.
Functional requirements
The ignition or radio ready state must be switched on.
It is not possible to start the engine and operate the convertible top simultaneously. When the engine is started, the convertible top movement is briefly interrupted.
Under the following conditions, the convertible top movement cannot be moved and a Check Control message is displayed.
▶ Cargo area partition is flipped up.
▶ Trunk lid is open.
▶ External temperature is too low.
▶ Vehicle system too low.
▶ Convertible top drive is overheating.
▶ Movement of the convertible top not allowed because of national regulations.
▶ Vehicle speed is too high.
Before opening and closing
▶ Follow the safety instructions for the convertible top.
▶ Make sure that the cargo area partition in the cargo area is folded down.
▶ Make sure that the cargo does not push against the cargo area partition from below.
▶ Make sure that the trunk lid is closed.
Convertible top switch

text_image
Diagram of a car interior with labeled parts, showing numbered components and directional arrows1 Switch
2 LEDs
Opening and closing from the inside
In order to protect the battery, move the convertible top only when the engine is running if possible.
Before closing the convertible top, remove any foreign objects from the windshield frame; otherwise, closing may be prevented.
▶ Press and hold the switch. The convertible top opens while the switch is being pressed.
▶ Pull the switch and hold it. The convertible top closes while the switch is being pulled.
Push or pull switch until the convertible top is completely open or closed and the end of the procedure is indicated by a corresponding Check Control message. Always make sure that the convertible top well storage cover is completely closed. If the convertible top is completely open or closed, convertible top and convertible top well storage cover are latched.
The side windows and the rear window go down when the convertible top control switch is pulled or pushed.
LEDs
▶ Left LED lights up green: convertible top is opened or closed. If the operation is completed, the LED goes out and a corresponding Check Control message is displayed.
Right LED flashes red after the switch is released: operating sequence has not yet concluded.
Right LED comes on red when the switch is pulled: cargo area partition is flipped up, trunk lid is not closed or there is a malfunction. Convertible top cannot be moved.
In addition to the red LED, a check control message is displayed.
Interruption

Always open/close the convertible top completely
A convertible top that is not opened or closed completely is not locked and represents a hazard.
The convertible top movement is interrupted if the switch is released. The sequence can be continued in the desired direction using the switch.
If there is a longer interruption, convertible top and convertible top well storage cover remain approx. 10 minutes in the current position before they slowly go down. The convertible top and the convertible top well storage cover are not locked. Operate switch again until the convertible operation is terminated.
Convenient operation\* from outside
When equipped with Comfort Access* the convertible top can also be operated from outside:
▶ Convenient opening with remote operation, refer to page 36.
▶ Convenient closing with the remote control, refer to page 37.
▶ Convenient closing via the door handles, refer to page 42.
Cargo area partition

natural_image
Top-down view of a car trunk with visible structural components and directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)Fold down cargo area partition in the back so that the convertible top can be opened.
Fold down cargo area partition in the front in order to enlarge the cargo area space when the convertible top is closed.
Manually close convertible top
If there is a defect, the convertible top can be manually closed. Two persons are necessary to do this.

Do not manually open convertible top and close it manually only in emergency situa-
Do not manually open the convertible top. The convertible top well storage cover cannot latch if there is an electrical defect and would open during driving.
Manually close the convertible top only in emergency situations.
Damage can result from improper handling.
Tools
Tools for manually closing the convertible top are located in the insert of the rear seat backrest under the first aid kit.
- Remove insert, refer to page 249.
- Remove the first aid kit.
- Remove tools.

text_image
1 2 31 Convertible top tool
2 Adapter
3 Rear window tool
Before closing
- Open trunk lid, refer to page 40.
Depending on the reason for the defect, it may be the case that the trunk lid cannot be opened. Then the convertible top cannot be manually closed. - Remove the two large caps from the trim. If necessary, use a screwdriver to help with this.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car trunk opening with visible structural ribs and side-mounted sensors (no text or symbols)- Unlock convertible top well storage cover.
To do this, pull on the right cap and simultaneously slightly raise the front right convertible top well storage cover in front of the rear window.
Proceed accordingly on the left side.
- When the convertible top is closed manually, the trunk lid can no longer be opened.
Remove urgently needed items from the cargo area and close the trunk lid.
- Lower the side window and the rear window completely.
If the rear window cannot be lowered electrically, it must be lowered manually.
Manually lowering rear window
The spindle for lowering the rear window is located in front of the rear window in the center beneath the convertible top well storage cover.
- Have a second person slightly raise the convertible top well storage cover, arrow 1, and hold it.

text_image
Diagram of car interior showing labeled parts with arrows and numbered annotations- Insert the rear window tool through the funnel-shaped opening into the spindle, arrow 2. Turn the spindle clockwise, arrow 3, until the rear window is all the way down.
Lifting out convertible top

Only close the convertible top with two people
Carry out the following steps with the aid of a second person and with the doors open; otherwise, it may result in damage to the convertible top.
- Grasp the convertible top well storage cover on both sides, swing it up until it reaches its limit position and hold it in place.

natural_image
3D rendering of a car's internal components with an arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)- Remove the cover in the center of the front convertible top frame. If necessary, use a screwdriver to help with this.

natural_image
3D rendered mechanical component with an arrow indicating a feature or assembly (no visible text or symbols)- Insert the convertible top tool into the convertible top lock. Turn the convertible top tool approx. one half turn clockwise to open the convertible top lock. Be careful not to damage the convertible top fabric. Remove the convertible top tool.

natural_image
Diagram showing a mechanical component with downward and left-pointing arrows indicating motion or force (no text or symbols)- On both sides of the vehicle, grasp the front edge of the convertible top frame with one hand. With the other hand, grasp the end of the convertible top on the bottom edge.
Keep the convertible top well storage cover open, e.g. with your shoulder.

natural_image
3D cutaway view of a car's internal battery pack showing internal compartments (no text or symbols)- Lift out the convertible top and the convertible top ends on both sides simultaneously and swing it forward. When you do this, make sure that the convertible top ends do not push against other parts.

natural_image
Diagram of a car interior showing airflow or airflow direction with arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols present)- With the cover ends placed high, close the convertible top well storage cover.

natural_image
Close-up of mechanical components with a white arrow pointing to a specific part (no visible text or symbols)- Fold down the two convertible top ends on the convertible top well storage cover.

natural_image
Diagram of a car interior showing seat, dashboard, and seatbelt with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)Lock convertible cover
-
Insert the cover tool on the front edge of the convertible top frame into the convertible top lock.
-
Turn the cover tool counterclockwise until the front convertible top frame is locked with the front windshield frame. Simultaneously, have a second person push from the outside toward the center on the front windshield frame.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)-
Insert the convertible top tool with the long end into the adapter from the tool kit.
-
In the rear, raise the inner lining of the convertible top. Place the adapter on the red-marked pin of the convertible top mechanism.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and seat area with a cable inserted (no text or symbols visible)- Push the rear convertible top end down and simultaneously have a second person push the tool all the way up to the stop.
In this way, the convertible top end is pushed against the convertible top well storage cover and locked.
Proceed accordingly on the other end of the convertible top.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing a curved black seat and directional arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)-
If possible, close the rear window electrically. The rear window cannot be manually closed.
-
Have the convertible top checked by the service center.
Wind deflector\*
The concept
The wind deflector reduces the air movement in the passenger compartment when driving with the top down.
Installation
- Remove wind deflector from the protective jacket and unfold it.

natural_image
Diagram of a winged aircraft with directional arrows indicating flight or movement (no text or symbols)- Press the upper and lower parts together until the latch engages.

natural_image
Technical diagram of a mechanical component with directional arrows indicating movement or force (no text or symbols present)- Push out the right retaining pin until the latch engages and flip out the two rear retaining pins.

natural_image
Diagram of a car's side panel with directional arrows indicating airflow or movement (no text or symbols)- Install the wind deflector on the vehicle with the right retaining pin and the two rear ones in the corresponding openings.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the front and rear seats with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)- Push the left retaining pin into the provided opening until it latches.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seat, dashboard, and seatbelt mechanism (no text or symbols visible)- Flip up the top half of the wind deflector.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seat, dashboard, and seatbelt (no text or symbols visible)
Do not tilt the front seat backrest too far back
Do not tilt the front seat backrest too far back with the wind deflector installed if the seat is to be moved all the way back. Otherwise, the wind deflector will be damaged.
Removing
Proceed in reverse sequence.
To release the two lateral retaining pins, pull the corresponding handle forward a little and them pull it to the side.
Folding up

natural_image
Diagram of a mechanical component with directional arrows indicating movement or force (no text or symbols present)On the left side, pull the handle of the retaining pin on the wind deflector all the way back and release the latch. Fold in top and bottom part.
Adjusting
Sitting safely
The ideal seating position can make a vital contribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving.
The seating position plays an important role in an accident in combination with:
▶ Safety belts, refer to page 56.
▶ Head restraints, refer to page 57.
Airbags, refer to page 88.
Seats
Adjusting
General information

Do not adjust the seat while driving
Never attempt to adjust the driver's seat while driving.
The seat could respond with unexpected movement and the ensuing loss of vehicle control could lead to an accident.

Do not incline the backrest too far to the rear
Do not incline the backrest on the front passenger side too far to the rear during driving. Otherwise, there is the danger of sliding under the safety belt in an accident. This would eliminate the protection normally provided by the belt.
The seat setting is stored for the remote control currently in use. When the vehicle is unlocked via the remote control, the position is automatically retrieved if this function, refer to page 37, was activated.
At a glance

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 81 Active seat*
2 Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory*
3 Backrest width*
4 Lumbar support*
5 Backrest, head restraint*
6 Shoulder support*
7 Forward/back, height, tilt*
8 Thigh support*
Adjustments in detail
- Forward/back.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with control panels and a central touchscreen display (no text or symbols visible)- Height.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating left and right movement (no text or symbols)- Seat tilt.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with control panels and a rotary knob (no text or symbols visible)- Backrest tilt.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with control buttons and a vehicle icon (no text or symbols)Thigh support\*
Multifunctional seat*

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with control panels and directional arrows (no text or symbols)Adjust the position using the lever.
Lumbar support\*
The curvature of the seat backrest can be adjusted in such a way that it supports the lumbar region of the spine. The lower back and the spine are supported for upright posture.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's front panel with buttons and a cursor arrow (no text or symbols)▶ Press the front/rear section of the switch. The curvature is increased/decreased.
▶ Press the upper/lower section of the switch. The curvature is shifted up/down.
Backrest width\*

natural_image
Interior view of a car air conditioner control panel with buttons and a white arrow pointing to the right side (no text or symbols)Change the width of the backrest using the side wings to adjust the lateral support.
To make it easier to enter and exit the vehicle, the backrest width temporarily opens fully.
Shoulder support\*

natural_image
Top-down view of a car air conditioner control panel with buttons and a white arrow pointing to the interior (no text or symbols)Also supports the back in the shoulder area:
▶ Results in a relaxed seating position.
▶ Reduces strain on the shoulder muscles.
Active seat\*
Active adjustment of the seat cushion's contours reduces muscular tension and fatigue to help prevent lower back pain.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a white arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols)Press the button. The LED lights up.
Front seat heating*

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with two rotary buttons labeled 'AUTO' and 'MAX', showing no readable text or symbols beyond the function labels.Switching on

Press the button once for each temperature level.
The maximum temperature is reached when three LEDs are lit.
Switching off
Press the button longer.
The LEDs go out.
The temperature may be reduced or seat heating may be switched off entirely to save battery power.
Temperature distribution\*
The heating action in the seat cushion and back-rest can be distributed in different ways.
-
"Climate"
-
"Seat heating distribution"
-
Select the required seat.

text_image
Seat heating Driver Passenger- Turn the controller to set the temperature distribution.
Front active seat ventilation\*
The seat cushion and backrest surfaces are cooled by means of integrated fans.
The ventilation rapidly cools the seat, e.g., if the vehicle interior is overheated or for continuous cooling at high temperatures.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with two rotary buttons labeled 'AUTO' and 'MAX', showing function keys and control buttons (no readable text beyond icons)Switching on

Press the button once for each ventilation level.
The highest level is active when three LEDs are lit.
After a short time, the system automatically moves down one level in order to prevent excessive cooling.
Switching off
Press the button longer.
The LEDs go out.
Safety belts
Seats with safety belt
The vehicle has four seats, each of which is equipped with a safety belt.
Notes
Always make sure that safety belts are being worn by all occupants before driving away.
Although airbags enhance safety by providing added protection, they are not a substitute for safety belts.

One person per safety belt
Never allow more than one person to wear a single safety belt. Never allow infants or small children to ride on a passenger's lap.

Putting on the belt
Lay the belt, without twisting, snugly across the lap and shoulders, as close to the body as possible. Make sure that the belt lies low around the hips in the lap area and does not press on the abdomen. Otherwise, the belt can slip over the hips in the lap area in a frontal impact and injure the abdomen.
The safety belt must not lie across the neck, rub on sharp edges, be routed over solid or breakable objects, or be pinched.

Reduction of restraining effect
Avoid wearing clothing that prevents the belt from fitting properly, and pull the shoulder belt periodically to readjust the tension across your lap; otherwise, the retention effect of the safety belt may be reduced.
Buckling the belt

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing steering wheel and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)Make sure you hear the latch plate engage in the belt buckle.
Unbuckling the belt
- Hold the belt firmly.
- Press the red button in the belt buckle.
- Guide the belt back into its reel.
Safety belt reminder for the driver's and front passenger seat

The indicator lamp flashes or lights up and a signal sounds. Make sure that the safety belts are positioned correctly.
The safety belt reminder is active at speeds above approx. 5 mph/8 km/h. It can also be activated if objects are placed on the front passenger seat.
Damage to safety belts
In the case of strain caused by accidents or damage:
Have the safety belts, including the safety belt tensioners, replaced and have the belt anchors checked.

Checking and replacing safety belts
Have the work performed only by your service center; otherwise, it cannot be ensured that this safety feature will function properly.
Front head restraints
Correctly adjusted head restraint
A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of injury to cervical vertebrae in the event of an accident.

Adjusting the head restraint
Correctly adjust the head restraints of all occupied seats; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury in an accident.
Height
Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approximately at ear level.
Distance
Adjust the distance so that the head restraint is as close as possible to the back of the head.
Active head restraint
In the event of a rear-end collision with a certain severity, the active head restraint automatically reduces the distance from the head.

Reduced protective function
Do not use seat or head restraint covers.
Do not hang objects, e.g., clothes hangers, on the head restraints.
▶ Only attach accessories approved by BMW to the seat or head restraint.
Otherwise, the protective function of the active head restraint will be impaired and the personal safety of the occupants will be endangered.
Adjusting the height*

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating left and right movement (no text or symbols)Adjusting electrically.
Distance to the back of the head*

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seat, neck, and side panel with a black arrow pointing to a side panel (no text or symbols visible)Forward: pull.
▶ Back: press the button and push the head restraint toward the rear.
Adjusting the side extensions*

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing a black seatbelt with white directional arrows indicating left and right sides (no text or symbols)Fold forward for increased lateral support in the resting position.
Removing
The head restraints cannot be removed.
Entering the rear
Note

Folding back and locking the backrest
Before driving away, fold back and lock the backrests; otherwise, an unexpected seat movement may cause an accident.
Unlocking the backrest

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest seat and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)Pull the lever and fold the backrest forward.
Changing the seat position

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seatbelt and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)To change the entry area:
▶ Press and hold the button until the seat has moved to the desired position. Releasing the button stops the motion.
▶ Press the button briefly. The seat automatically moves to the respective end position. Pressing again stops the motion.
Folding back and locking the backrest
After entering the rear, fold the backrest back and lock it.

Press the button. The seat moves to its original position. Pressing again stops the motion.
Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory\*
General information

natural_image
Interior view of a car air conditioner control panel with buttons and dials (no text or symbols visible)Two different driver's seat, exterior mirror, and steering wheel positions can be stored and retrieved for each remote control. The adjustment of the lumbar support is not stored.
Storing
- Switch on the ignition.
- Set the desired position.

Press the button. The LED in the lights up.
3. Press the button. The LED in the button lights up.
4. Press the desired button 1 or 2. The LED goes out.
If the M button is pressed accidentally:

Press the button again.
The LED goes out.
Calling up settings

Do not retrieve the memory while driving
Do not retrieve the memory setting while driving, as an unexpected movement of the seat or steering wheel could result in an accident.
Comfort function
- Open the driver's door.
- Switch off the ignition.
- Briefly press the desired button 1 or 2.
The corresponding seat position is performed automatically.
The procedure stops when a switch for adjusting the seat or one of the buttons is pressed.
Safety mode
- Close the driver's door or switch on the ignition.
- Press and hold the desired button 1 or 2 until the adjustment procedure is completed.
Calling up of a seat position deactivated
After a brief period, the calling up of stored seat positions is deactivated to save battery power.
To reactivate calling up of a seat position:
▶ Open or close the door or trunk lid.
▶ Press a button on the remote control.
▶ Press the Start/Stop button.
Mirrors
Exterior mirrors
At a glance

text_image
Diagram of a car control panel with labeled buttons and a central knob1 Adjusting
2 Left/right, Automatic Curb Monitor*
3 Fold in and out*
General information
Themirror on the passenger side is more curved than the driver's side mirror.

Estimating distances correctly
Objects reflected in the mirror are closer than they appear. Do not estimate the distance to the traffic behind you based on what you see in the mirror, as this will increase your risk of an accident.
The mirror setting is stored for the remote control currently in use. When the vehicle is unlocked via the remote control, the position is automatically retrieved if the setting for this function is active.
Selecting a mirror

To change over to the other mirror: Slide the mirror changeover switch.
Adjusting electrically

The setting corresponds to the direction in which the button is pressed.
Storing positions\*
Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory, refer to page 58.
Adjusting manually
If an electrical malfunction occurs, for example, press the edges of the mirror glass.
Automatic Curb Monitor\*
When the reverse gear is engaged, the mirror glass tilts downward slightly on the front passenger side. This improves your view of the curb and other low-lying obstacles when parking, for example.
Activating
Slide the mirror changeover switch river's side mirror position.
2. Engage transmission position R.

Deactivating
Slide the mirror changeover switch to the passenger's side mirror position.
Fold in and out\*

Press the button.
Possible up to approx. 15 mph/20 km/h.
For example, this is advantageous
In car washes.
In narrow streets.
For folding back mirrors that were folded away manually.
Mirrors that were folded in are folded out automatically at a speed of approx. 25 mph/40 km/h.

Fold in the mirror in a car wash
Before entering an automatic car wash, fold in the exterior mirrors by hand or with the button; otherwise, they could be damaged, depending on the width of the vehicle.
Automatic heating
Both exterior mirrors are automatically heated whenever the engine is running.
Automatic dimming feature
Both exterior mirrors are automatically dimmed. Photocells are used for control in the Interior rear view mirror, refer to page 60.
Interior rearview mirror
Reducing the blinding effect

natural_image
Top-down view of a car head with a black sensor and white tape (no text or symbols)From behind when driving at night: turn the knob.
Interior rearview mirror, automatic dimming feature\*

natural_image
Two grayscale images showing a car rearview mirror with directional arrows indicating top and side views (no text or symbols)Photocells are used for control:
In the mirror glass.
On the back of the mirror.
For proper operation:
▷ Keep the photocells clean.
Do not cover the area between the inside rearview mirror and the windshield.
Steering wheel
General information

Do not adjust while driving
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving; otherwise, an unexpected movement could result in an accident.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control switches and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)Adjusting

natural_image
Top-down view of a vehicle's center with directional arrows indicating movement or flow (no text or symbols)The steering wheel can be adjusted in four directions.
Storing the position
Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory, refer to page 58.
Assistance getting in and out
The steering wheel temporarily moves into the highest position to make it easier to enter and exit the vehicle.
Steering wheel heating\*
Switching on/off

Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
Transporting children safely
The right place for children
Note

Children in the vehicle
Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle; otherwise, they could endanger themselves and other persons, e.g., by opening the doors.
Children should always be in the rear
Accident research shows that the safest place for children is in the back seat.

Transporting children in the rear
Only transport children younger than
13 years of age or shorter than 5 ft/150 cm in the rear in child restraint fixing systems provided in accordance with the age, weight and size of the child; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury in an accident.
Children 13 years of age or older must wear a safety belt as soon as a suitable child restraint fixing system can no longer be used, due to their age, weight and size.
Children on the front passenger seat
Should it ever be necessary to use a child restraint fixing system in the front passenger seat, make sure that the front, knee and side airbags on the front passenger side are deactivated. Automatic deactivation of front passenger airbags, refer to page 89.

Deactivating the front passenger airbags
If a child restraint fixing system is used in the front passenger seat, the front passenger airbags must be deactivated; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury to the child when the airbags are triggered, even with a child restraint fixing system.
Installing child restraint fixing systems
Notes

Manufacturer's information for child re- straint fixing systems
To select, mount and use child restraint fixing systems, observe the information provided by the system manufacturer; otherwise, the protective effect can be impaired.
On the front passenger seat
After installing a child restraint fixing system in the front passenger seat, make sure that the front, knee and side airbags on the front passenger side are deactivated.
Deactivate the front passenger airbags automatically, refer to page 89.

Deactivating the front passenger airbags
If a child restraint fixing system is used in the front passenger seat, the front passenger airbags must be deactivated; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury to the child when the airbags are triggered, even with a child restraint fixing system.
Seat position and height
Before installing a child restraint fixing system, move the front passenger seat as far back as possible and adjust its height to the highest position to obtain the best possible position for the belt and to offer optimal protection in the event of an accident.
Do not change the seat position and height after this.
Backrest width\*
Before installing a child restraint fixing system in the front passenger seat, open the backrest width completely. Do not change the backrest
width again and do not call up a memory position.

Backrest width for the child seat Before installing a child restraint fixing system in the front passenger seat, the backrest width must be opened completely. Do not change the adjustment after this; otherwise, the stability of the child seat will be reduced.
Child seat security

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with visible seat and seat outlines (no text or symbols)The rear safety belts and the front passenger safety belt can be locked against pulling out for mounting the child restraint fixing systems.
Locking the safety belt
- Pull out the belt webbing completely.
- Secure the child restraint fixing system with the belt.
- Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in and pull it taut against the child restraint fixing system. The safety belt is locked.
Unlocking the safety belt
- Unbuckle the belt buckle.
- Remove the child restraint fixing system.
- Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in completely.
LATCH child restraint fixing system
LATCH: Lower Anchors and Tether for CHil- dren.
Note

Manufacturer's information for LATCH child restraint fixing systems To mount and use the LATCH child restraint fixing systems, observe the operating and safety information from the system manufacturer; otherwise, the level of protection may be reduced.
Mounts for the lower LATCH anchors

Correctly engage the lower LATCH anchors
Make sure that the lower LATCH anchors have properly engaged and that the child restraint fixing system is resting snugly against the back-rest; otherwise, the degree of protection offered may be reduced.
Before mounting the LATCH child restraint fixing system, pull the belt away from the child restraint fixing system.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing dashboard and seat components with white arrows pointing to specific parts (no text or symbols present)Mounts for the lower LATCH anchors are located in the gap between the seat and backrest.
Mounting LATCH child restraint fixing systems
- Mount the child restraint fixing system; refer to the operating instructions of the system.
- Ensure that both LATCH anchors are properly connected.
Child restraint fixing system with a tether strap
For Canadian customers Only
The following statement is required by Transport Canada:
This vehicle is not equipped with user-ready tether anchorages. As such neither a child restraint system, nor a booster cushion, requiring the use of a tether strap can be properly secured in the vehicle.
Driving
Start/Stop button
The concept

Pressing the Start/Stop button switches the ignition on or off and starts the engine.
Automatic transmission*: the engine starts if the brake is de-
pressed when the Start/Stop button is pressed.
Manual transmission: the engine starts if the clutch is depressed when the Start/Stop button is pressed.
Ignition on
Automatic transmission*: press the Start/Stop button, and do not press on the brake pedal at the same time.
Manual-shift transmission: press the Start/Stop button, and do not press on the clutch pedal at the same time.
All vehicle systems are ready for operation.
Most of the indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster light up for varying lengths of time.
To save battery power when the engine is off, switch off the ignition and any unnecessary electronic systems/power consumers.
The ignition switches off automatically:
When the vehicle is locked, if the low beams are switched on.
▶ Shortly before the battery is discharged completely, so that the engine can still be started.
If the engine is switched off and the ignition is switched on, the system automatically switches to the radio ready state when the door is opened if the lights are switched off or the daytime running lights are switched on.
Ignition off
Automatic transmission*: press the Start/Stop button again, and do not press on the brake pedal at the same time.
Manual-shift transmission: press the Start/Stop button again, and do not press on the clutch pedal at the same time.
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
To save battery power when the engine is off, switch off the ignition and any unnecessary electronic systems/power consumers.

Transmission position P with the ignition off
When the ignition is switched off, position P is engaged automatically. When in an automatic car wash, for example, ensure that the ignition is not switched off accidentally.
When the vehicle is locked using the central locking system, the ignition switches off automatically.
Radio ready state
Activate radio ready state:
▶ When the ignition is switched off: press ON/OFF button on the radio.
▶ When the engine is running: press START/STOP button.
Some electronic systems/power consumers remain ready for operation.
Radio ready state switches off automatically:
▶ After approx. 8 minutes.
When the vehicle is locked using the central locking system.
Starting the engine
General information

Enclosed areas
Do not let the engine run in enclosed areas; otherwise, breathing of exhaust fumes may lead to loss of consciousness and death. The exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, an odorless and colorless but highly toxic gas.

Unattended vehicle
Do not leave the car unattended with the engine running; otherwise, it presents a potential source of danger.
Before leaving the car with the engine running, set the parking brake and place the transmission in position P or neutral to prevent the car from moving.

Frequent starting in quick succession
Avoid repeated futile attempts at starting the car and avoid starting the car frequently in quick succession. Otherwise, the fuel is not burned or is inadequately burned, and there is the danger of overheating and damaging the catalytic converter.
Do not wait for the engine to warm up while the vehicle remains stationary. Start driving at moderate engine speeds.
Manual transmission
Starting the engine
- Depress the brake pedal.
- Press on the clutch and shift to neutral.
- Press the Start/Stop button.
The ignition is activated automatically for a certain time and is stopped as soon as the engine starts.
Automatic transmission\*
Starting the engine
- Depress the brake pedal.
- Press the Start/Stop button.
The ignition is activated automatically for a certain time and is stopped as soon as the engine starts.
Engine stop
General information

Take the remote control with you
Take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that children, for example, cannot operate the windows and injure themselves.

Set the parking brake and further secure the vehicle as required
Set the parking brake firmly when parking; otherwise, the vehicle could roll. On steep upward and downward inclines, further secure the vehicle, for example, by turning the steering wheel in the direction of the curb.
Before driving into a car wash
In order for the vehicle to be able to roll into a car wash, heed the information regarding Washing in automatic car washes, refer to page 254.
Manual transmission
Switching off the engine
- With the vehicle at a standstill, press the Start/Stop button.
- Shift into first gear or reverse.
- Set the parking brake.
Automatic transmission\*
Switching off the engine
- Engage transmission position P with the vehicle stopped.
- Press the Start/Stop button. The engine is switched off. The radio ready state is switched on.
- Set the parking brake.
Parking brake
The concept
The parking brake is primarily intended to prevent the vehicle from rolling while parked; it brakes the rear wheels.
In cars with automatic transmission*:
The parking brake can be set manually or automatically:
▶ Manual: by pulling and pushing the switch.
▶ Automatic: by activating Automatic Hold.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a rotary knob (no text or symbols visible)Setting

Pull the switch.
The LED lights up.

The indicator lamp lights up in red. The parking brake is set.

Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadian models

Set the parking brake and further secure the vehicle as required
Set the parking brake firmly when parking; otherwise, the vehicle could roll. On steep upward and downward inclines, further secure the vehicle, for example, by turning the steering wheel in the direction of the curb.
While driving
Use while driving:
Pull the switch and hold it. The vehicle brakes hard while the button is being pulled.

The indicator lamp lights up in red, a signal sounds and the brake lamps light up.
Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadian models

If the vehicle is braked to a speed of approx. 2 mph/3 km/h, the parking brake remains set.
Releasing

Manual transmission: Press the switch while the brake or clutch is pressed.
Automatic transmission*: Press the switch while the brake is pressed or transmission position P is engaged.
The LED and indicator lamp go out.
The parking brake is released.

Take the remote control with you
Take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that children, for example, cannot release the parking brake.
Automatic Hold\*
The concept
This system assists the driver by automatically setting and releasing the brake, such as when moving in stop-and-go traffic.
The vehicle is automatically held in place when it is stationary.
On inclines, the system prevents the vehicle from rolling backward when driving away.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a circular vent (no visible text or symbols)For your safety
Under the following conditions, Automatic Hold is automatically deactivated and the parking brake is set:
The engine is switched off.
A door is opened and driver's safety belt is unbuckled.
The moving vehicle is brought to a standstill using the parking brake.

The indicator lamp switches from green to red and the letters AUTO H go out.
Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadian models

Before driving away:
▶ Release the parking brake manually.
▶ Reactivate Automatic Hold.

Leaving the vehicle with the engine running
Before leaving the vehicle with the engine running, engage position P of the automatic transmission and ensure that the parking brake is set. Otherwise, the vehicle may begin to roll.
Activating
This function can be activated when the driver's door is closed and the safety belt is fastened, or while driving.

Press the button.
The LED and the letters AUTO H light

The indicator lamp lights up.
Automatic Hold is activated.
Deactivating

Press the button again.
The LED and the letters AUTO H go out.
Automatic Hold is deactivated.
If the vehicle is being held by Automatic Hold, press on the brake pedal to deactivate it. When the parking brake, refer to page 67, is set manually, Automatic Hold is deactivated automatically.
Driving
Automatic Hold is activated: the vehicle is automatically secured against rolling when it stops.

The indicator lamp lights up in green.
Step on the accelerator pedal to drive off.

The brake is released automatically.
The indicator lamp goes out.
Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadian models

Before driving into a car wash
Deactivate Automatic Hold; otherwise, the parking brake will be set when the vehicle is stationary and the vehicle will no longer be able to roll.
Parking
The parking brake is automatically set if the engine is switched off while the vehicle is being held by Automatic Hold.

The indicator lamp changes from green to red.

The parking brake is not set if the engine is switched off while the vehicle is coasting to a halt. Automatic Hold is deactivated.
Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadian models

Take the remote control with you
Take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that children, for example, cannot release the parking brake.
Malfunction
In the event of a failure or malfunction of the parking brake, secure the vehicle against rolling using a wheel chock, for example, when leaving it.
Turn signal, high beams, headlamp flasher
Turn signal
Using turn signals

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing a car's seatbelt with directional arrows indicating left and right motion (no text or symbols)Press the lever beyond the resistance point.
To switch off manually, press the lever to the resistance point.
Unusually rapid flashing of the indicator lamp indicates that a turn signal bulb has failed.
Triple turn signal activation
Press the lever to the resistance point.
The turn signal flashes three times.
The function can be activated or deactivated:
- "Settings"
- "Lighting"
- "Triple turn signal"

text_image
Lighting Pathway light: 0 s ✓ Triple turn signal □ Daytime running lamps □ Welcome lightSignaling briefly
Press the lever to the resistance point and hold it there for as long as you want the turn signal to flash.
High beams, headlamp flasher

text_image
Diagram showing car seatbelt with numbered arrows indicating left and right movement of a key▶ High beams, arrow 1.
▶ Headlamp flasher, arrow 2.
Washer/wiper system
Switching the wipers on/off and brief wipe
Do not switch on the wipers if frozen Do not switch on the wipers if they are frozen onto the windshield; otherwise, the wiper blades and the windshield wiper motor may be damaged.
Switching on

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)Press the wiper levers up.
The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.
▶ Normal wiping speed: press up once.
The wipers switch to intermittent operation when the vehicle is stationary.
▶ Fast wiping speed: press up twice or press once beyond the resistance point.
Thewipers switch to normal speed when the vehicle is stationary.
Switching off and brief wipe

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle dashboard with a car seatbelt and directional arrow (no text or symbols)Press the wiper levers down.
The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.
▶ Brief wipe: press down once.
To switch off normal wipe: press down once.
To switch off fast wipe: press down twice.
Rain sensor
The concept
The time between wipes is controlled automatically and depends on the intensity of the rainfall.
The sensor is located on the windshield, directly in front of the interior rearview mirror.
Activating/deactivating the rain sensor

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black connector and directional arrow (no text or symbols visible)Press the button on the wiper lever.
When activated, the wipers move over the wind-shield once.
The LED in the steering column stalk lights up.

Deactivate the rain sensor in car washes
Deactivate the rain sensor when passing through an automatic car wash; otherwise, damage could be caused by undesired wiper activation.
Rain sensor sensitivity

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating movement or rotation (no text or symbols)Turn the thumbwheel.
Clean the windshield, headlamps\*

natural_image
Top-down view of a car interior showing dashboard, steering wheel, and dashboard controls (no text or symbols visible)Pull the lever.
The system sprays washer fluid on the wind-shield and activates the wipers briefly.
In addition, the headlamps are cleaned at regular intervals when the vehicle lights are switched on.

Do not use the washer system at freezing temperatures
Do not use the washers if there is any danger that the fluid will freeze on the windshield; otherwise, your vision could be obscured. For this reason, use antifreeze.
Avoid using the washer when the reservoir is empty; otherwise, you could damage the pump.
Windshield washer nozzles
The washer jets are automatically heated* whenever the ignition is switched on.
Fold-out position of the wipers
Required when changing the wiper blades or under frosty conditions, for example.
- Switch off the ignition.
- Under frosty conditions, ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen onto the wind-shield.
- Press the wiper lever up beyond the point of resistance and hold it for approx. 3 seconds, until the wiper remains in a nearly vertical position.
After the wipers are folded back down, the wiper system must be reactivated.

Fold the wipers back down
Before switching the ignition on, fold the
wipers back down to the windshield; otherwise, the wipers may become damaged when they are switched on.
- Switch on the ignition.
- Press the wiper levers down. The wipers move to their resting position and are ready for operation.
Washer fluid
General information

Antifreeze for washer fluid
Antifreeze is flammable. Therefore, keep
it away from sources of ignition.
Only keep it in the closed original container and inaccessible to children.
Follow the instructions on the container.
Washer fluid reservoir

Adding washer fluid
Only add washer fluid when the engine is cool, and then close the cover completely to avoid contact between the washer fluid and hot engine parts.
Otherwise, there is the danger of fire and a risk to personal safety if the fluid is spilled.

natural_image
Close-up of a car engine bay with a white arrow pointing to a key component (no visible text or symbols)All washer nozzles are supplied from one reservoir.
Fill with water and – if required – with a washer antifreeze, according to the manufacturer's recommendations.
Mix the washer fluid before adding to maintain the correct mixing ratio.
Capacity
Approx. 5.3 US quarts/ 5 liters
Manual transmission
Shifting

Shifting into 5th or 6th gear
When shifting into 5th or 6th gear, push the gearshift lever to the right; otherwise inadvertent shifting into the 3rd or 4th gear could lead to engine damage.
Reverse gear
Select only when the vehicle is stationary. When the gearshift lever is pressed to the left, a slight resistance needs to be overcome.
Automatic transmission with Steptronic\*
Transmission positions
D Drive, automatic position
Position for normal vehicle operation. All forward gears are available.
R is Reverse
Select only when the vehicle is stationary.
N is Neutral
Use in automatic car washes, for example. The vehicle can roll.
When the ignition is switched off, refer to page 65, position P is engaged automatically.
P Park
Select only when the vehicle is stationary. The drive wheels are blocked.
P is engaged automatically:
▶ After the engine is switched off, if the car is in radio ready state, refer to page 65, or if the ignition is switched off, refer to page 65, and if position R or D is engaged.
▶ If the ignition is switched off and position N is engaged.
If the safety belt is unbuckled, the driver's door is opened, and the brake pedal is not pressed while the vehicle is stationary and transmission position R or D is engaged.
Kickdown
Kickdown is used to achieve maximum driving performance. Press on the accelerator beyond the resistance point at the full throttle position.
Engaging the transmission position
▶ Transmission position P can only be disengaged if the engine is running and the brake pedal is pressed.
▶ With the vehicle stationary, press on the brake pedal before shifting out of P or N;
otherwise, the shift command will not be executed: shift lock.

Depress the brake until you start driving
To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a driving position, maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.
Engaging D, R and N

text_image
R N Z DBriefly push the selector lever in the desired direction, beyond a resistance point if necessary. After releasing the selector lever, it returns to its center position.

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever with a white arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols visible)Press the Unlock button to:
Engage R.
▶ Shift out of P.
Engaging P

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever with a white arrow pointing to the handle (no text or symbols visible)Press button P.
Sport program and manual mode M/S
Activating the sport program

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no text or symbols visible)Push the selector lever to the left out of transmission position D.
DS is displayed in the instrument cluster.
This position is recommended for a performance-oriented driving style.
Activating the M/S manual mode
Push the selector lever to the left out of transmission position D.
Push the selector lever forward or backward.
Manual mode becomes active and the gear is changed.
The engaged gear is displayed in the instrument cluster, e.g., M1.
To shift down: press the selector lever forward.
To shift up: press the selector lever backward.
The transmission only shifts up or down if the rpm and vehicle speed are appropriate. If the
engine speed is too high, the transmission does not shift down.
The selected gear is briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, followed by the current gear.
Ending the sport program/manual mode
Push the selector lever to the right.
D is displayed in the instrument cluster.
Shift paddles for Sport automatic transmission\*

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with BMW logo and directional arrows indicating steering wheel (no text or symbols)The shift paddles on the steering wheel allow you to shift gears quickly while keeping both hands on the steering wheel.
If the shift paddles on the steering wheel are used to shift gears in automatic mode, the transmission temporarily switches to manual mode.
If the shift paddles are not used and the vehicle is not accelerated for a certain time, the system switches back into automatic mode if the selector lever is in D.
▶ Shift up: pull right shift paddle.
▶ Shift down: pull left shift paddle.
The vehicle only shifts up or down at appropriate engine and road speeds, e.g., it does not shift down if the engine speed is too high.
The selected gear is briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, followed by the current gear.
Displays in the instrument cluster

The transmission position is displayed, for instance, P.
Displays
Instrument cluster
At a glance

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 1/2 1 0 mph 0 km/h 160 120 100 80 100 120 140 160 120 180 200 220 240 260 20 140 DTC PARK OFF AUTO H 1/min x 1000 M4 Time_ 8:35 am 9 Miles_ 34235 343.4 8 7 Temp_ +74.0 °F 10 9 8 61 Fuel gauge
2 Speedometer
3 Indicator/warning lamps
4 Tachometer
5 Oil temperature
6 External temperature
7 Electronic displays
8 Miles, trip miles
9 Clock
10 Display/reset miles
Fuel gauge

The vehicle inclination may cause the display to vary. Notes on refueling, refer to page 226.
Range

After the reserve range is reached:
▶ A Check Control message is displayed briefly.
The remaining range is shown on the computer.
When a dynamic driving style is used, such as when corners are taken rapidly, engine functions are not ensured.
The Check Control message appears continuously below a range of approx. 30 miles/50 km.

Refuel promptly
Refuel no later than at a range 30 miles/
50 km, or engine functions are not ensured and damage may occur.
Displaying the cruising range
- "Settings"
- "Info display"
- "Additional indicators"

text_image
Info display ✓ Additional indicators ✓ Range ✓ Distance to destination ✓ Arrival time ✓ Average consumption ✓ Average speed ✓ DateThe range is displayed in the instrument cluster.
Tachometer

text_image
1/min x 1000Always avoid engine speeds in the red warning field. In this range, the fuel supply is interrupted to protect the engine.
Engine oil temperature

▶ Cold engine: the pointer is at the low temperature end. Drive at moderate engine and vehicle speeds.
Normal operating temperature: the pointer is in the middle or in the left half of the temperature display.
Hot engine: the pointer is at the high temperature end. A Check Control message is displayed in addition.
Coolant temperature
Should the coolant, and with it the engine, become too hot, a Check Control message is displayed.
Check the coolant level, refer to page 239.
External temperature
External temperature warning

If the display drops to +37 °F/+3 °C, a signal sounds.
A Check Control message is displayed.
There is the increased danger of
Ice on roads Even at tom
Even at temperatures above +37 °F/+3 °C, there can be a risk of ice on roads.
Therefore, drive carefully on bridges and shady roads, for example, to avoid the increased danger of an accident.
Current fuel consumption

Displays the current fuel consumption. You can check whether you are currently driving in an efficient and environmentally-friendly manner.
Displaying the current fuel consumption
- "Settings"
- "Info display"
- "Additional indicators"

text_image
Info display ✓ Additional indicators ✓ Range ✓ Distance to destination ✓ Arrival time ✓ Average consumption ✓ Average speed ✓ DateThe bar display for the current fuel consumption is displayed in the instrument cluster.
Energy recovery

The energy of motion of the vehicle is converted to electrical energy while coasting. The vehicle battery is partially charged and fuel consumption can be lowered.
Odometer and trip odometer

▶ Odometer, arrow 1.
▶ Trip odometer, arrow 2.
Display/reset miles

Press the knob.
When the ignition is switched off, the time, external temperature and odometer are displayed.
▶ When the ignition is switched on, the trip odometer is reset.
Time

The time is displayed at the bottom of the instrument cluster.
Setting the time and time format, refer to page 79.
Date

The date is displayed in the instrument cluster.
Setting the date and date format, refer to page 80.
Selection lists in the instrument cluster
The concept

text_image
No One But You ✓ Rock'n Roll Boy Shine A LightThe following can be operated using the buttons and the thumbwheel on the steering wheel:
▶ Current audio source.
▶ Redial on telephone*.
▶ Activation of the voice activation system*.
Activating a list and creating the setting

natural_image
Close-up of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating movement or control buttons (no text or symbols visible)Press a button on the right side of the steering wheel or turn the thumbwheel to activate the required list.
Create the setting using the thumbwheel.
Computer
Indication in the info display

The information from the computer is shown in the Info display in the instrument cluster.
Calling up information on the info display

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the left side of the dashboard with a car seatbelt switch and a white arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols visible)Press the computer button on the turn signal lever.
Information is displayed on the info display of the instrument cluster.
Information at a glance
Repeatedly pressing the button on the turn signal lever calls up the following information on the info display:
▷ Range.
▶ Average fuel consumption.
▷ Average speed.
Date*.
Time of arrival*
When destination guidance is activated in the navigation system.
Distance to destination*
When destination guidance is activated in the navigation system.
▶ Arrow view of navigation system*
When destination guidance is activated in the navigation system.
Adjusting the info display
You can select what information from the computer is to be displayed on the info display of the instrument cluster.
- "Settings"
-
"Info display"
-
Select the desired displays.

text_image
Info display ✓ Additional indicators ✓ Range ✓ Distance to destination ✓ Arrival time ✓ Average consumption ✓ Average speed ✓ DateInformation in detail
Range
Displays the estimated cruising range available with the remaining fuel.
It is calculated based on your driving style over the last 20 miles/30 km. If there is only enough fuel left for less than 45 miles/80 km, the color of the display changes.
Average fuel consumption
This is calculated for the period during which the engine is running.
The average fuel consumption is calculated on the basis of various distances.
Average speed
Periods in which the vehicle is parked with the engine stopped do not enter into the calculation.
Resetting average values
Press and hold the computer button on the turn signal lever.
Distance to destination\*
The distance remaining to the destination is displayed if a destination is entered in the navigation system* before the trip is started.
The distance to the destination is adopted automatically.
Time of arrival\*

The estimated time of arrival is displayed if a destination is entered in the navigation system* before the trip is started.
The time must be correctly set.
Speed limit
Display of a speed limit which, when reached, should cause a warning to be issued.
Renewed warning if the vehicle speed drops below the set speed limit once by at least 3 mph/5 km/h.
Displaying, setting or changing the limit
- "Settings"
- "Speed"
- "Warning at:"

text_image
Speed Warning at: 6 km/h Warning Select current speed- Turn the controller until the desired limit is displayed.
- Press the controller.
The speed limit is stored.
Activating/deactivating the limit
- "Settings"
- "Speed"
- "Warning"
- Press the controller.
Applying your current speed as the limit
- "Settings"
-
"Speed"
-
"Select current speed"
- Press the controller.
The current vehicle speed is stored as the limit.
Resetting values
The average fuel consumption and average speed can be reset.
Press and hold the computer button on the turn signal lever.
Trip computer
There are two types of computer.
▶ "Onboard info": the values can be reset as often as necessary.
▶ "Trip computer": the values provide an overview of the current trip.
Resetting the trip computer
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Trip computer"
- "Reset": all values are reset.
"Automatically reset": all values are reset approx. 4 hours after the vehicle comes to a standstill.

text_image
Trip computer 17:26 Depart. 1:54 std Duration 118 km Distance 12.4 l/100 km Cons. 65.2 km/h Speed ResetDisplay on the Control Display
Display the computer or trip computer on the Control Display.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Onboard info" or "Trip computer"
Resetting the fuel consumption or speed
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Onboard info"
- "Cons." or "Speed"

text_image
Onboard info 535 km Range 342 km To dest. 02:45 Arrival 16.5 l/100 km Cons. 70.9 km/h Speed- "Yes"
Gear shift indicator\*
The concept
Thesystem recommends the most fuel efficient gear in the current driving situation.
Indicators to shift up or down are displayed in the instrument cluster.
Displays

text_image
1 2 3 31 Fuel efficient gear is engaged
2 Shift up to fuel efficient gear
3 Shift down to fuel efficient gear
Settings on the Control Display
Time
Setting the time zone\*
- "Settings"
- "Time/Date"
- "Time zone"
- Select the desired time zone.
The time zone is stored.
Setting the time
- "Settings"
- "Time/Date"
- "Time:"

text_image
Time/Date Time: 09:30 Format: 24 h Date: 27.05.2012 Format: tt.mm.jjjj- Turn the controller until the desired hours are displayed.
- Press the controller.
- Turn the controller until the desired minutes are displayed.
- Press the controller.
The time is stored.
Setting the time format
- "Settings"
- "Time/Date"
- "Format:"
- Select the desired format.
The time format is stored.
Date
Setting the date
- "Settings"
- "Time/Date"
- "Date:"
- Turn the controller until the desired day is displayed.
- Press the controller.
- Make the necessary settings for the month and year.
The date is stored.
Setting the date format
- "Settings"
- "Time/Date"
- "Format:"
- Select the desired format.

text_image
Date format ✓ dd.mm.yyyy mm/dd/yyyyThe date format is stored.
Language
Setting the language
To set the language on the Control Display:
- "Settings"
- "Language/Units"
3. "Language:"

text_image
Language/Units Language: Deutsch Speech mode: Default Consumption: l/100 km Distance: km Temperature: °C4. Select the desired language.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Setting the voice dialog\*
Voice dialog for the voice activation system*, refer to page 26.
Units of measure
Setting the units of measure
To set the units for fuel consumption, route/distance and temperature:
- "Settings"
- "Language/Units"
- Select the desired menu item.

text_image
Language/Units Language: Deutsch Speech mode: Default Consumption: l/100 km Distance: km Temperature: °C4. Select the desired unit.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Brightness
Setting the brightness
To set the brightness of the Control Display:
- "Settings"
- "Control display"
- "Brightness"

text_image
Control display Brightness Display driving settings- Turn the controller until the desired brightness is set.
- Press the controller.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Depending on the light conditions, the brightness control may not be clearly visible.
Service requirements
Display

The driving distance or the time to the next service is displayed briefly after the ignition is switched on.
The current service require-
ments can be read out from the remote control by the service specialist.
Data regarding the maintenance status or legally mandated inspections of the vehicle are automatically transmitted to your service center before a service due date, Automatic Service Request, refer to page 218.
Detailed information on service requirements
More information on the scope of service required can be displayed on the Control Display.
- "Vehicle Info"
-
"Vehicle status"
-
"Service required"
Required maintenance procedures and legally mandated inspections are displayed. - Select an entry to call up detailed information.
Symbols
Symbols Description

No service is currently required.

The deadline for service or a legally mandated inspection is approaching. Please make a service appointment.

The service deadline has already passed.
Entering appointment dates
Enter the dates for the required inspections.
Ensure that the vehicle date and time are set correctly.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- "Service required"
- "§ Vehicle inspection"
- "Date:"
- Create the settings.
- Confirm.
The entered date is stored.
Automatic Service Request\*
Data regarding the maintenance status or legally mandated inspections of the vehicle are automatically transmitted to your service center before a service due date.
You can check when your service center was notified.
- "Vehicle Info"
-
"Vehicle status"
-
Open "Options".
- "Last Service Request"
Check Control
The concept
The Check Control system monitors functions in the vehicle and notifies you of malfunctions in the monitored systems.
A Check Control message is displayed as a combination of indicator or warning lamps and text messages in the instrument cluster and in the Head-up Display*.
In addition, an acoustic signal may be output and a text message may appear on the Control Display.
Indicator/warning lamps

text_image
Car dashboard display showing two gauges with Chinese function labels and numerical readingsThe indicator and warning lamps can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.
Several of the lamps are checked for proper functioning and light up temporarily when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on.
Text messages
Text messages in combination with a symbol in the instrument cluster explain a Check Control message and the meaning of the indicator and warning lamps.
Supplementary text messages
Addition information, such as on the cause of a fault or the required action, can be called up via Check Control. The supplementary text of urgent messages is displayed automatically. It is shown on the Control Display.
Symbols
Depending on the Check Control message, the following functions can be selected.
"Owner's Manual"
Display additional information about the Check Control message in the integrated owner's manual.
"Service request"
Contact the service partner.
"Roadside Assistance"
Contact Roadside Assistance.
Hiding Check Control messages

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the left side of the door and seatbelt, with a hand adjusting a key (no visible text or symbols)Press the computer button on the turn signal lever.
Some Check Control messages are displayed continuously and are not cleared until the malfunction is eliminated. If several malfunctions occur at once, the messages are displayed consecutively.
These messages can be hidden for approx. 8 seconds. After this time, they are displayed again automatically.
Other Check Control messages are hidden automatically after approx. 20 seconds. They are stored and can be displayed again later.
Displaying stored Check Control messages
-
"Vehicle Info"
-
"Vehicle status"
-
"Check Control"
- Select the text message.
Messages after trip completion
Malfunctions indicated during a trip are displayed again after the ignition is switched off.
Lamps
At a glance

text_image
2 1 3 4 5 6 0 71 Rear fog lamps*
2 Front fog lamps*
3 Automatic headlamp control / adaptive light control* / high-beam assistant* / welcome lamps / daytime running lights*
4 Lamps off / daytime running lights*
5 Parking lamps / daytime running lights*
6 Low beams / welcome lamps / high-beam assistant*
7 Instrument lighting
Parking lamps/low beams, headlamp control
Parking lamps
Switch position ☑☐☐: the vehicle lamps light up on all sides, e.g., for parking.
Do not use the parking lamps for extended periods; otherwise, the battery may become discharged and it would then be impossible to start the engine.
When parking, it is preferable to switch on the one-sided roadside parking lamps, refer to page 85.
Low beams
Switch position 📋D with the ignition switched on: the low beams light up.
Welcome lamps
When parking the vehicle, leave the switch in position ☐ or : the parking and interior lamps light up briefly when the vehicle is unlocked.
Activating/deactivating
- "Settings"
- "Lighting"
- "Welcome light"

text_image
Lighting Pathway light: 0 s □ Triple turn signal □ Daytime running lamps ✓ Welcome lightThe setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Headlamp courtesy delay feature
The low beams stay lit for a short while after the ignition is switched off, if the lamps are switched off and the headlamp flasher is switched on.
Setting the duration
- "Settings"
- "Lighting"
- "Pathway light.: s"

text_image
Lighting Pathway light.: 0 s Triple turn signal Daytime running lamps Welcome light- Set the duration.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Automatic headlamp control
Switchposition ☐: the low beams are switched on and off automatically, e.g., in tunnels, in twilight or if there is precipitation. The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
A blue sky with the sun low on the horizon can cause the lights to be switched on.
The low beams always stay on when the fog lamps are switched on.

Personal responsibility
The automatic headlamp control cannot serve as a substitute for your personal judgment in determining when the lamps should be switched on in response to ambient lighting conditions.
For example, the sensors are unable to detect fog or hazy weather. To avoid safety risks, you should always switch on the lamps manually under these conditions.
Daytime running lights\*
With the ignition switched on, the daytime running lights light up in position 0, ∃D or □A After the ignition is switched off, the parking lamps light up in position ∃D.
Roadside parking lamps

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a central touchscreen switch and directional arrows indicating left and right motion (no text or symbols)The vehicle can be illuminated on one side.
Switching on
With the ignition switched off, press the lever either up or down past the resistance point for approx. 2 seconds.
Switching off
Briefly press the lever to the resistance point in the opposite direction.
Adaptive light control\*
The concept
Adaptive light control is a variable headlamp control system that enables dynamic illumination of the road surface.
Depending on the steering angle and other parameters, the light from the headlamp follows the course of the road.
In tight curves, e.g., on mountainous roads or when turning, an additional, corner-illuminating lamp is switched on that lights up the inside of the curve when the vehicle is moving below a certain speed.
Controls
Activating
Switch position 📋 with the ignition switched on.
The turning lamps are automatically switched on depending on the steering angle or the use of turn signals.
To avoid blinding oncoming traffic, the adaptive light control directs light towards the front passenger side when the vehicle is at a standstill.
When driving in reverse, only the turning lamp is active.
Self-leveling headlights
The self-leveling headlights feature adapts the light distribution to the contours of the road.
The light distribution is lowered on hilltops to avoid blinding oncoming traffic and tilted in depressions to increase visibility.
Malfunction
A Check Control message is displayed.
Adaptive light control is malfunctioning or has failed. Have the system checked as soon as possible.
High-beam Assistant\*
The concept
When the low beams are switched on, this system automatically switches the high beams on and off. The procedure is controlled by a sensor on the front of the interior rearview mirror. The assistant ensures that the high beams are switched on whenever the traffic situation allows. The driver can intervene at any time and switch the high beams on and off as usual.
Activating the High-beam Assistant

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black key inserted into the seat, showing no visible text or symbols.- Turn the light switch to

- Press the button on the turn signal lever, arrow.

The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
When the lights are switched on, the high beams are switched on and off automatically.
The system responds to light from oncoming traffic and traffic driving ahead of you, and to adequate illumination, e.g., in towns and cities.
Switching the high beams on and off manually

text_image
Diagram showing car seatbelt insertion mechanism with numbered arrows indicating left and right movement▶ High beams on, arrow 1.
▶ High beams off/headlamp flasher, arrow 2.
To reactivate the High-beam Assistant, press the button on the turn signal lever.
System limits

Personal responsibility
The high-beam assistant cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment of when to use the high beams. Therefore, manually switch off the high beams in situations where this is required to avoid a safety risk.
The system is not fully functional in situations such as the following, and driver intervention may be necessary:
In very unfavorable weather conditions, such as fog or heavy precipitation.
In detecting poorly-lit road users, such as pedestrians, cyclists, horseback riders and wagons; when driving close to train or ship traffic; and at animal crossings.
In tight curves, on hilltops or in depressions, in cross traffic or half-obscured oncoming traffic on freeways.
In poorly-lit towns and cities and in the presence of highly reflective signs.
▶ At low speeds.
When the windshield in front of the interior rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or covered with stickers, etc.
Camera

natural_image
Top-down view of a car showing the rearview and dashboard with an arrow pointing to the wheel (no text or symbols present)The camera is located on the front of the interior rearview mirror.
Keep the area in front of the interior rearview mirror clear.
Fog lamps
Front fog lamps\*
The parking lamps or low beams must be switched on.

Press the button. The green indicator lamp lights up.
If the automatic headlamp control, refer to page 85, is activated, the low beams will come on automatically when you switch on the front fog lamps.
Instrument lighting
Adjusting

The parking lamps or low beams must be switched on to adjust the brightness.
Adjust the brightness using the thumbwheel.
Interior lamps
General information
The interior lamps, footwell lamps, entry lamps and courtesy lamps are controlled automatically.
The brightness of some of these lamps is influenced by the thumbwheel for the instrument lighting.

text_image
2 1 21 Interior lamps
2 Reading lamp
Switching the interior lamps on and off

Press the button.
To switch off permanently: press the button for approx. 3 seconds.
To clear this setting: press the button.
Reading lamps

Press the button.
Safety
Airbags

text_image
Technical diagram of a car interior with numbered components for identification1 Front airbag, driver
2 Front airbag, front passenger
3 Side airbag
4 Knee airbags
Front airbags
Front airbags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which safety belts alone cannot provide adequate restraint.
Side airbags
In a lateral impact, the side airbag supports the side of the body in the chest, lap, and head area.
Knee airbag
The knee airbag supports the legs in a frontal impact.
Protective action
Airbags are not triggered in every impact situation, e.g., in less severe accidents or rear-end collisions.
Information on how to ensure the optimal protective effect of the airbags
▷ Keep at a distance from the airbags.
▶ Always grasp the steering wheel on the steering wheel rim, holding your hands at the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions, to keep the danger of injury to your hands or arms as low as possible if the airbag is triggered.
There should be no people, animals, or objects between an airbag and a person.
Do not use the cover of the front airbag on the front passenger side as a storage area.
Keep the dashboard and window on the front passenger side clear, i.e., do not cover with adhesive labels or coverings, and do not attach holders such as for navigation instruments and mobile phones.
▶ Make sure that the front passenger is sitting correctly, i.e., keeps his or her feet and legs in the footwell; otherwise, leg injuries can occur if the front airbag is triggered.
Do not place slip covers, seat cushions or other objects on the front passenger seat that are not approved specifically for seats with integrated side airbags.
Do not hang pieces of clothing, such as jackets, over the backrests.
▶ Make sure that occupants keep their heads away from the side airbag; otherwise, injuries can occur if the airbags are deployed.
Do not remove the airbag restraint system.
Do not remove the steering wheel.
Do not apply adhesive materials to the airbag cover panels, cover them or modify them in any way.
▶ Never modify either the individual components or the wiring in the airbag system. This also applies to steering wheel covers, the dashboard, and the seats.
Even when all instructions are followed closely, injury from contact with the airbags cannot be ruled out in certain situations.
The ignition and inflation noise may lead to short-term and, in most cases, temporary hearing impairment in sensitive individuals.

In the case of a malfunction, deactivation and after triggering of the airbags
Do not touch the individual components immediately after the system has been triggered; otherwise, there is the danger of burns.
Only have the airbags checked, repaired or dismantled and the airbag generator scrapped by your service center or a workshop that has the necessary authorization for handling explosives.
Non-professional attempts to service the system could lead to failure in an emergency or undesired triggering of the airbag, either of which could result in injury.
Warnings and information on the airbags are also found on the sun visors.
Functional readiness of the airbag system

When the ignition is switch on, the warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up briefly and thereby indicates the operational readiness of the entire airbag system and the belt tensioner.
Airbag system malfunctioning
In radio ready state, the warning lamp does not come on.
The warning lamp lights up continuously.

When there is a malfunction, have the air-bag system checked immediately
When there is a malfunction, have the airbag system checked immediately; otherwise, there is a risk that the system does not function as expected in the event of an accident despite corresponding severity of the accident.
Automatic deactivation of the front passenger airbags
The system determines whether the front passenger seat is occupied by measuring the resistance of the human body.
The front, knee, and side airbag on the front passenger side are activated or deactivated accordingly.

Leave feet in the footwell
Make sure that the front passenger keeps his or her feet in the footwell; otherwise, the front passenger airbags may not function properly.

Child restraint fixing system in the front passenger seat
Before transporting a child on the front passenger seat, see the safety notes and instructions under Children on the front passenger seat.
Malfunction of the automatic deactivation system
When transporting older children and adults, the front passenger airbags may be deactivated in certain sitting positions. In this case, the indica-
tor lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up.
In this case, change the sitting position so that the front passenger airbags are activated and the indicator lamp goes out.
If it is not possible to activate the airbags, have the person sit in the rear.
To make sure that the occupied seat cushion can be evaluated correctly
Do not attach covers, cushions, ball mats or other items to the front passenger seat unless they are specifically recommended by the manufacturer of your vehicle.
Do not place any objects on the front passenger seat.
Do not place objects under the seat that could press against the seat from below.
Indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags

natural_image
Top-down view of a car dashboard with two circular gauges and a digital display (no visible text or symbols)The indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags indicates the operating state of the front passenger airbags.
The lamp indicates whether the airbags are activated or deactivated.

The indicator lamp lights up when a child who is properly seated in a child restraint fixing system intended for that purpose is detected on the seat or the seat is empty. The airbags on the front passenger side are not activated.
The indicator lamp does not light up when, for example, a correctly seated person of sufficient size is detected on the seat. The
airbags on the front passenger side are activated.
The system generally detects children seated in a child seat, especially in the child seats that were required by NHTSA when the vehicle was manufactured. After installing a child seat, make sure that the indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up. This indicates that the child seat has been detected and the front passenger airbags are not activated.
Strength of the driver's and front passenger airbag
The strength with which the driver's and front passenger airbags are triggered depends on the position of the driver's and front passenger seats.
To maintain the accuracy of this function over the long-term, calibrate the front seats when a corresponding message appears on the Control Display.
Calibrating the front seats
A corresponding message appears on the Control Display.
- Move the respective seat forward all the way.
- Move the respective seat forward again. It moves forward briefly.
- Readjust the seat to the desired position.
The calibration procedure is completed when the message on the Control Display disappears. If the message continues to be displayed, repeat the calibration.
If the message does not disappear after a repeat calibration, have the system checked as soon as possible.
Unobstructed area of movement Ensure that the area of movement of the seats is unobstructed to avoid personal injury or damage to objects.
Rollover protection system
The concept
The rollover protection system is activated during an accident or a critical driving situation, when there is extreme tilt with respect to the longitudinal axis or when there is loss of ground contact. The safety frames located behind the rear headrests extend within fractions of a second.
In addition to the rollover bracket integrated in the front windshield frame, the rollover protection system guarantees the required head clearance of all vehicle occupants.

Maintaining movement space
Always keep the movement space of the rollover protection system clear. Otherwise, there may be damage or injuries when the rollover protection system is triggered.
In less severe accidents, the secured safety belt and, depending on the severity of the accident, the belt tensioner and airbag restraint system provide protection.
Triggered rollover protection system

After deployment or damage
After deployment of the rollover protection system or in the event of damage, have the system checked and replaced.
Have this work performed only by your service center; otherwise, it cannot be ensured that this safety feature will function properly.

Do not move convertible top
When the rollover protection system is extended, do not move the convertible top. Otherwise, damages or injuries may result.
If the rollover protection system was not placed under any stress after an automatic triggering, it can be pushed back by hand, e.g. to close the convertible top. Three people are necessary for this.
- Push the lever to the side and hold it in this position.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing two black vehicle heads with directional arrows indicating movement or orientation (no text or symbols)- Push down the safety frame.
- Release lever.
- Hold down the safety frame.
- Proceed likewise with the second safety frame.
- Close the convertible top

In the event of malfunctions, deactivation or after deployment
Only have the airbags checked, repaired or dismantled and the system scrapped by your service center. Non-professional attempts to service the system could lead to failure in an emergency or undesired triggering of the airbag, either of which could result in injury.
Malfunction

A Check Control message is displayed when there is a malfunction.
Tire Pressure Monitor TPM\*
The concept
The tire inflation pressure is measured in the four mounted tires. The system notifies you if there is a significant loss of pressure in one or more tires.
Functional requirements
The system must have been reset when the inflation pressure was correct; otherwise, reliable signaling of a flat tire is not ensured. Always use wheels with TPM electronics to ensure that the
system will operate properly. Reset the system after each correction of the tire inflation pressure and after every tire or wheel change.
System limits

Sudden tire damage
Sudden serious tire damage caused by external influences cannot be indicated in advance.
The system does not operate correctly if it has not been reset. For example, a flat tire may be indicated despite correct tire inflation pressures.
The system is inactive and cannot indicate a flat tire:
- For a mounted wheel without TPM electronics.
▶ When the TPM is disturbed by other systems or devices with the same radio frequency.
Status display
The current status of the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM can be displayed on the Control Display, e.g., whether or not the TPM is active.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- (!) "Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM"
The status is displayed.
Status display
The tire and system status is indicated by the color of the tires.
A change in the tire inflation pressure during driving is taken into account.
A correction is only necessary if this is indicated by the TPM
Wheels, green
The tire inflation pressure is equal to the target state.
One wheel is yellow
A flat tire or major drop in inflation pressure in the indicated tire.
All wheels are yellow
▶ A flat tire or major drop in inflation pressure in several tires.
The system was not reset after a wheel change and thus warns based on the inflation pressures initialized last.
▶ A flat tire in one or more tires while the system is being reset.
Wheels, gray
The system cannot detect a flat tire. Reasons for this may be:
▷ TPM is being reset.
▶ Disturbance by systems or devices with the same radio frequency.
Malfunction.
For Canadian models: additional information
The status display additionally shows the current tire inflation pressures and tire temperatures.
When correcting the tire inflation pressures, note the following:
The tire pressure increases as the tire temperature increases.
Therefore, only correct the tire inflation pressure when the tire is at the ambient temperature. Compare the displayed tire temperature with the external temperature in the instrument cluster.
Resetting the system
Reset the system after each correction of the tire inflation pressure and after every tire or wheel change.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
-
(!) "Reset"
-
Start the engine - do not drive away.
- Reset the tire pressure using "Reset".
- Drive away.
The tires are shown in gray and "Resetting TPM..." is displayed.
After driving for a few minutes, the set tire inflation pressures are applied as set values. The resetting process is completed automatically during driving. The tires are shown in green and "TPM active" is shown on the Control Display.
The trip can be interrupted at any time. If you drive away again, the process resumes automatically.
If a flat tire is detected during a reset, all tires are displayed in yellow.
Low tire pressure message

The yellow warning lamp lights up. A Check Control message is displayed.
There is a flat tire or a major loss in tire inflation pressure.
The system was not reset after a wheel change and thus warns based on the inflation pressures initialized last.
- Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
- Check whether the vehicle is fitted with regular tires* or run-flat tires*.
Run-flat tires, refer to page 234, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the tire sidewall.
When a low inflation pressure is indicated, DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on if necessary.
Actions in the event of a flat tire
Normal tires\*
- Identify the damaged tire.
Do this by checking the air pressure in all four tires.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not
have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
If an identification is not possible, please contact the service center.
- Rectify the flat tire.
Use of tire sealant, e.g., the Mobility System, may damage the TPM wheel electronics. In this case, have the electronics checked at the next opportunity and have them replaced if necessary.
Run-flat tires\*
You can continue driving with a damaged tire at speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Do not continue driving without run-flat tires
Do not continue driving if the vehicle is not equipped with run-flat tires; continued driving may result in serious accidents.
Continued driving with a flat tire
If continuing to drive with a damaged tire:
- Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
- Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
- Check the air pressure in all four tires at the next opportunity.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
Possible driving distance with complete loss of tire inflation pressure:
The possible driving distance after a loss of tire inflation pressure depends on the cargo load and the driving style and conditions.
For a vehicle containing an average load, the possible driving distance is approx. 50 miles/80 km.
When the vehicle is driven with a damaged tire, its handling characteristics change, e.g., reduced lane stability during braking, a longer braking distance, and altered self-steering properties. Adjust your driving style accordingly. Avoid abrupt steering maneuvers or driving over obstacles, e.g., curbs, potholes, etc.
Because the possible driving distance depends on how the vehicle is used during the trip, the actual distance may be smaller or greater depending on the driving speed, road conditions, external temperature, cargo load, etc.

Continued driving with a flat tire
Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
A loss of tire inflation pressure results in a change in the handling characteristics, e.g., reduced lane stability during braking, a longer braking distance and altered self-steering properties.

Final tire failure
Vibrations or loud noises while driving can indicate the final failure of the tire. Reduce speed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tire could come loose and cause an accident. Do not continue driving, and contact your service center.
Message when the system was not reset
A Check Control message is displayed.
The system detected a wheel change but was not reset.
Warnings regarding the current tire inflation pressure are not reliable.
Check the tire inflation pressure and reset the system.
Malfunction

The yellow warning lamp flashes and then lights up continuously. A Check Control message is displayed. No flat tire can be detected.
Display in the following situations:
▶ A wheel without TPM electronics is fitted: have the service center check it if necessary.
▶ Malfunction: have the system checked by your service center.
▷ TPM could not be fully reset. Reset the system again.
Disturbance by systems or devices with the same radio frequency: after leaving the area of the disturbance, the system automatically becomes active again.
Declaration according to NHTSA/FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Each tire, including the spare (if provided) should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then re-
main continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.
FTM Flat Tire Monitor\*
The concept
The system does not measure the actual inflation pressure in the tires.
It detects a pressure loss in a tire by comparing the rotational speeds of the individual wheels while moving.
In the event of a pressure loss, the diameter and therefore the rotational speed of the corresponding wheel change. This is detected and reported as a flat tire.
Functional requirements
The system must have been initialized when the tire inflation pressure was correct; otherwise, reliable signaling of a flat tire is not ensured. Initialize the system after each correction of the tire inflation pressure and after every tire or wheel change.
System limits

Sudden tire damage
Sudden serious tire damage caused by external influences cannot be indicated in advance.
A natural, even pressure loss in all four tires cannot be detected. Therefore, check the tire inflation pressure regularly.
The system could be delayed or malfunction in the following situations:
▶ When the system has not been initialized.
▶ When driving on a snowy or slippery road surface.
▶ Sporty driving style: slip in the drive wheels, high lateral acceleration.
▶ When driving with snow chains*.
Status display
The current status of the Flat Tire Monitor can be displayed on the Control Display, e.g., whether or not the FTM is active.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- "E at Tire Monitor"
The status is displayed.
Initialization
The initialization process adopts the set inflation tire pressures as reference values for the detection of a flat tire. Initialization is started by confirming the inflation pressures.
Do not initialize the system when driving with snow chains*.
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- (!) "Reset"
- Start the engine - do not drive away.
- Start the initialization with "Reset".
- Drive away.
The initialization is completed while driving, which can be interrupted at any time.
The initialization automatically continues when driving resumes.
Indication of a flat tire

The yellow warning lamp lights up. A Check Control message is displayed.
There is a flat tire or a major loss in tire inflation pressure.
- Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
- Check whether the vehicle is fitted with regular tires* or run-flat tires*.
Run-flat tires, refer to page 234, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the tire sidewall.
When a flat tire is indicated, DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on if necessary.
Actions in the event of a flat tire
Normal tires\*
- Identify the damaged tire.
Do this by checking the air pressure in all four tires.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
If an identification is not possible, please contact the service center.
- Rectify the flat tire.
Run-flat tires\*
You can continue driving with a damaged tire at speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Do not continue driving without run-flat tires
Do not continue driving if the vehicle is not equipped with run-flat tires; continued driving may result in serious accidents.
Continued driving with a flat tire
If continuing to drive with a damaged tire:
- Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
- Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
- Check the air pressure in all four tires at the next opportunity.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have
been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.
Possible driving distance with complete loss of tire inflation pressure:
The possible driving distance after a loss of tire inflation pressure depends on the cargo load and the driving style and conditions.
For a vehicle containing an average load, the possible driving distance is approx. 50 miles/80 km.
When the vehicle is driven with a damaged tire, its handling characteristics change, e.g., reduced lane stability during braking, a longer braking distance, and altered self-steering properties. Adjust your driving style accordingly. Avoid abrupt steering maneuvers or driving over obstacles, e.g., curbs, potholes, etc.
Because the possible driving distance depends on how the vehicle is used during the trip, the actual distance may be smaller or greater depending on the driving speed, road conditions, external temperature, cargo load, etc.

Continued driving with a flat tire
Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
A loss of tire inflation pressure results in a change in the handling characteristics, e.g., reduced lane stability during braking, a longer braking distance and altered self-steering properties.

Final tire failure
Vibrations or loud noises while driving can indicate the final failure of the tire. Reduce speed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tire could come loose and cause an accident. Do not continue driving, and contact your service center.
Lane departure warning\*
The concept
This system issues a warning at speeds above approx. 40 mph/65 km/h if the vehicle is about to leave the lane on roads with lane markings.
The steering wheel begins vibrating gently.
The system does not provide a warning if the turn signal is set before leaving the lane.
Switching on/off

text_image
Car interior control panel with icons for fuel, car, water, and other vehicle symbols
Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
The system can issue warnings at speeds above approx. 40 mph/65 km/h.
The state is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Display

flowchart
graph TD
A["1"] --> B["2"]
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#bbf,stroke:#333
▶ Lines, arrow 1: the system is activated.
▶ Arrows, arrow 2: at least one lane marking was detected and warnings can be issued.
Issued warning
If you leave the lane and if a lane marking has been detected, the steering wheel begins vibrating.
If the turn signal is set before changing the lane, a warning is not issued.
End of warning
The warning ends:
▶ Automatically after approx. 3 seconds.
▶ When returning to your own lane.
When braking hard.
▷ When using the turn signal.
System limits

Personal responsibility
The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment of the course of the road and the traffic situation.
In the event of a warning, do not jerk the steering wheel, as you may lose control of the vehicle.
The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:
In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.
In the event of worn, poorly visible, merging, diverging, or multiple lane markings such as in construction areas.
▶ When lane markings are covered in snow, ice, dirt or water.
In tight curves or on narrow lanes.
▶ When the lane markings are covered by objects.
▶ When driving very close to the vehicle in front of you.
▶ When driving toward bright lights.
When the windshield in front of the interior rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or covered with stickers, etc.
Malfunctions
Steering wheel vibration
Frequent activation of the steering wheel vibration causes the system to overheat.
This causes the lane departure warning to become deactivated.
Let the system cool and reactivate it by pressing the button.
Camera

natural_image
Top-down view of a car showing the rearview mirror and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)The camera is located on the front of the interior rearview mirror.
Keep the area in front of the interior rearview mirror clear.
Active Blind Spot Detection\*
The concept

flowchart
graph TD
A["Car 1"] --> B["Car 2"]
C["Car 3"] --> D["Car 4"]
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style C fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style D fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
Two radar sensors below the rear bumper monitor the area behind and next to the vehicle at speeds above approx. 30 mph/50 km/h.
The system indicates whether there are vehicles in the blind spot, arrow 1, or approaching from behind on the adjacent lane, arrow 2.
The lamp in the exterior mirror housing lights up dimly.
Before you change lanes after setting the turn signal, the system issues a warning in the situations described above.
The lamp in the housing of the exterior mirror flashes and the steering wheel vibrates.
Switching on/off

natural_image
Interior view of a car's back panel with six function buttons (no text or symbols visible)
Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
The system can issue warnings at speeds above approx. 30 mph/50 km/h.
The state is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Display

natural_image
Side profile illustration of a car's front mirror and side panel (no text or symbols)Information stage
The dimmed lamp in the mirror housing indicates when there are vehicles in the blind spot or approaching from behind.
Warning
If the turn signal is set while a vehicle is in the critical zone, the steering wheel vibrates briefly and the lamp in the mirror housing flashes brightly.
The warning stops when the turn signal is switched off, or the other vehicle leaves the critical zone.
System limits

Personal responsibility
The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment of the traffic situation.
In the event of a warning, do not jerk the steering wheel, as you may lose control over the vehicle.
The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:
When a vehicle is approaching at a speed much faster than your own.
In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.
In tight curves or on narrow lanes.
Malfunctions
Steering wheel vibration
Frequent activation of the steering wheel vibration causes the system to overheat.
This causes Active Blind Spot Detection to become deactivated.
Let the system cool and reactivate it by pressing the button.
Radar sensors

natural_image
Front view of a white car with visible headlights and grille (no text or symbols)The radar sensors are located under the rear bumper.
The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:
▷ Dirty or icy bumper.
▶ Stickers on the bumper.
A Check Control message is displayed when the system is not fully functional.
For US owners only
The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communication Commission regulations. Operation is governed by the following:
FCC ID:
NBG009014A.
Compliance statement:
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
This device may not cause harmful interference, and
this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Brake force display\*
The concept

natural_image
Front view of a white car's side profile showing the headlights and grille (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Front view of a white car's rear window and grille (no text or symbols visible)During normal brake application, the outer brake lamps light up.
During heavy brake application, the inner brake lamps light up in addition.
Driving stability control systems
Antilock Brake System ABS
ABS prevents locking of the wheels during braking.
The vehicle remains steerable even during full brake applications, thus increasing active safety.
ABS is operational every time you start the engine.
Brake assistant
When you apply the brakes rapidly, this system automatically produces the maximum braking force boost. It thus helps to achieve the shortest possible braking distance during full braking. This system utilizes all of the benefits provided by ABS.
Do not reduce the pressure on the brake pedal for the duration of the full braking.
Drive-off assistant
This system supports driving away on gradients. The parking brake is not required.
- Hold the vehicle in place with the foot brake.
- Release the foot brake and drive away without delay.
After the foot brake is released, the vehicle is held in place for approx. 2 seconds.
Depending on the vehicle load, the vehicle may roll back slightly.

Driving off without delay
After releasing the foot brake, start driving without delay, since the drive-off assistant will not hold the vehicle in place for more than approx. 2 seconds and the vehicle will begin rolling back.
DSC Dynamic Stability Control
The concept
DSC prevents traction loss in the driving wheels when driving away and accelerating.
DSC also recognizes unstable vehicle conditions, such as fishtailing or nose-diving. Subject to physical limits, DSC helps to keep the vehicle on a steady course by reducing engine speed and by applying brakes at individual wheels.

Adjust your driving style to the situation
An appropriate driving style is always the responsibility of the driver.
The laws of physics cannot be repealed, even with DSC.
Therefore, do not reduce the additional safety margin by driving in a risky manner.
Indicator/warning lamps

The indicator lamp flashes: DSC controls the drive forces and brake forces.
The indicator lamp lights up: DSC has
failed.
DTC Dynamic Traction Control
The concept
The DTC system is a version of the DSC in which forward momentum is optimized.
The system ensures maximum forward momentum on special road conditions, e.g., unplowed snowy roads, but driving stability is limited.
It is therefore necessary to drive with appropriate caution.
You may find it useful to briefly activate DTC under the following special circumstances:
▶ When driving in slush or on uncleared, snow-covered roads.
When rocking the vehicle or driving off in deep snow or on loose surfaces.
▶ When driving with snow chains.
Adaptive Drive\*
The concept
Adaptive Drive* includes the following systems:
▷ Dynamic Drive, refer to page 102
▶ Dynamic Damping Control, refer to page 102
The system increases driving stability and driving comfort.
Dynamic Drive\*
The concept
Dynamic Drive reduces the lateral inclination of the vehicle that occurs during rapid driving in curves or during quick evasive maneuvers.
Driving stability and driving comfort are increased under all driving conditions. The system utilizes active stabilizer bars on the front and rear axles that react immediately to all driving situations.
Programs
The system offers two different programs.
The programs can be selected via Dynamic Driving Control, refer to page 103.
SPORT
Sporty tuning for greater driving agility.
NORMAL
Comfort-oriented tuning for optimal comfort.
Dynamic Damping Control\*
The concept
This system reduces undesirable vehicle motion when using a dynamic driving style or traveling on uneven road surfaces.
The system enhances driving dynamics and comfort as required for the road surface and driving style.
Programs
The system offers three different programs.
The programs can be selected via Dynamic Driving Control, refer to page 103.
SPORT
Consistently sporty control of the shock absorbers for greater driving agility.
NORMAL
Balanced tuning between the COMFORT and SPORT programs.
COMFORT
Comfort-oriented tuning of the shock absorbers for optimal traveling comfort.
Integral Active Steering\*
The concept
Integral Active Steering is a combination of Active Steering and rear axle steering.
Active Steering varies the steering angle of the wheels in relation to the steering wheel movement as a function of the speed.
At speeds up to approx. 37 mph/60 km/h, e.g., in curves, the steering angle is increased, i.e., steering becomes more direct.
The rear axle steering acts to increase maneuverability by turning the rear wheels slightly in a direction opposite to the front wheels.
At higher speeds, the steering angle is increasingly reduced.
The rear wheels are turned to the same angle as the front wheels.
In critical situations, Integral Active Steering can specifically steer the front and rear wheels to stabilize the vehicle before the driver intervenes, e.g., when braking where road conditions differ on the left and right sides of the vehicle.
Initializing
In rare cases, it may become necessary to initialize the Integral Active Steering.

The warning lamp lights up. A Check Control message is displayed.
- With the engine running, turn the steering wheel all the way to the left and right several times in a uniform manner until the warning lamp disappears.
- Have the system checked if the warning lamp does not go out after moving the steering wheel approx. 6 times or if the steering wheel is at an angle.
Using snow chains
Ensure that the rear axle steering is deactivated when using snow chains, refer to page 235.
Programs
The system offers two different programs.
The programs can be selected via Dynamic Driving Control, refer to page 103.
SPORT
Consistently sporty tuning of the Integral Active Steering for greater driving agility.
NORMAL
Balanced tuning of the Integral Active Steering for optimal traveling comfort.
Malfunction
In the event of a malfunction, the steering wheel must be turned further, while the vehicle responds more sensitively to steering wheel movements in the higher speed range. The stability-enhancing intervention may be deactivated.
Proceed cautiously and drive defensively.
Have the system checked.
Dynamic Driving Control\*
The concept
Dynamic Driving Control can be used to adjust the driving dynamics of the vehicle. Several programs are available for this purpose; they can be activated using the two Dynamic Driving Control buttons.
Operating the programs
Press the button Program
| OFF | DSC OFF |
| TRACTION | |
| SPORT+ | |
| SPORT | |
| NORMAL | |
| COMFORT* |
For Adaptive Drive* or Dynamic Damper Control*, the lower button is labeled with COMFORT.
Automatic program change
The system automatically switches to NORMAL in the following situations:
▶ Failure of Integral Active Steering*.
▶ Failure of Dynamic Damping Control*.
The vehicle has a flat tire.
DSC OFF
Driving stability is limited during acceleration and when driving in bends.
Stabilizing interventions by the Integral Active Steering* system are only performed by the rear axle steering.
To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC again as soon as possible.
Activating DSC OFF

Press and hold the button, but not longer than approx. 10 seconds, until the
indicator lamp for the DSC lights up in the instrument cluster and DSC OFF is displayed in the tachometer.
The DSC system is switched off.
Deactivating DSC OFF

Press the button.
DSC OFF and the DSC indicator lamp
go out.
Indicator/warning lamps
When DSC OFF is activated, DSC OFF is displayed in the tachometer.

The indicator lamp lights up: DSC OFF is activated.
TRACTION
Maximum traction on loose road surfaces. DTC Dynamic Traction Control is switched on. Driving stability is limited during acceleration and when driving in bends.
Activating TRACTION

Press the button.
TRACTION is displayed in the tachom-
eter.
The DSC indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Deactivating TRACTION

Press the button again.
TRACTION and the DSC indicator lamp
go out.
Indicator/warning lamps
When TRACTION is activated, TRACTION is displayed in the tachometer.

The indicator lamp lights up: TRACTION is activated.
SPORT+
Sporty driving with optimized chassis and suspension during limited driving stabilization.
Dynamic Traction Control is switched on.
The driver handles several of the stabilization tasks.
Activating SPORT+

Press the button repeatedly until SPORT+ appears in the tachometer
and the DSC indicator lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.
Indicator/warning lamps
SPORT+ is displayed in the instrument cluster.

The indicator lamp lights up: DTC Dynamic Traction Control is activated.
SPORT
Consistently sporty tuning of the suspension for greater driving agility with maximum driving stabilization.
The program can be configured to individual specifications.
The configuration is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Activating SPORT

Press the button repeatedly until SPORT appears in the tachometer.
Configuring SPORT
When the display is activated on the Control Display, refer to page 105, the sport program can be set to individual specifications.
After the sport program is activated, select "Configure SPORT mode" on the displayed panel and configure the program.
Optionally, the sport program can be configured before it is activated:
- "Settings"
- "SPORT mode"

text_image
Settings Speed Climate Lighting Door locks SPORT mode Profiles Allow rear control- Configure the program.
This configuration is retrieved when the sport program is activated.
NORMAL
For a balanced tuning with maximum driving stabilization.
Activating NORMAL

Press the button repeatedly until the program display in the tachometer goes out.
In certain situations, the system automatically changes to the NORMAL program, automatic program change, refer to page 103.
COMFORT\*
Comfort-oriented tuning of the shock absorbers for optimal traveling comfort with maximum driving stabilization.
Activating COMFORT

Press the button repeatedly until COM-FORT appears in the tachometer.
Displays in the instrument cluster
Selected program

The selected program is displayed in the tachometer.
Program selection

text_image
SPORT+ SPORT NORMAL COMFORTPressing the button displays a list of the selectable programs.
Display on the Control Display
Program changes can be displayed briefly on the Control Display.
To do so, make the following settings:
- "Settings"
- "Control display"
- "Display driving settings"

text_image
Control display Brightness Display driving settingsDriving comfort
Cruise control
The concept
The system is functional at speeds beginning at approx. 20 mph/30 km/h.
It maintains the speed that was set using the control elements on the steering wheel.
The system brakes on downhill gradients if engine braking action is insufficient.

Unfavorable conditions
Do not use the system if unfavorable conditions make it impossible to drive at a constant speed, for instance:
On curvy roads.
In heavy traffic.
On slippery roads, in fog, snow or rain, or on a loose road surface.
Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
Controls
Buttons at a glance

text_image
1 2 3 I/O 4 RES SET1 System on/off, interrupt
2 Resume speed
3 Store speed*
4 Store, maintain/change speed
Switching on

Press the button on the steering wheel. The marking in the speedometer is set to the current speed.
Cruise control can be used.
Switching off

Deactivated or interrupted system
If the system is deactivated or interrupted, actively intervene by braking and, if necessary, with evasive maneuvers; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident occurring.

Press the button.
▶ If active: press twice.
▶ If interrupted: press once.
The displays go out. The stored desired speed is deleted.
Interrupting

When active, press the button.
The system is automatically interrupted if:
The brakes are applied.
The clutch pedal is depressed.
▶ Transmission position D is disengaged.
▷ DTC Dynamic Traction Control is activated or DSC is deactivated.
▷ DSC is actively controlling stability.
Maintaining/storing the current speed

Press the button.
When the system is switched on, the current speed is maintained and stored as the desired speed.
It is displayed in the speedometer and briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, Displays in the speedometer, refer to page 107.
When cruise control is maintained or stored, DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if necessary.
Change, maintain speed
The rocker switch can be pressed while interrupted to maintain and store the current speed.

Adapting the desired speed
Adapt the desired speed to the road conditions and be ready to brake at all times; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident occurring.

natural_image
Diagram of a car intake manifold with directional arrows indicating flow or movement (no text or symbols)Press the rocker switch up or down repeatedly until the desired speed is set.
If active, the displayed speed is stored and the vehicle reaches the stored speed if the road is clear.
▶ Each time the rocker switch is pressed to the point of resistance, the desired speed increases or decreases by approx. 1 mph/1 km/h.
▶ Each time the rocker switch is pressed past the point of resistance, the desired speed increases or decreases by a maximum of 5 mph/10 km/h.
▶ Pressing the rocker switch to the resistance point and holding it accelerates or decelerates the vehicle without requiring pressure on the accelerator. After the rocker switch is released, the vehicle maintains its final speed. Pressing the switch beyond the resistance point causes the vehicle to accelerate more rapidly.
Resuming the desired speed

Press the button.
The stored speed is reached and maintained.
Displays in the instrument cluster

text_image
1 80 100 120 140 160 180 200 220 240 260 280 160 55 3 mph 0 1/1m1 Display of desired speed
2 Indicator lamp
3 Brief status display
Desired speed
Display in the speedometer:

The marking lights up in green: the system is active.
The marking lights up in orange: the system has been interrupted.
The marking does not light up: the system is switched off.
Brief status display
Brief display in the speedometer:

Selected desired speed
If --- appears briefly, conditions may not be adequate to operate the system.
PDC Park Distance Control\*
The concept
In addition to the PDC Park Distance Control, the backup camera*, refer to page 110, can be switched on.
PDC supports you when parking. Objects that you are approaching slowly in front of or behind your vehicle are indicated with:
▷ Signal tones.
▶ Visual display.
Measurement
Measurements are made by ultrasound sensors in the bumpers.
The range is approx. 6 ft/2 m.
An acoustic warning is first given:
By the front* sensors and the two rear corner sensors at approx. 24 in/60 cm.
▶ By the rear middle sensors at approx. 5 ft/1.50 m.
System limits

Check the traffic situation as well PDC cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment of the traffic situation. Check the traffic situation around the vehicle with your own eyes. Otherwise, an accident could result from road users or objects located outside of the PDC detection range.
Loud noises from outside and inside the vehicle may prevent you from hearing the PDC's signal tone.

Avoid driving quickly with PDC
Avoid approaching an object quickly.
Avoid driving away quickly while PDC is not yet active.
For technical reasons, the system may otherwise be too late in issuing a warning.
Limits of ultrasonic measurement
The detection of objects can reach the physical limits of ultrasonic measurement, for instance:
With tow bars and trailer hitches.
▶ With thin or wedge-shaped objects.
▶ With low objects.
▶ With objects with corners and sharp edges.
Low objects already displayed, e.g., curbs, can move into the blind area of the sensors before or after a continuous tone sounds.
High, protruding objects such as ledges may not be detected.
False warnings
PDC may issue a warning under the following conditions even though there is no obstacle within the detection range:
In heavy rain.
▶ When sensors are very dirty or covered in ice.
▶ When sensors are covered in snow.
On rough road surfaces.
In large buildings with right angles and smooth walls, e.g., in underground garages.
▷ In heavy exhaust.
Due to other ultrasound sources, e.g., sweeping machines, high pressure steam cleaners or neon lights.
Switching on automatically
Select transmission position R with the engine running.
Switching off automatically
The system switches off and the LED goes out:
▶ After approx. 160 ft/50 m when driving forward.
▶ Above approx. 22 mph/36 km/h when driving forward.
Switch on the system again if necessary.
Switching on/off manually

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a circular vent (no visible text or symbols)
Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
Signal tones
When approaching an object, an intermittent tone is sounded that indicates the position of the object. For example, if an object is detected to the left rear of the vehicle, a signal tone sounds from the left rear speaker.
The shorter the distance to the object becomes, the shorter the intervals.
If the distance to a detected object is less than approx. 12 in/30 cm, a continuous tone is sounded.
If objects are located both in front of and behind the vehicle, an alternating continuous signal is sounded.
The intermittent tone is interrupted after approx. 3 seconds:
▶ If the vehicle stops in front of an object that is detected by only one of the corner sensors.
▶ If moving parallel to a wall.
The signal tone is switched off:
▶ When the vehicle moves away from an object by more than approx. 4 in/10 cm.
▶ When transmission position P is engaged.
Volume
You can set the volume of the PDC signal tone, refer to page 165.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Visual warning
The approach of the vehicle to an object can be shown on the Control Display. Objects that are farther away are displayed on the Control Display before a signal tone sounds.
A display appears as soon as Park Distance Control (PDC) is activated.
If the backup camera image was selected last, it again appears on the display. To switch to PDC:
- "Rear view camera" Select the symbol on the Control Display.
- Press the controller.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Zoom view\*
On the left part of the display screen, the vehicle is shown enlarged.

natural_image
Abstract grayscale illustration of a conical object with layered bands (no text or symbols)▶ Forward gear or transmission position D engaged: front area of the vehicle.
▶ Reverse gear or transmission position R engaged: rear area of the vehicle.
Display on the Control Display
Switching on the backup camera via the iDrive
With PDC activated:
R "Rear view camera"
The backup camera image is displayed. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Malfunction
A Check Control message is displayed.

natural_image
Close-up of a conical object with diagonal striped pattern, possibly a lamp or container (no text or symbols visible)On the Control Display, the areas in front of and behind the vehicle are shaded. PDC has failed. Have the system checked.
To ensure full operability:
▷ Keep the sensors clean and free of ice.
When using a pressure washer, keep the sprayer moving and maintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm from the sensors.
Surround View\*
The concept
Surround View includes the following systems:
▶ Backup camera, refer to page 110.
▶ Side View, refer to page 114.
▶ Top View, refer to page 112.
It assists the driver when parking, maneuvering and on blind driveways and intersections.
Backup camera\*
The concept
The backup camera provides assistance in parking and maneuvering backwards. The area behind the vehicle is shown on the Control Display.
System limits

Check the traffic situation as well
Check the traffic situation around the vehicle with your own eyes. Otherwise, an accident could result from road users or objects located outside the picture area of the backup camera.

Detection of objects
High, protruding objects such as ledges may not be detected by the backup camera.
Switching on automatically
Select transmission position R with the engine running.
The backup camera image is displayed if the system was switched on via the iDrive.
Switching off automatically
The system switches off and the LED goes out:
▶ After approx. 33 ft/10 m when driving forward.
▶ Above approx. 9 mph/15 km/h when driving forward.
Switch on the system again if necessary.
Switching on/off manually

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing dashboard, air vent, and control panel (no text or symbols visible)
Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
The PDC is shown on the Control Display.
Switch on the backup camera via the iDrive, refer to page 112.
Assistance functions
Functional requirement
The backup camera is switched on.
The trunk lid is fully closed.
Pathway lines

natural_image
Top-down view of a modern architectural facade with diagonal grid pattern (no text or symbols)▶ Can be shown in the backup camera image when in transmission position R.
▶ Help you to estimate the space required when parking and maneuvering on level roads.
Are dependent on the current steering angle and are continuously adjusted to the steering wheel movements.
Show the parking aid lines, refer to page 111.
Turning circle lines

natural_image
Exterior view of a paved road with two parallel tracks crossing through the center (no signage or text)▶ Can be shown in the backup camera image.
▶ Show the course of the smallest possible turning circle on a level road.
▶ Only one turning circle line is displayed when the steering wheel is turned.
Show the parking aid lines, refer to page 111.
Parking using pathway and turning circle lines
- Position the vehicle so that the turning circle lines lead to within the limits of the parking space.

natural_image
Exterior view of a modern building facade with diagonal window grilles (no signage or text)- Turn the steering wheel to the point where the pathway line covers the corresponding turning circle line.

natural_image
Abstract geometric pattern with curved and grid lines, no text or symbols presentObstacle marking

natural_image
Close-up of a curved surface with grid pattern and a vertical rod, no visible text or symbols▶ Spatially-shaped markings can be shown in the backup camera image.
Their colored steps match the markings of the PDC. This simplifies estimation of the distance to the object shown.
Activating the assistance functions
More than one assistance function can be active at the same time.
Showing the parking aid lines
"Parking aid lines"
Pathway and turning circle lines are displayed.
Showing the obstacle marking
P4 "Obstacle marking"
Spatially-shaped markings are displayed.
Display on the Control Display
Switching on the backup camera via iDrive
With PDC activated:
R "Rear view camera"
The backup camera image is displayed. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Brightness
With the backup camera switched on:
- ☀️ Select the symbol.
- Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Contrast
With the backup camera switched on:
- Select the symbol.
- Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Camera

natural_image
Close-up of a car's rear window with a circular opening and an arrow pointing to the eye area (no text or symbols visible)The camera lens is located under the BMW emblem of the trunk lid. The image quality may be impaired by dirt.
Clean the lens, refer to page 257.
Top View\*
The concept
Top View assists you in parking and maneuvering. The area around the doors and the road area around the vehicle are shown on the Control Display for this purpose.
Capturing the image
The image is captured by two cameras integrated in the exterior mirrors and by the backup camera.
The range equals:
▶ approx. 7 ft/2 m to the side.
▷ approx. 7 ft/2 m to the rear.
In this way, obstacles up to the height of the exterior mirrors are detected early.
System limits
Top View cannot be used in the following situations:
▶ With a door open.
▶ With the trunk lid open.
▶ With an exterior mirror folded in.
In poor light.
A Check Control message is displayed in some of these situations.

Check the traffic situation as well
Check the traffic situation around the vehicle with your own eyes. Otherwise, an accident could result from road users or objects located outside the picture area of the cameras.
Switching on automatically
Select transmission position R with the engine running.
The Top View and PDC images are displayed if the system is switched on via iDrive.
Switching off automatically
The system switches off and the LED goes out:
▶ After approx. 160 ft/50 m when driving forward.
▶ Above approx. 22 mph/36 km/h when driving forward.
Switch on the system again if necessary.
Switching on/off manually

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a circular vent (no visible text or symbols)
Press the button.
On: the LED lights up.
▶ Off: the LED goes out.
If Top View is displayed, switch on the backup camera via the iDrive, refer to page 113.
Visual warning
The approach of the vehicle to an object can be shown on the Control Display.
When the distance to an object is small, a red bar is shown in front of the vehicle, as it is in the PDC display.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car parked in a parking lot with lane markings (no visible text or symbols)The display appears as soon as Top View is activated.
If the backup camera image was selected last, it again appears on the display. To switch to Top View:
"Rear view camera" Select the symbol on the Control Display.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Display on the Control Display
Switching on the backup camera via iDrive
With Top View switched on:
R "Rear view camera"
The backup camera image is displayed. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Brightness
With Top View switched on:
-
"Brightness"
-
Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Contrast
With Top View switched on:
-
Contrast"
-
Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Displaying the turning circle and pathway lines
The static, red turning circle line shows the space needed to the side of the vehicle when the steering wheel is turned all the way.
The variable, green pathway line assists you in assessing the amount of space actually needed to the side of the vehicle.
The pathway line is dependent on the current steering angle and is continuously adjusted with the steering wheel movement.
"Parking aid lines"
Turning circle and pathway lines are displayed.
Cameras

natural_image
Side view of a car's side mirror and window, showing the front wheel and side window (no text or symbols visible)The objectives of the Top View cameras are located at the bottom of the exterior mirror housings. The image quality may be impaired by dirt. Clean the lens, refer to page 257.
Side View\*
The concept
Side View provides an early look at cross traffic at blind driveways and intersections. Road users concealed by obstacles to the left and right of the vehicle can only be detected relatively late from the driver's seat. To improve visibility, two cameras in the front of the vehicle record the traffic situation on each side.
System limits
The maximum recording range of the camera is 330 ft/100 m.
Display
The images from both cameras are shown simultaneously on the Control Display.

Check the traffic situation as well
Check the traffic situation around the vehicle on blind driveways and intersections with your own eyes. Otherwise, an accident could result from road users or objects located outside the picture area of the Side View cameras.
Switching off automatically
System switches off: above approx. 9 mph/15 km/h.
Switch on the system again if necessary.
Switching on/off manually

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and a circular vent (no visible text or symbols)
Press the button.
Display on the Control Display
The traffic area to the left and right is displayed on the Control Display.

natural_image
Diagram showing two cars standing on a road with a central car silhouette, no text or symbols presentGuidelines at the bottom of the image show the position of the front of the vehicle.
Brightness
With the Side View switched on:
-
"Brightness"
-
Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Contrast
With the Side View switched on:
-
"Contrast"
-
Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Cameras

natural_image
Side view of a car showing a tire and dashboard, with an arrow pointing to a detail on the wheel (no text or symbols visible)The two camera lenses are located on the sides of the bumper.
The image quality may be impaired by dirt.
Clean the lens, refer to page 257.
Parking assistant\*
The concept

natural_image
Top-down diagram of a car being towed into three lanes, showing a curved arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)This system assists the driver in parking parallel to the road.
Ultrasound sensors measure parking spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
The parking assistant calculates the best possible parking line and takes control of steering during the parking procedure.
When parking, also take note of the visual and acoustic information issued by the PDC and the parking assistant and accelerate or brake accordingly.
A component of the parking assistant is the PDC Park Distance Control*, refer to page 107.

Personal responsibility
The parking assistant does not relieve the driver of responsibility for the vehicle during the parking procedure.
Watch the parking space and parking procedure closely and intervene if necessary; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident.
Requirements
For measuring parking spaces
▶ Maximum speed while driving forward approx. 22 mph/35 km/h.
▶ Maximum distance to row of parked vehicles: 5 ft/1.5 m.
Suitable parking space
▶ Gap between two objects with a minimum length of approx. 5 ft/1.5 m.
▶ Minimum length: own vehicle length plus approx. 4 ft/1.2 m.
▶ Minimum depth: approx. 5 ft/1.5 m.
For parking procedure
Closed doors.
Switching on
Using the button

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle dashboard with control panels and a circular vent (no visible text or symbols)
Press the button.
The LED lights up.
The parking assistant is activated automatically.
The current status of the parking space search is indicated on the Control Display.
By engaging reverse
Engage transmission position R.
The current status of the parking space search is indicated on the Control Display.
Activate: "Parking Assistant" Select the symbol in the Control Display.
Display on the Control Display
System status
Symbol Meaning

Gray: the system is not available.
White: the system is available but not activated.

The system is activated.

natural_image
Top-down view of a car with a central display area and two directional arrows indicating movement or navigation (no text or symbols)
Gray: the system is not activated. Parking space search.
Blue: the system is activated. A suitable parking space was found.

The parking procedure is active. Steering control has been seized.
Status of the parking space search

text_image
1 2▶ Gray, arrow 1: parking space search.
▶ Blue, arrow 2: parking space is suitable.
The vehicle is parked in the parking space if the parking procedure is active.
▶ No display: no parking space search.
Parking using the parking assistant

Personal responsibility
The parking assistant does not relieve the driver of responsibility for the vehicle during the parking procedure.
Watch the parking space and parking procedure closely and intervene if necessary; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident.

Check the traffic situation as well
Loud sounds outside and within the vehicle can drown out the signal tones of the parking assistant and PDC.
Check the traffic situation around the vehicle with your own eyes; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident.
- Switch on the parking assistant and activate it if necessary.
The status of the parking space search is indicated on the Control Display. - Follow the instructions on the Control Display.
The end of the parking procedure is indicated on the Control Display. - Adjust the parking position yourself if necessary.
Notes
The parking assistant takes control of steering for as long as the symbol for active parking appears on the display.
The system maneuvers the vehicle to position it properly in smaller parking spaces, for example.
To achieve the best possible parking position, wait for the automatic steering wheel movement after the gear change when the vehicle is stationary.
When parking in parking spaces on the driver's side, the corresponding turn signal must be set.
Interrupting manually
The parking assistant can be interrupted at any time by:
- Grasping the steering wheel and steering yourself.
▶ "Deactivate Parking Assistant" Select the symbol on the Control Display.
Interrupting automatically
The procedure is interrupted automatically:
▶ If the vehicle speed exceeds approx. 6 mph/10 km/h.
On snow-covered or slippery road surfaces if necessary.
▶ If doors are open.
A Check Control message is displayed.
Continuing
An interrupted parking procedure can be continued if necessary.
Follow the instructions on the Control Display to do this.
Switching off
The system can be deactivated as follows:
▶ Press the button.
▶ Switch off the ignition.

Malfunction
A Check Control message is displayed.
The parking assistant failed. Have the system checked.
System limits

Changes to the parking space
Changes to the parking space after it was measured are not taken into account by the system.
Therefore, always be alert and ready to intervene; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident occurring.

Transporting loads
Loads that extend beyond the perimeter of the vehicle are not taken into account by the system during the parking procedure.
Therefore, always be alert and ready to intervene; otherwise, there is the danger of an accident occurring.

Curbs
The parking assistant may steer the vehicle over or onto curbs.
Therefore, always be alert and ready to intervene; otherwise, the wheels, tires, or the vehicle may become damaged.
No parking assistance
The parking assistant does not provide assistance in parking.
In tight curves.
Functional limitations
The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:
▶ When sensors are dirty or iced over.
▶ In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.
On bumpy road surfaces such as gravel roads.
▶ When leaves or snow has collected in the parking space.
Limits of ultrasonic measurement
The detection of objects can reach the physical limits of ultrasonic measurement, for instance:
▶ With tow bars and trailer hitches.
▶ With thin or wedge-shaped objects.
▶ With elevated, protruding objects such as ledges or cargo.
▶ With objects with corners and sharp edges.
▶ With objects with a fine surface structure, such as fences.
The parking assistant may identify parking spaces that are not suitable for parking.
Ultrasound sensors

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel with a pointing arrow and a small black dot on the door (no text or symbols)The ultrasounds sensors used to measure parking spaces are located in the side turn signals.
To ensure full operability:
▷ Keep the sensors clean and free of ice.
When using a pressure washer, keep the sprayer moving and maintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm from the sensors.
Night Vision with pedestrian detection\*
The concept
Night Vision with pedestrian detection is a night vision system.
An infrared camera records the area in front of the vehicle and displays the image on the Control Display.
The picture is a heat image. The system has an integrated pedestrian detection function that detects pedestrians and cyclists. Warm objects that are similar in shape to human beings are detected by the system.
Personal responsibility
Night Vision cannot replace the driver's personal judgment of the visibility conditions and the traffic situation. The view ahead and the actual visibility conditions must always be the basis on which the vehicle speed is adjusted; otherwise, there is a risk to road safety.
Heat image

natural_image
Silhouette of a herd of sheep walking along a path with trees in the background (no text or symbols)The image shows the heat radiated by objects in the field of view of the camera.
Warm objects have a light appearance and cold objects, a dark appearance.
The ability to detect an object depends on the temperature difference between the object and the background and on the level of heat radiation emitted by the object. Objects that are similar in temperature to the environment or that radiate very little heat are difficult to detect.
For safety reasons, when driving at speeds above approx. 3 mph/5 km/h and in low ambient light, the image is only displayed when the low beams are switched on.
A still image is displayed at regular intervals for a fraction of a second.
Pedestrian detection

natural_image
Silhouette of a person standing on a road with a car, surrounded by trees and buildings (no text or symbols visible)The pedestrian detection and warning system only operates in darkness and only when a heat image is displayed.
Warm objects that are similar in shape to human beings are detected by the system.
People detected by the system are displayed with a slight yellow hue.
Under good ambient conditions, the pedestrian detection system operates within a range of approx. 50 ft/15 m to approx. 330 ft/100 m.

natural_image
Nighttime street scene with a person walking on a road, a car, and trees (no visible text or symbols)Environmental influences can limit the availability of pedestrian detection.
If pedestrian detection is not available, a symbol is displayed in the heat image.
This symbol disappears when the function becomes available again.
Warning of people in danger

natural_image
Illustration of a road with two human silhouettes and a warning sign, surrounded by trees (no text or symbols)If the system detects a person in the defined area in front of the vehicle and if there is the danger of a collision with this person, a warning symbol appears in the Control Display and Head-up Display*.
Although both the shape and the heat radiation are analyzed, false warnings cannot be ruled out.
Warning area in front of the vehicle

text_image
Diagram showing a car driving on a road with two directional arrows labeled 1 and 2 indicating flow or movement directions.The warning area in front of the vehicle is divided into two areas.
▶ Central area 1 directly in front of the vehicle.
▶ Expanded area 2 to the right and left.
The entire area moves along with the vehicle in the direction of the steering angle and changes with the vehicle speed. As the vehicle speed increases, the area becomes longer and wider, for example.
Symbols

This symbol is displayed when a person is detected in the central area, arrow 1, immediately in front of the vehicle.

This symbol is displayed when a person detected in the extended area, arrow 2,
is moving from the right or left to the central area.
Display in the Head-up Display\*

The warning is simultaneously displayed in the Head-up Display and in the Control Display. The displayed symbol can vary with the people detected. For people located in the central area, the distance to the person is indicated by the size of the symbol.
System limits
Basic limits
System operation is limited in situations such as the following:
On steep hills, in steep depressions or in tight curves.
▶ When the camera is dirty or the protective glass is damaged.
In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.
▶ At very high external temperatures.
Limits of pedestrian detection
Animals are not detected by the pedestrian detection function, even if they are clearly visible in the image.
Limited pedestrian detection:
When people are fully or partially covered, especially when their heads are covered.
▶ When people are not in an upright position, e.g., when lying down.
▶ Cyclists on unconventional bicycles (e.g., recumbent bicycles).
▶ After physical damage to the system, e.g., after an accident.
Activation/deactivation

text_image
Car interior control panel with icons for car, vehicle, roof, and exhaust
Press the button.
Display
Settings via iDrive
With Night Vision switched on:
- Activate Night Vision with pedestrian detection.
- Press the controller.
- Open the desired menu item.
▶ "Brightness"
▶ "Contrast"
▶ "Pedestrian detection"
The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
Camera

natural_image
Close-up of a car's front grille with a white arrow pointing to a small component (no text or symbols visible)Rain, dirt, snow, or ice can impair camera operation.
The camera is automatically heated when the external temperatures are low.
The camera is automatically cleaned together with the headlamps.
Clean the lens, refer to page 257.
Head-up Display\*
The concept

natural_image
Close-up of a car's rear window frame and roof structure (no text or symbols visible)This system projects important information into the driver's field of vision, e.g., the speed.
In this way, the driver can get information without averting his or her eyes from the road.
Display visibility
The visibility of the displays in the Head-up Display is influenced by:
▶ Certain sitting positions.
▶ Objects on the cover of the Head-up Display.
▷ Sunglasses with certain polarization filters.
▷ Wet roads.
▶ Unfavorable light conditions.
If the image is distorted, check the basic settings.
Switching on/off

text_image
Car interior control panel with icons for fuel, car, climate, and weather symbols
Press the button.
Display

text_image
3 2 1 35 30 mph 5 BAYSHORE BOULEVARD 800 ft 41 Lane departure warning*
2 Active Cruise Control*
3 Desired speed
4 Navigation system*
5 Speed
The collision warning*, Night Vision* pedestrian warning, or Check Control messages are displayed briefly if needed.
Selecting displays in the Head-up Display
- "Settings"
- "Head-up display"
- "Displayed information"
- Select the desired displays in the Head-up Display.
The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
Setting the brightness
The brightness is automatically adjusted to the ambient light.
The basic setting can be adjusted manually.
- "Settings"
- "Head-up display"
- "Brightness"
- Turn the controller.
The brightness is adjusted.
When the low beams are switched on, the brightness of the Head-up Display can be additionally influenced using the instrument lighting, refer to page 87.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Adjusting the height
- "Settings"
- "Head-up display"
- "Height"
- Turn the controller.
The height is adjusted.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Special windshield
The windshield is part of the system.
The shape of the windshield makes it possible to display a precise image.
A film in the windshield prevents double images from being displayed.
Therefore, have the special windshield replaced by a service center only.
Climate control
Automatic climate control

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 AUTO MAX AUTO ALL A 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 121 Air distribution, left
2 Temperature, left
3 AUTO program, left
4 Air volume, AUTO intensity, residual heat, left
5 Remove ice and condensation
6 Maximum cooling
7 Display
8 Air volume, AUTO intensity, right
9 AUTO program, right
10 Temperature, right
Climate control functions in detail
Manual air distribution

Press the button repeatedly to select a program:
▶ Upper body region.
▶ Upper body region and footwell.
11 Air distribution, right
12 Seat heating*, right 55
13 Active seat ventilation*, right 55
14 Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air mode
15 Cooling function
16 Rear window defroster
17 ALL program
18 Active seat ventilation*, left 55
19 Seat heating*, left 55
▶ Footwell.
▶ Windows and footwell: driver's side only.
▶ Windows, upper body region and footwell: driver's side only.
If the windows are fogged over, press the AUTO button on the driver's side to utilize the condensation sensor.
Temperature

Turn the wheel to set the desired temperature.
The automatic climate control achieves this temperature as quickly as possible, if necessary with the maximum cooling or heating capacity, and then keeps it constant.
Avoid rapidly switching between different temperature settings. The automatic climate control will not have sufficient time to adjust the set temperature.
AUTO program

Press the button.
Air volume, air distribution, and temperature are controlled automatically.
Depending on the selected temperature, AUTO intensity, and outside influences, the air is directed to the windshield, side windows, upper body, and into the footwell.
The cooling function, refer to page 125, is switched on automatically with the AUTO program.
At the same time, a condensation sensor controls the program so as to prevent window condensation as much as possible.
Intensity of the AUTO program
With the AUTO program switched on, automatic control of the air volume and air distribution can be adjusted.

Press the left or right side of the button: decrease or increase the intensity.
The selected intensity is shown on the display of the automatic climate control.
Convertible program
When the convertible top is open, the convertible program is activated as well. In the convertible program, the automatic climate control is optimized for driving with the convertible top open. In addition, the air volume is increased as the vehicle speed increases.
The efficiency of the convertible program can be greatly enhanced by installing the wind deflector*.
Air volume, manual
To be able to manually adjust the air volume, switch off the AUTO program first.

Press the left or right side of the button: decrease or increase air volume.
The selected air volume is shown on the display of the automatic climate control.
The air volume of the automatic climate control may be reduced automatically to save battery power.
Defrosting windows and removing condensation

Press the button.
Ice and condensation are quickly removed from the windshield and the front side windows.
The air volume can be adjusted when the program is active.
If the windows are fogged over, additionally switch on the cooling function or press the AUTO button to utilize the condensation sensor.
Maximum cooling

Press the button.
The system is set to the lowest temperature, maximum air volume and recirculated-air mode.
Air flows out of the vents for the upper body region. Open them for this purpose.
Air is cooled as quickly as possible:
At an external temperature of approx. 32 °F/0 °C.
▷ When the engine is running.
The air volume can be adjusted when the program is active.
Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air mode
You can respond to unpleasant odors or pollutants in the immediate environment by temporarily suspending the supply of outside air. The system then recirculates the air currently within the vehicle.

Press the button repeatedly to select an operating mode:
▶ LEDs off: outside air flows in continuously.
▶ Left LED on, automatic recirculated-air control: a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and controls the shut-off automatically.
Right LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply of outside air into the vehicle is permanently blocked.
If the windows are fogged over, switch off the recirculated-air mode and press the AUTO button on the driver's side to utilize the condensation sensor. Make sure that air can flow onto the windshield.

Continuous recirculated-air mode
The recirculated-air mode should not be used for an extended period of time, as the air quality inside the vehicle deteriorates steadily.
Cooling function
The passenger compartment can only be cooled with the engine running.

Press the button.
The air is cooled and dehumidified and – depending on the temperature setting – warmed again.
Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog up briefly when the engine is started.
The cooling function is switched on automatically with the AUTO program.
When using the automatic climate control, condensation water, refer to page 140, develops that exits underneath the vehicle.
Rear window defroster

Press the button.
The rear window defroster switches off automatically after a certain period of time.
The rear window defroster is only active when the rear window is closed.
ALL program

Press the button.
Current settings on the driver's side for the temperature, air volume, air distribution, and AUTO program are transferred to the front passenger side.
The program is switched off if the settings on the front passenger side are changed.
Residual heat
The heat stored in the engine is used to heat the interior.
Functional requirement
▶ Up to 20 minutes after the engine has been switched off.
▷ Warm engine.
The battery is sufficiently charged.
▶ External temperature below 77 °F/25 °C.
Switching on
- Switch off the ignition.

Press the right side of the button on er's side.
iii is shown on the display of the automatic climate control.
The interior temperature, air volume and air distribution can be adjusted with the ignition switched on.
Switching off
At the lowest fan speed, press the left side of the button on the driver's side.
!!! on the display of the automatic climate control goes out.
Switching the system on/off
Switching off
▶ Complete system:

At the lowest fan speed, press the left side of the button on the driver's
On the front passenger side:

At the lowest fan speed, press the left side of the button on the front gler side.
Switching on
Press any button.
Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter
The microfilter removes dust and pollen from the incoming air.
The activated-charcoal filter removes gaseous pollutants from the outside air that enters the vehicle.
This combined filter should be replaced during scheduled maintenance of your vehicle., refer to page 241
Ventilation

text_image
1 2 2 3 3▶ Thumbwheel to vary the temperature, arrow 1.
Toward blue: colder.
Toward red: warmer.
▶ Lever for changing the air flow direction, arrow 2.
▶ Thumbwheels for opening and closing the vents continuously, arrows 3.
Adjusting the ventilation
▶ Ventilation for cooling:
Adjust the vent to direct the air in your direction, e.g., if the vehicle interior is hot from the sun.
Draft-free ventilation:
Adjust the vent to let the air flow past you.
Parked-car ventilation
The concept
The parked-car ventilation ventilates the vehicle interior and lowers its temperature, if necessary.
The system can be switched on and off directly or by using two preset switch-on times. It remains switched on for 30 minutes.
They can be operated via iDrive.
Parked-car ventilation
Using the preset switch-on time or when operated directly: any external temperature.
Open the vents to allow air to flow out.
Switching on/off directly
-
"Settings"
-
"Climate"
-
"Activate parked-car vent."
The symbol on the automatic climate control flashes if the system is switched on.
The system continues to run for some time after being switched off.
Preselecting the switch-on time
-
"Settings"
-
"Climate"
-
"Timer 1:" or "Timer 2:"
-
Set the desired time.
Activating the switch-on time
-
"Settings"
-
"Climate"
-
"Activate Timer 1" or "Activate Timer 2"
The symbol on the automatic climate control lights up when the switch-on time is activated.
The symbol on the automatic climate control flashes when the system has been switched on.
The system will only be switched on within the next 24 hours. After that, it needs to reactivated.
Interior equipment
Integrated universal remote control\*
The concept
This system can replace up to three different hand-held transmitters for various types of remote-controlled equipment, such as garage doors or lighting systems.
The hand-held transmitter signal can be programmed on one of the three memory buttons.
The corresponding device can then be operated using the programmed memory button.
The LED indicates that a signal is being transmitted.
When selling the vehicle, delete the stored programs for security reasons.

During programming
During programming and before activating a device using the universal remote control, ensure that there are no people, animals, or objects in the range of movement of the remote-controlled device; otherwise, there is a risk of injury or damage.
Also follow the safety instructions of the hand-held transmitter.
Compatibility

If this symbol is printed on the packaging or in the instructions of the hand-held transmitter, the remote-controlled device is generally compatible with the universal remote control.
If you have any questions, please contact:
▶ Your service center.
▷ www.homelink.com on the Internet.
Programming

text_image
1 2▷ LED, arrow 1.
▶ Memory buttons, arrow 2.
Fixed-code hand-held transmitters
-
Switch on the ignition.
-
Initial setup:
Press both outer buttons 1 and 3 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED flashes.
All programs of the three memory buttons, arrow 2, are cleared.
-
Hold the hand-held transmitter a distance of approx. 2 to 8 in/5 to 20 cm from the memory buttons.
-
Simultaneously press the transmit button of the hand-held transmitter and the memory button of the universal remote control.
The LED flashes slowly.
- Release both buttons when the LED flashes rapidly.
If the LED does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, change the distance and repeat the step.
The device can be operated using the memory button with the engine running or the ignition switched on.
Malfunction
If the device cannot be used after repeated attempts at programming, please check whether the hand-held transmitter is equipped with an alternating code system.
To do so:
Read the instructions of the hand-held transmitter.
▶ Press the memory button of the universal remote control for an extended period.
If the LED flashes rapidly for a brief period and then lights up continuously for approx. 2 seconds, the hand-held transmitter is equipped with an alternating code system.
In this case, program the memory buttons as described under Alternating-code hand-held transmitters.
Alternating-code hand-held transmitters
Please obtain information on synchronizing the device in the operating manual of the device being set up.
Programming will be easier with the aid of a second person.
- Park the vehicle within range of the remote-controlled device.
- Program the universal remote control as described above under Fixed-code hand-held transmitters.
- Press and hold the programmed button on the interior rearview mirror for approx. 5 seconds until the device to be adjusted is activated.
If the device does not become activated, press and hold the button and watch the LED:
If the LED lights up continuously, the programming is completed. The device should become activated when the button is pressed briefly.
▶ If the LED flashes for approx. 2 seconds and then lights up continuously, continue the programming procedure beginning with step 4.
-
Locate the button on the receiver of the device to be set, e.g., on the drive.
-
Press the button on the receiver of the device to be set. You have approx. 30 seconds for the next step.
- Press the programmed memory button of the universal remote control three times.
The device can be operated when the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.
Reassigning individual programs
- Switch on the ignition.
- Hold the hand-held transmitter a distance of approx. 2 to 8 in/5 to 20 cm from the memory buttons.
- Press the memory button of the universal remote control.
- If the LED flashes slowly after approx. 20 seconds, press the transmit button on the hand-held transmitter.
- Release both buttons when the LED flashes rapidly.
If the LED does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, change the distance and repeat the step.
Deleting all stored programs
Press the left and right memory buttons for approx. 20 seconds until the LED flashes rapidly. All stored programs are deleted.
The programs cannot be deleted individually.
Ashtray/cigarette lighter\*
Manual-shift transmission: opening

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black keyway and white directional arrow (no text or symbols)Press on the cover.
Automatic transmission\*: opening

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a switch and gear shift (no text or symbols visible)Press the button.
Emptying
Take out the insert.
Lighter

Push in the lighter.
The lighter can be removed as soon as it pops back out.

Danger of burns
Only hold the hot lighter by its knob; otherwise, there is the danger of getting burned.
Switch off the ignition and take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle so that children cannot use the lighter and burn themselves.
Connecting electrical devices
Sockets\*
The lighter socket can be used as a socket for electrical equipment while the engine is running or when the ignition is switched on. The total load of all sockets must not exceed 140 Watt at 12 V.
Do not damage the socket by using unsuitable connectors.
Manual transmission: center console

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black play button and white arrow symbol (no text or labels)Press on the cover.
Remove the cover or cigarette lighter*.
Automatic transmission\*: center console

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black switch and directional arrow (no text or symbols)Press on the cover.
Remove the cover or cigarette lighter*.
Center armrest

natural_image
Interior view of a car headrest with a highlighted component (no text or symbols visible)Remove the cover.
Ski bag\*
Capacity
The ski bag makes it possible to transport two pairs of skis up to a length of 6 ft/2.10 m.
Preparing and loading the ski bag
- Pull the release and remove the insert from the front.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seat with a black seatbelt and white arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)-
Lay out the ski bag.
-
Press button in the cargo area, open tailboard and attach to the rear wall via magnetic holder.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle cab with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)-
Load the ski bag. If necessary, wrap the sharp edges of the skis. If necessary, open the ski bag zipper to ease loading or to dry the ski bag.
-
Tighten the retaining strap.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with an arrow pointing to the seat (no text or symbols visible)
Securing the ski bag
Secure the ski bag by tightening the retaining strap; otherwise, the contents could present a source of danger to the passengers, for example during braking or evasive maneuvers.
Stowing the ski bag
Proceed in the reverse order of loading.
When replacing the insert, place both pins into the rail at the bottom and press the insert back in place. Ensure that the rear seat backrest upholstery is not damaged.
Storage compartments
Storage compartments
The following storage compartments are available in the vehicle interior:
▶ Glove compartment on the front passenger side, refer to page 132.
Storage compartment on the center console: manual transmission.
Storage compartment in the center armrest, refer to page 132.
▶ Compartments in the doors.
▷ Pockets* on the backrests of the front seats.
Net* in the front passenger footwell.
Glove compartment
Opening

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear air vent with an arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols visible)Pull the handle.
The light in the glove compartment switches on.

Close the glove compartment again immediately
Close the glove compartment immediately after use while driving; otherwise, injury may occur during accidents.
Closing
Fold up the cover.
USB interface for data transfer

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a door handle and rear panel with an arrow pointing to the door (no text or symbols visible)Connection for importing and exporting data on USB devices, e.g.:
▶ Personal Profile settings, refer to page 33.
▶ Music collection, refer to page 180.
Observe the following when connecting:
Do not use force when plugging the connector into the USB interface.
Do not connect devices such as fans or lamps to the USB interface.
Do not connect USB hard drives.
Do not use the USB interface to recharge external devices.
Center armrest
Opening
A storage compartment is located in the center armrest between the front seats.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with arrows indicating downward motion (no text or symbols)Press the buttons next to the lock.
Locking the storage compartment

natural_image
Close-up of a car seatbelt buckle with a white arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)The storage compartment in the armrest can be locked with an integrated key to separately secure the trunk lid, refer to page 39, for example.
After the storage compartment is locked, the remote control can be handed out without the integrated key, refer to page 32, for instance at a hotel.
This prevents access to the storage compartment and to the cargo area.
Connection for an external audio device

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever (no text or symbols visible)This can be used to connect an external audio device, such as a CD or MP3 player.
▶ AUX-IN port, refer to page 184.
▶ USB audio interface*, refer to page 185.
Cupholders
Notes

Shatter-proof containers and no hot drinks
Use light and shatter-proof containers and do not transport hot drinks. Otherwise, there is the increased danger of injury in an accident.

Unsuitable containers
Do not forcefully push unsuitable containers into the cupholders. This may result in damage.
Manual transmission: center console

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel, gear shift, and central vent (no text or symbols visible)A cupholder is located on the center console.
Manual transmission: center armrest

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with two white arrows pointing to the side (no text or symbols)A cupholder is located in the center armrest compartment.
To open: press the buttons next to the lock.
Automatic transmission*: center console

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black play button and white arrow indicator (no text or symbols)To open: press on the cover.
Storage compartments in the cargo area
Net\*
Small objects can be stowed in the net on the rear cargo area trim.
Storage compartment under the cargo floor cover

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a dark panel with three white arrows pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)Raise the cargo floor cover using the strap.
Lashing eyes
To secure the cargo, refer to page 141, there are lashing eyes in the cargo area.

text_image
Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 606 521 - 03 11 490Driving tips
This chapter provides you with information useful in dealing with specific driving and operating modes.
Things to remember when driving
Breaking-in period
General information
Moving parts need to be broken in to adjust to each other.
The following instructions will help achieve a long vehicle life and good economy.
Engine and differential
Always obey the official speed limit.
Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 km
Do not exceed the maximum engine and road speed:
▶ For gasoline engine, 4500 rpm and 100 mph/160 km/h.
Avoid full-throttle operation and use of the transmission's kickdown mode for the initial miles.
From 1,200 miles/2,000 km
The engine and vehicle speed can gradually be increased.
Tires
Due to technical factors associated with their manufacture, tires do not achieve their full traction potential until after an initial breaking-in period.
Drive conservatively for the first 200 miles/300 km.
Brake system
Brakes require an initial break-in period of approx. 300 miles/500 km to achieve optimized contact and wear patterns between brake pads and discs. Drive moderately during this break-in period.
Clutch
The function of the clutch reaches its optimal level only after a distance driven of approx.
300 miles/500 km. During this break-in period, engage the clutch gently.
Following part replacement
The same breaking in procedures should be observed if any of the components mentioned above have to be renewed in the course of the vehicle's operating life.
General driving notes
Closing the trunk lid

Drive with the trunk lid closed
Only drive with the tailgate closed; otherwise, in the event of an accident or braking or evasive maneuvers, passengers or other road users may be injured or the vehicle may be damaged. In addition, exhaust fumes may enter the passenger compartment.
If driving with the tailgate open cannot be avoided:
▶ If the convertible top is closed, close all windows.
▶ Greatly increase the blower speed.
▶ Drive moderately.
Hot exhaust system

Hot exhaust system
High temperatures are generated in the exhaust system.
Do not remove the heat shields installed and never apply undercoating to them. When driving, standing at idle and while parking, take care to avoid possible contact between the hot exhaust system and any highly flammable materials such as hay, leaves, grass, etc. Such contact could lead to a fire, and with it the risk of serious personal injury as well as property damage.
Do not touch hot exhaust pipes; otherwise, there is the danger of getting burned.
Climate control windshield\*

natural_image
Top-down view of a car showing the rearview and side seats with an upward arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols)The marked area is not covered with heat reflective coating.
Use this area for garage door openers, devices for electronic toll collection, etc.
Mobile communication devices in the vehicle

Mobile communication devices in the vehicle
It is advised that you do not use mobile communication devices, e.g., mobile phones, inside the vehicle without connecting them directly to the external antenna. Otherwise, the vehicle electronics and mobile communication devices can interfere with each other. In addition, there is no assurance that the radiation generated during transmission will be discharged from the vehicle interior.
Hydroplaning
On wet or slushy roads, a wedge of water can form between the tires and road surface.
This phenomenon is referred to as hydroplaning. It is characterized by a partial or complete loss of contact between the tires and the road surface, ultimately undermining your ability to steer and brake the vehicle.

Hydroplaning
When driving on wet or slushy roads, reduce your speed to prevent hydroplaning.
Driving through water
Drive though calm water only if it is not deeper than 9.8 inches/25 cm and at this height, no faster than walking speed, up to 6 mph/10 km/h.

Adhere to water depth and speed limitations
Do not exceed this water depth and walking speed; otherwise, the vehicle's engine, the electrical systems and the transmission may be damaged.
Braking safely
Your vehicle is equipped with ABS as a standard feature.
Applying the brakes fully is the most effective way of braking in situations when this is necessary.
The vehicle maintains steering responsiveness. You can still avoid any obstacles with a minimum of steering effort.
Pulsation of the brake pedal and sounds from the hydraulic circuits indicate that ABS is in its active mode.
Objects in the area around the pedals

No objects in the area around the pedals Keep floor mats, carpets, and any other
objects out of the area of motion of the pedals; otherwise, the function of the pedals could be impeded while driving
Do not place additional floor mats over existing mats or other objects.
Only use floor mats that have been approved for the vehicle and can be properly fixed in place.
Ensure that the floor mats are securely fastened again after they were removed for cleaning, for example.
Driving in wet conditions
When roads are wet or there is heavy rain, briefly exert gentle pressure on the brake pedal every few miles.
Ensure that this action does not endanger other road users.
The heat generated in this process helps dry the brake discs and pads.
In this way braking efficiency will be available when you need it.
Hills
Drive long or steep downhill gradients in the gear in which the least braking is required. Otherwise, the brake system may overheat, resulting in a reduction in the brake system efficiency.
Manual transmission:
You can increase the engine's braking effect by shifting down, going all the way to first gear, if necessary.
Automatic transmission*:
You can increase the engine's braking effect by shifting down in the manual mode of the automatic transmission, refer to page 72.

Avoid load on the brakes
Avoid placing excessive load on the brake system. Light but consistent brake pressure can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.

Do not drive in neutral
Do not drive in neutral or with the engine stopped, as doing so disables engine braking. In addition, steering and brake assist is unavailable with the engine stopped.
Brake disc corrosion
Corrosion on the brake discs and contamination on the brake pads are furthered by:
Low mileage.
▶ Extended periods when the vehicle is not used at all.
▶ Infrequent use of the brakes.
Corrosion occurs when the minimum pressure that must be exerted by the pads during brake applications to clean the discs is not reached.
Should corrosion form on the brake discs, the brakes will tend to respond with a pulsating effect that generally cannot be corrected.
Condensation under the parked vehicle
When using the automatic climate control, condensation water develops that exits underneath the vehicle.
Therefore, traces of condensed water under the vehicle are normal.
Loading

Overloading the vehicle
To avoid exceeding the approved carrying capacity of the tires, never overload the vehicle. Overloading can lead to overheating and increases the rate at which damage develops inside the tires. This could result in a sudden loss of tire inflation pressure.

No fluids in the trunk
Make sure that fluids do not leak into the trunk; otherwise, the vehicle may be damaged.
Determining the load limit

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the side panel and seatbelt (no text or symbols visible)- Locate the following statement on your vehicle's placard*:
The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or YYY lbs. Otherwise, damage to the vehicle and unstable driving situations may result. - Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
-
Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or YYY pounds.
-
The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the YYY amount equals 1,000 lbs and there will be four 150 lbs passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 400 lbs: 1,000 lbs minus 600 lbs = 400 lbs.
- Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.
Load

text_image
+ + + + ≦ Max. Load + + ≦ Max. Load + ≦ Max. LoadThe maximum load is the sum of the weight of the occupants and the cargo.
The greater the weight of the occupants, the less cargo that can be transported.
Stowing cargo

natural_image
Side-view cutaway illustration of a sedan showing the driver's seat, dashboard, and engine compartment (no text or symbols)▶ Heavy cargo: stow as far forward and as low as possible, ideally directly behind the cargo area separating wall.
▶ Very heavy cargo: when the rear seat is not occupied, secure each of the outer safety belts in the opposite buckle.
▶ Cover sharp edges and corners.
Securing cargo
Lashing eyes in the cargo area

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel showing front and rear components with directional arrows (no text or symbols)To secure the cargo, there are four lashing eyes in the cargo area
Securing cargo
▶ Smaller and lighter items: secure with retaining straps or with a cargo net* or draw straps.
▶ Larger and heavy objects: secure with cargo straps*.
Cargo straps, cargo netting, retaining straps or draw straps on the lashing eyes in the cargo area.
Securing cargo
Always position and secure the cargo as described above; otherwise, it can endanger the car's occupants if sudden braking or swerving becomes necessary.
Heavy or hard objects should not be carried loose inside the car; otherwise, they could be thrown around as a result of hard braking, sudden swerves, etc., and endanger the occupants.
Saving fuel
General information
Your vehicle contains advanced technology for the reduction of fuel consumption and emissions.
Fuel consumption depends on a number of different factors.
The implementation of certain measures, driving style and regular maintenance can have an influence on fuel consumption and on the environmental impact.
Remove unnecessary cargo
Additional weight increases fuel consumption.
Remove attached parts following use
Attached parts on the vehicle impair the aerodynamics and increase the fuel consumption.
Closing the windows
Open windows increase air resistance and therefore lead to greater fuel consumption.
Check the tire inflation pressure regularly
Check and, if necessary, correct the tire inflation pressure at least twice a month and before starting on a long trip.
Low tire inflation pressure increases rolling resistance and thus raises fuel consumption and tire wear.
Drive away without delay
Do not wait for the engine to warm up while the vehicle remains stationary. Start driving right away, but at moderate engine speeds.
This is the fastest way for the cold engine to reach its operating temperature.
Look well ahead when driving
Avoid unnecessary acceleration and braking.
By maintaining a suitable distance to the vehicle driving ahead of you.
Driving smoothly and looking ahead reduces fuel consumption.
Avoid high engine speeds
Use 1st gear to get the vehicle in motion. Beginning with 2nd gear, accelerate rapidly. When accelerating, shift up before reaching high engine speeds.
When you reach the desired speed, shift into the highest applicable gear and drive with the engine speed as low as possible and at a constant speed.
As a rule: driving at low engine speeds lowers fuel consumption and reduces wear.
The gear shift indicator* of your vehicle indicates the most fuel efficient gear.
Use coasting conditions
When approaching a red light, take your foot off the accelerator and let the vehicle coast to a halt.
On a downhill gradient, take your foot off the accelerator and let the vehicle roll.
The flow of fuel is interrupted while coasting.
Switch off the engine during longer stops
Switch off the engine during longer stops, e.g., at traffic lights, railroad crossings or in traffic congestion.
Fuel savings are achieved after the vehicle is switched off for only approx. 4 seconds.
Switch off any functions that are not currently needed
Functions such as seat heating and the rear window defroster require a lot of energy and consume additional fuel, especially in city and stop-and-go traffic.
Therefore, switch off these functions if they are not actually needed.
Have maintenance carried out
Have vehicles maintained regularly to achieve optimal vehicle economy and operating life.
Have the maintenance carried out by your service center.
Please also note the BMW Maintenance System.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 606 521 - 03 11 490
Navigation
This chapter contains various examples of how the navigation system can guide you reliably to your destination.
Navigation\*
Navigation system
General information
The navigation system can determine the precise position of the vehicle, with the aid of satellites and vehicle sensors, and can reliably guide you to every entered destination.
Navigation data are stored in the vehicle and can be updated.

Entries in stationary vehicle
Enter data only when the vehicle is stationary, and always give priority to the applicable traffic regulations in the event of any contradiction between traffic and road conditions and the instructions issued by the navigation system. Failure to take to this precaution can place you in violation of the law and put vehicle occupants and other road users in danger.
Destination input
Manual destination entry
General information
The system supports you in entering street names and house numbers by automatically completing the entry and providing entry comparisons, refer to page 24.
Stored town/city and street names can be called up quickly.
▶ If the existing entries should not be changed, the entries for the state/province and town/city can be skipped.
Destination guidance is started to the town/city center if no street is entered.
Entering a state/province
-
Press the MENU button.
-
"Navigation"
-
"Enter address"

text_image
Navigation ✓ Enter address Address book Last destinations Points of interest Map Stored trips Route information- Select "State/Province" or the displayed state/province.
Entering a town/city
- Select "Town/City/Postal Code" or the displayed town/city.

text_image
Enter address USA Town/City/Postal Code: (BEVERL Street House number Intersection Accept destination Points of Interest at loc.- Select letters, if necessary.
The list is narrowed down further with each entry.
-
Move the controller to the right.
-
Select the town/city name from the list.
If there are several towns/cities with the same name:
-
Change to the list of town/city names.
-
Highlight the town/city.
-
Select the town/city.
Entering the postal code\*
-
Select "Town/City/Postal Code" or the displayed town/city.
-
Select the symbol.
-
Select the numbers.
- Change to the list of postal codes and towns/cities.
- Highlight the entry.
- Selecting an entry.
Entering a street and intersection
- Select "Street" or the displayed street.
- Enter a street and intersection in the same way as you would enter a town/city.
If there are several streets with the same name:
- Change to the list of street names.
- Highlight the street.
- Select the street.
Alternative: enter the street address and house number
- Select "Street" or the displayed street.
- Enter the street as you would the town/city.
- "House number"
- Select the numbers.
- Change to the list of house numbers.
- Select a house number or range of house numbers.
Street does not exist in the destination city/town
The desired street does not exist in the specified city/town because it belongs to another part of the city/town.
- "Navigation"
- "Enter address"
- Select "Street" or the displayed street.
- Change to the list of street names.
- Select "In" the displayed country.
All streets of the selected state/province are offered. The associated town/city is displayed after the street name.

text_image
In BEVERLY HILLS, CA in UNITED STATES MUSÄUSSTRASSE MUSENBERGSTRASSE MUSEUMSINSEL MUSPELHEIMSTRASSE MUSPILLISTRASSE- Select the letters.
- Change to the list of street names.
- Highlight the street.
- Select the street.
Starting destination guidance after entering the destination
- "Accept destination"
- "Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Add a destination as a further destination, refer to page 152.
Address book
Selecting a destination from the address book
- "Navigation"
- "Address book"
Contacts with addresses are displayed if these have been checked as destinations. If the mobile phone* does not display the contacts with addresses, they must first be
checked as a destination, refer to page 217.

text_image
Navigation Enter address ✓ Address book Last destinations Points of Interest Map Stored trips Route information- Select a contact in the list or, if desired, with "A-Z search".
- "Business address" or "Home address"
Storing the destination in the address book
After entering the destination, store the destination in the address book.
- Open "Options".
- "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact"

text_image
Options Switch off control display Address book Display Owner's Manual Navigation Store as new contact Add to existing contact Receive Traffic Info- Select an existing contact, if available.
- "Business address" or "Home address"
- Enter "Last name" and, if necessary, "First name".
- "Store in vehicle"
Storing the position
The current position can be stored in the address book.
- "Navigation"
-
Open "Options".
-
"Store position as contact" or "Add position to contact"

text_image
Options Switch off control display Address book Display Owner's Manual Navigation Store position as contact Add position to contact ✓ Receive Traffic Info- Depending on the selection, choose an existing contact from the list. Select the type of address and enter the first and last name.
- "Store in vehicle"
Editing or deleting an address
- "Navigation"
- "Address book"
- Highlight the entry.
- Open "Options".
- "Edit in Contacts" or "Delete entry"
Using the home address as the destination
The home address must be stored. Specify the home address, refer to page 216.
- "Navigation"
- "Address book"
- "Home"

text_image
Address book Check My contacts address Home Andreas Angela Hans-Juergen Marcus- "Start guidance"
Last destinations
At a glance
The destinations previously entered are stored automatically.
The destinations can be called up and used as a destination for destination guidance.
Calling up the last destination
- "Navigation"
- "Last destinations"

text_image
Navigation Enter address Address book ✓ Last destinations Points of Interest Map Stored trips Route informationStarting destination guidance
- "Navigation"
- "Last destinations"
- Select the destination.
- "Start guidance"
Editing the destination
- "Navigation"
- "Last destinations"
- Highlight the destination.
- Open "Options".
- "Edit destination"
Deleting the last destinations
- "Navigation"
- "Last destinations"
- Highlight the destination.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete entry" or "Delete all last destinations"
Special destinations
Opening the search for special destinations
To select special destinations, e.g., hotels or tourist attractions:
- "Navigation"
- "Points of Interest"
- Select the search function.
Online Search\*
- "Google™ Search"
- Select a special destination.
- Select the symbol.
- "Start guidance"
A-Z search
- "A-Z search"
- "Town/City"
Select or enter the town/city.
- "Category"
- Select the category.
- "Category details"
For some special destinations, multiple category details can be selected. Move the controller to the left to leave the category details.
- "Keyword"
- Enter the keyword.
A list of the special destinations is displayed.
- Select a special destination.
Details are displayed.
If multiple details are stored, you can leaf through the pages.
If a phone number is available, a connection can be established if necessary.
- Select the symbol.
"Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Add a destination as a further destination, refer to page 152.
"Start search": if a search term is not entered, the search is repeated with the previous search term.
Category search
-
"Category search"
-
"Town/City"
Select or enter the town/city.
-
"Category"
-
Select the category.
-
"Category details"
For some special destinations, multiple category details can be selected. Move the controller to the left to leave the category details.
- "Start search"
A list of the special destinations is displayed.
- Select a special destination.
Details are displayed.
If multiple details are stored, you can leaf through the pages.
If a phone number is available, a connection can be established if necessary.
- Select the symbol.
"Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Add a destination as a further destination, refer to page 152.
Display of special destinations
List of special destinations: special destinations are organized by distance and are displayed with a directional arrow to the special destination.
on the split screen, special destinations of the selected category are displayed in the map view as symbols. The display depends on the scale of the map and the category.
Destination entry via BMW Assist\*
A connection is established to the Concierge service, refer to page 219.
- "Navigation"
- "Enter address"
- Open "Options".
- "BMW Assist dest. entry"
Displaying special destinations in the map
To display symbols of the special destinations in the map view:
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Open "Options".
- "Display Points of Interest"
- Select the setting.
Destination entry by map
Selecting the destination
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
The current position of the vehicle is indicated on the map.
- ☐ "Interactive map"

text_image
12:54 Interactive map 50 m- Select the destination with crosshairs.
To change the scale: turn the controller.
To shift the map: move the controller in the required direction.
To shift the map diagonally: move the controller in the required direction and turn it.
Specifying the street
If the system does not recognize a street, one of the following is displayed:
The name of a street in the vicinity.
The county.
The coordinates of the destination.
Additional functions
Additional functions are available on the interactive map after the controller is pressed.

text_image
Selected position 48°08'10"O 11°34'36"N Exit interactive map View in northern direction Display destination Display current location Find points of interest▶ Select the symbol.
"Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Add a destination as a further destination, refer to page 152.
▶ "Exit interactive map": return to the map view.
▶ "View in northern direction" or "View in driving direction"
▶ "Display destination": the map section around the destination is displayed.
▶ "Display current location": the map section around your current location is displayed.
▶ "Find points of interest": the search for special destinations is started.
Destination entry by voice\*
General information
▶ Instructions for voice activation system, refer to page 25.
When making a destination entry by voice, you can change between voice operation and iDrive.
To have the available spoken instructions read out loud: »Voice commands«
Saying the entries
▶ the town/city, street, and house number can be entered as a single command*.
Countries, towns and cities, streets, and intersections can be said as whole words* or spelled in the language of the system, refer to page 80.
Example: to enter a town/city in a US state as a whole word, the language of the system must be English.
▶ Spell the entry if the spoken language and the language of the system differ.
▷ Say the letters smoothly, and avoid exaggerating the pronunciation and inserting lengthy pauses between the letters.
The options available for entering data depend on the navigation data and the country and language settings.
entering an address using a command\*

Press the button on the steering
-
Enter address
- Wait for a request from the system.
- Say the address in the suggested order.
- Continue making the entry as prompted by the system.
If necessary, individually name the separate components of the address, e.g., the town/city.
Entering a town/city separately
The name of the town/city can be said as a word* or spelled out.
With the destination entry menu displayed:

he button on the steering
-
City< or >Spell city<.
-
Wait for the system to prompt you for the town/city.
-
Say the name of the town/city, or say at least the first three letters. Depending on the entry, up to 20 towns/cities may be suggested.
-
Select the town/city.
To select a recommended town/ city: >Yes
To select a different town/city: »New entry«
▶ Select an entry: >Entry ...< e.g., entry 2
To spell an entry: >Spell city
- Continue making the entry as prompted by the system.
If there are several towns/cities with the same name:
Towns/cities of the same name are grouped in a list and displayed as one location followed by an ellipsis.
-
Select an entry: >Yes< or >Entry ...< e.g., Entry 2.
-
Select the desired town/city.
Entering a street or intersection separately
Enter a street and intersection in the same way as you would enter a town/city.
Entering a house number separately
Depending on the data in the navigation system, house numbers up to number 2000 can be entered.
-
House number
- Say the house number.
Say each digit separately. - Continue making the entry as prompted by the system.
Planning a trip with intermediate destinations
New trip
A trip can be planned with several intermediate destinations.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Move the controller to the left if necessary.
- "Guidance"
- "Enter new destination"
- Select the type of destination entry.

text_image
New destination Enter address using: Enter address Address book Last destinations Points of Interest Interactive map-
Enter the intermediate destination.
-
"Start guidance"
Entering intermediate destinations
For a trip, a max. of 30 intermediate destinations can be entered.
- "Enter new destination"
- Select the type of destination entry.
- Enter the intermediate destination.
- "Add as another destination"
The intermediate destination is entered in the destination list and is highlighted. - Turn the controller until the intermediate destination is located in the desired position in the list.
- Press the controller.
Starting the trip
-
After all intermediate destinations are entered, highlight the first destination. If the second destination, for example, is highlighted when destination guidance is started, the first destination is skipped.
-
"Start guidance"
This symbol marks the active leg of the trip.
Store the trip
Up to 30 trips can be stored in the trip list. If necessary, delete existing trips to be able to store new trips.
- Open "Options".
- "Store trip"
- Enter the name.
- "OK"
Select the stored trip
- "Navigation"
- "Stored trips"
- Select a stored trip.
- "Start guidance"
Reversing the direction of travel
Intermediate destinations are displayed in reverse order in the list.
- "Map"
- "Guidance"
- Open "Options".
- "Reverse order of trip dest."
Intermediate destination options
- "Map"
- "guidance"
- "Display all trip destinations"
- Select an intermediate destination.
▶ "Edit destination"
▶ "Reposition dest. in the trip": move an intermediate destination to another position in the list.
▶ "Delete dest. in the trip"
▶ "Go to next dest. in the trip"
Some options are not available for certain trips.
Delete the stored trip
- "Stored trips"
- Highlight the desired trip.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete all trips" or "Delete trip"
Open the last trip
- "Navigation"
- "Stored trips"
- "Last trip"
- "Start guidance"
Destination guidance
Starting destination guidance
- "Navigation"
- Make a destination entry, refer to page 146.
- "Accept destination"
- "Start guidance"
The route is shown on the Control Display.
The distance to the destination/intermediate destination and the estimated time of arrival are displayed in the map view.
The arrow view is shown in the instrument cluster, in the Head-up Display*, and on the Control Display where appropriate.
Terminating destination guidance
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- "Guidance"
- "Stop guidance"
Continuing destination guidance
If the destination was not reached during the last trip, destination guidance can be resumed.
"Resume guidance"
Route criteria
General information
The route calculated can be influenced by selecting certain criteria.
The route criteria can be changed when the destination is entered and during destination guidance.
Road types are part of the navigation data and are taken into consideration when planning a route, e.g., avoid highways.
The recommended route may differ from the route you would take based on personal experience.
The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
▶ Destination guidance with traffic bulletins, refer to page 159.
Changing the route criteria
-
"Navigation"
-
"Map"
-
☎ / "Route preference"
-
Select the criterion:
▶ "Fast route": time-optimized route, being a combination of the shortest possible route and the fastest roads.
▶ "Efficient route": optimized combination of the fastest and shortest route.
▶ "Short route": short distance, irrespective of how fast or slow progress will be.
▶ "Alternative routes": if available, alternative routes are suggested during active route guidance. The individual suggestions are highlighted in color.

text_image
Route preference ✓ Fast route Efficient route Short route 10:17 44 km Alternative routes 10:24 36 km 10:27 50 km- Specify additional criteria for the route, if necessary:
▶ "Avoid highways": highways are avoided wherever possible.
▶ "Avoid toll roads": toll roads are avoided wherever possible.
▶ "Avoid ferries": ferries are avoided where possible.
Route
Different views of the route are available during destination guidance:
▶ Arrow view in the instrument cluster and on the Control Display.
▷ List of route sections.
▶ Map view, refer to page 155.
▶ Arrow view in the Head-up Display*, refer to page 121.
Arrow view
The following information is displayed during destination guidance:
▶ Large arrow: current direction of travel.
▶ Small arrow: indicates the next change in direction.
▶ Intersection view.
▶ Lane information.
▶ Traffic bulletins.
Distance to the next change in direction.
▷ Street name at the next change in direction.
Lane information
On multi-lane roads, the recommended lanes are marked in the arrow view by a triangle.
Solid triangle: best lane.
▶ Empty triangle: possible lane. However, another lane change may be needed shortly.
Displaying list of route sections
When the destination guidance is started, a list of route sections can be displayed. The driving distances and traffic bulletins are displayed for each route section.
- "Navigation"
- "Route information"
- Mark route section.
The route section is displayed on the split screen.
Bypassing a section of the route
Calculate a new route for a route section.
- "Navigation"
- "Route information"
- "New route for"

text_image
Route information New route for- Turn the controller. Enter the number of kilometers within which you would like to return to the original route.
- Press the controller.
Resuming the original route
If the route section should no longer be bypassed:
- "Navigation"
- "Route information"
- "New route for:"
- "Remove blocking"
Gas station recommendation
The remaining range is calculated, and if necessary gas stations along the route are displayed.
- "Navigation"
- "Route information"
- "Recommended refuel"
A list of the gas stations is displayed. - Highlight a gas station.
The position of the gas station is displayed on the split screen. -
Select the gas station.
-
Select the symbol.
- "Start guidance": destination guidance to the selected gas station is started.
"Add as another destination": the gas station is added to the route.
Switching spoken instructions on/off
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- "Voice instructions"
Repeating spoken instructions
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Highlight the symbol.
- Press the controller twice.
Volume of spoken instructions
Turn the volume button while giving an instruction until the desired volume is set.
Saving the spoken instructions on the programmable memory buttons
The function for switching the spoken instructions on/off can be stored on a programmable memory button, refer to page 23, for quick access.
Map view
Selecting the map view
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
At a glance

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 VI 4:17 65 km 10 km N 3:24 -11 Function bar
2 Route section with traffic obstruction
3 Traffic sign for traffic obstruction
4 Planned route
5 Current location
6 Upper status field
7 Lower status field
Lines in the map
Streets and routes are displayed in different colors and styles depending on their classification. Dashed lines represent railways and ferry connections. Country borders are indicated by thin lines.
Traffic obstructions
Small triangles along the planned route indicate route sections with traffic obstructions, depending on the map scale. The direction of the triangles indicates the direction of the obstruction.
The traffic signs indicate the significance of the obstruction.
▶ Red traffic sign: the obstruction affects the planned route or direction.
▶ Gray traffic sign: the obstruction does not affect the planned route or direction.
Traffic bulletins, refer to page 157.
Planned route
After destination guidance is started, the planned route is displayed on the map.
Status fields
Show/hide: press the controller.
▶ Upper status field: time, telephone, and entertainment details.
▶ Lower status field: symbol for active destination guidance, status of traffic bulletins, time of arrival, and distance to destination.
Function bar
The following functions are available in the function bar:
Symbol Function
Start/end destination guidance.
Switch spoken instructions on/off.
Change the route criteria.
Search for a special destination.
⚠️ Display the traffic bulletins.
Interactive map.
Ⓐ Ⓓ Set the map view.
Q+ Change the scale.
To change to the function bar, move the controller to the left.
Changing the map section
⊕ "Interactive map"
To shift the map: move the controller in the required direction.
To shift the map diagonally: move the controller in the required direction and turn it.
Changing the scale
- Select the symbol.
- To change the scale: turn the controller.
Automatically scaled map scale
In the map view facing north, turn the controller in any direction until the AUTO scale is displayed. The map shows the entire route between the current location and the destination.
Settings for the map view
The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Open "Options".
- "Settings"
Set the map view.
▶ "Day/night mode"
Select and create the necessary settings depending on the light conditions.
"Traffic conditions/gray map" active: the setting is disregarded.
▶ "Satellite images"
Depending on availability and resolution, satellite images* are displayed in a scale of approx. 1 mile to 600 miles/2 km to 1,000 km.
▶ "Perspective view in 3D"
Prominent areas that are contained in the navigation data are displayed on the map in 3D.
▶ "Traffic conditions/gray map"
The map is optimized for displaying traffic bulletins, refer to page 157. Symbols for the special destinations are no longer displayed.
Map view for split screen
The map view can be selected for the split screen independently from the main screen.
- Open "Options".
- "Split screen"
- Move the controller to the right repeatedly until the split screen is selected.
- Select "Split screen content" or the scale.
- Select the map view.
▶ "Arrow display"
▶ "Map facing north"
▶ "Map direction of travel"
▶ "Map view with perspective"
"Position"
"Exit ramp view": selected blind driveways are displayed three dimensionally. Setting in some cases will affect the display in the Head-Up Display*.
▶ "Traffic conditions/gray map"
- To change the scale: select the split screen and turn the controller.
Traffic bulletins\*
At a glance
▶ Display the traffic bulletins from radio stations that broadcast the TI Traffic Information of a traffic information service. Information on traffic obstructions and hazards is updated continuously.
Certain BMW models equipped with navigation have the capability to display real-time traffic information. If your system has this capability the following additional terms and conditions apply:
An End-User shall no longer have the right to use the Traffic Data in the event that the End-User is in material breach of the terms and conditions contained herein.
A. Total Traffic Network, a division of Clear Channel Broadcasting, Inc. ("Total Traffic Network") holds the rights to the traffic incident data and RDS-TMC network through which it is delivered. You may not modify, copy, scan or use any other method to reproduce, duplicate, republish, transmit or distribute in any way any portion of traffic incident data. You agree to indemnify, defend and hold harmless BMW of North America, LLC. ("BMW NA") and Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc (and their affiliates) against any and all claims, damages, costs or other expenses that arise directly or indirectly out of (a) your unauthorized use of the traffic incident data or the RDS-TMC network, (b) your violation of this directive and/or (c) any unauthorized or unlawful activities by you in connection herewith.
B. Total Traffic Network traffic data is informational only. User assumes all risk of use. Total Traffic Network, BMW NA, and their suppliers make no representations about content, traffic and road conditions, route usability, or speed.
C. The licensed material is provided to licensee “as is,” and “where is”. Total Traffic Network, including, but not limited to, any and all third party providers of any of the licensed material, expressly disclaims, to the fullest extent permitted by law, all warranties or representations with respect to the licensed material (including, without limitation, that the licensed material will be error-free, will operate without interruption or that the traffic data will be accurate), express, implied or statutory, including, without limitation, the implied warranties of merchantability, non-infringement fitness for a particular purpose, or those arising from a course of dealing or usage of trade.
D. Neither Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc. or BMW NA will be liable to you for any indirect, special, consequential, exemplary, or incidental damages (including, without limitation, lost revenues, anticipated revenues, or profits relating to the same) arising from any claim relating directly or indirectly to use of the traffic data, and even if Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc., or BMW NA are aware of the possibility of such damages. These limitations apply to all claims, including, without limitation, claims in contract and tort (such as negligence, product liability and strict liability). Some states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, so those particular limitations may not apply to you.
The traffic bulletins are indicated on the map by symbols.
The traffic bulletins for the surrounding area are stored in a list.
The symbol in the function bar of the map view turns red if there are traffic bulletins that affect the calculated route.
Switching the reception on/off
- "Navigation"
- Open "Options".
- "Receive Traffic Info"
Open the traffic bulletins
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- "Traffic Info"
First the traffic bulletins for the calculated route are displayed.
The traffic bulletins are sorted by their distance from the current position of the vehicle.

- Select a traffic bulletin.
"More information": display additional information. - Scroll to the next or previous traffic bulletin if required.
Traffic bulletins on the map
"Traffic conditions/gray map" Active: indication on the control display is switched to shades of gray. This enables a better view of the traffic bulletins. The day/night mode is disregarded in this setting. Symbols and special destinations are not displayed.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Open "Options".
- "Settings"
- "Traffic conditions/gray map"
Symbols in the map view
Depending on the scale of the map and the location of the traffic obstruction along the route, the symbols for the traffic obstructions are displayed.
Additional information in the map view
Depending on the map scale, a traffic obstruction's length, direction, and impact are displayed
in the map using triangles or gray bars along the calculated route.
Red: congestion.
Orange: stop-and-go traffic.
▶ Yellow: heavy traffic.
▷ Green: clear roads.
Gray: general traffic bulletins, e.g., construction site.
The displayed information depends on the particular traffic information service.
Filtering traffic bulletins
You can set which traffic bulletins appear on the map.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- Open "Options".
- "Traffic Info categories"
- Select the desired categories.

text_image
Categories ✓ Traffic flow ✓ Roadwork ✓ Closed roads ✓ Traffic disruptionsTraffic bulletins of the selected category are displayed on the map.
▶ Traffic bulletins that are relevant to the route are always shown.
For your own safety, traffic bulletins that notify you of potentially dangerous situations, such as wrong-way drivers, cannot be hidden.
Destination guidance with traffic bulletins
Semi-dynamic destination guidance
When traffic bulletin reception is switched on, semi-dynamic destination guidance is active.
The destination guidance system takes the available traffic information into account. A message is displayed depending on the route, the traffic bulletins, and the possible detour routes.
A detour is suggested in the event of a traffic obstruction. In addition, distance and time differences between the original route and the detour are displayed.
To accept the detour:
"Detour"
In the event of special hazards, e.g., objects on the road, a message is displayed without a detour suggestion.
Detours can also be accepted if the traffic messages are called up in the list.
- "Navigation"
- "Map"
- ▲ "Traffic Info"
- "Detour information"
- "Detour"
Dynamic destination guidance
The route is automatically changed in the event of traffic obstructions.
The system does not point out traffic obstructions along the original route.
▶ Traffic bulletins continue to be displayed on the map.
▷ Depending on road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the calculated route may lead through the traffic obstruction.
▶ Dangerous situations are displayed regardless of the setting.
To activate dynamic destination guidance:
- "Navigation"
- Open "Options".
- "Dynamic guidance"
Navigation data
Information on the navigation data
- "Navigation"
- Open "Options".
- "Navigation system version": information on the data version is displayed.
Updating the navigation data
General information
Navigation data and authorization codes are available from your service center. Navigation data are stored in the vehicle and can be updated.
▶ Depending on the data volume, a data update may take several hours.
▶ Update during the trip to preserve battery.
During the update, only the basic functions of the navigation system are available.
The status of the update can be viewed.
The system restarts after the update.
The data carrier with the navigation data can be removed after the update is complete.
Perform an update
- Insert the navigation DVD into the DVD player with the labeled side facing up.
- Follow the instructions on the Control Display.
- Enter the authorization code of the navigation DVD and change the DVD if needed.
After interrupting your trip, follow the instructions on the Control Display.
Viewing the status
-
☐️ Press the button.
-
"Navigation update"
What to do if...
The current transmission position cannot be displayed?
The vehicle is located in an unrecognized region, is in a poor reception area, or the system is currently determining the position. Reception is usually best when you have an unobstructed view of the sky.
The destination without street information is not used for route guidance?
When city has been input, no downtown can be determined.
Input any street in the selected city and start destination guidance.
The destination is not used for route guidance?
The destination data is not contained in the navigation data. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.
▷ Letters for destination input cannot be selected?
The stored data do not contain the data of the destination.
Select a goal that is as close as possible to the original.
▷ Is the map displayed in shades of gray?
"Traffic conditions/gray map" Active: indication on the control display is switched to shades of gray. This enables a better view of the traffic bulletins.
▶ Spoken instructions are no longer output during route guidance in front of intersections?
The area has not yet been fully recorded, or you have left the recommended route and the system requires a few seconds to calculate a new route suggestion.

natural_image
Black and white close-up of piano keys in action, with no visible text or symbols on the keys or background.
text_image
Entertainment The chapter helps assure your enjoyment when receiving radio and television stations and playing CDs, DVDs and tracks from the music collection. Online Edition for Part no. 01-40.2 606 521 - 03 11:490Tone
General information
The sound settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.
Treble, bass, balance, and fader
▶ "Treble": treble adjustment.
▶ "Bass": depth adjustment.
▶ "Balance": left/right volume distribution.
▶ "Fader": front/rear volume distribution.
Setting treble, bass, balance, and fader
- "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings"
- "Tone"

text_image
Radio FM AM Satellite radio Presets Weather band ✓ Tone- Select the desired tone settings.

text_image
Tone Treble - + Bass - + Balance L R Fader F R Equalizer ✓ Surround Volume settings- To adjust: turn the controller.
- To store: press the controller.
Equalizer\*
Setting for individual audio frequency ranges.
Adjusting the equalizer
- "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings"
- "Tone"
- "Equalizer"
- Select the desired setting.

text_image
Equalizer 100 Hz - + 200 Hz - + 500 Hz - + 1 kHz - + 2 kHz - + 5 kHz - + 10 kHz - +- To adjust: turn the controller.
- To store: press the controller.
Multi-channel playback, surround\*
Choose between stereo and multi-channel play-back, surround.
Setting multi-channel playback, surround
- "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings"
- "Tone"
- "Surround"

text_image
Tone Treble - + Bass - + Balance L R Fader F R Equalizer ✓ Surround Volume settingsWhen surround is activated, multi-channel play-back is simulated when a stereo audio track is played.
Volume
▶ "Speed volume": speed-dependent volume control.
▶ "PDC": volume of the PDC signal* compared to the entertainment sound output.
▶ "Gong": volume of the signal, such as the safety belt reminder, compared to the entertainment sound output.
▶ "Microphone": volume of the microphone* during a phone call.
▶ "Loudspeak.": volume of the loudspeakers* during a phone call.
The following volumes are only stored for the respective paired telephone: "Microphone", "Loudspeak.".
Adjusting the volume
- "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings"
- "Tone"
- "Volume settings"
- Select the desired volume setting.

text_image
Volume settings PDC - + + Gong - + + Telephone: Setting possible only during a call. Microphone - + + Loudspeak. - + +- To adjust: turn the controller.
- To store: press the controller.
Resetting the tone settings
- "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings"
- "Tone"
- "Reset"
Opening the tone settings in the Options menu\*
- "CD/Multimedia" or "Radio"
- If necessary, select additional entries, for example, "FM" or "CD/DVD".
- Open "Options".
- "Tone"
- Set the desired tone.
Radio
Controls

text_image
1 MODE FRAME 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 5 4 31 Change entertainment sources
2 Change station/track
3 Programmable memory buttons
4 Volume, on/off
5 Change wave band
Sound output
Switching on/off
When the ignition is switched off: press ON/OFF button on the radio.
Muting
When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running: press the ON/OFF button on the radio.
AM/FM station
Selecting a station
- "Radio"
-
"FM" or "AM"
-
Select the desired station.

text_image
FM Manual CARIVARI ENERGY GONG96.3 ✓ Klassik 100.0 MHz 101.3 MHzAll saved stations are stored for the remote control currently in use.
Changing the station via the button

Press the button.
Storing a station
- "Radio"
- "FM" or "AM"
- Highlight the desired station.

text_image
FM Manual CARIVARI ENERGY GONG96.3 ✓ KLASSIK 100.0 MHz 101.3 MHz- Press the controller for an extended period.
- Select the desired memory location.
The stations are stored for the remote control currently in use.
The stations can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 23.
Selecting a station manually
Station selection via the frequency.
- "Radio"
- "FM" or "AM"
- "Manual"
- To select the frequency: turn the controller.

text_image
FM manual 96 98 100 94 92 MHz 93.3 90 88 102 104 106 108To store the station: press the controller for an extended period.
RDS\*
RDS broadcasts additional information, such as the station name, in the FM wave band. When playing a station with multiple frequencies, the system automatically switches to the frequency with the best reception, if needed.
Switching the RDS on/off
- "Radio"
- "FM"
- Open "Options".
- "RDS"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display FM Display Owner's Manual HD Radio Reception RDS RadioThe setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
HD Radio™ reception\*
Many stations broadcast both analog and digital signals.
License conditions
HD Radio™ technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corp. U. S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD and HD Radio logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.
Activating/deactivating digital radio reception
- "Radio"
- "FM" or "AM"
- Open "Options".
- "HD Radio Reception"
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
H) This symbol is displayed in the status line when the audio signal is digital.
In areas in which the station is not continuously received in digital mode, the playback switches between analog and digital reception. Due to time delayed broadcasting, there may be repetitions or interruptions. In this case, switch off digital radio reception.
Displaying additional information
Some stations broadcast additional information on the current track, such as the name of the artist.
- Select the desired station.
- Open "Options".
- "Station info"
Selecting a substation
☐ This symbol indicates that a main station also broadcasts additional substations. The station name of the main station ends in HD1. Station names of the substations end in HD2, HD3, etc.
- Select the desired station.
- Press the controller.
- Select the substation.
When reception is poor, the substation is muted for several seconds. If reception is interrupted for an extended period, it switches back to the main station.
Weather Band\*
General information
The availability of the Weather Band and the number of available channels can vary depending on the region.
Switching on the Weather Band
- "Radio"
- "Weather band"
- Select the desired channel.
Additional information
Weather Band is a service of the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA). Additional information on the Internet: www.nws.noaa.gov.
Satellite radio\*
General information
The channels are offered in predefined packages. The packages must be enabled by telephone.
Navigation bar overview
Symbol Function


Change the list view.

Select the category.

Direct channel entry

Timeshift

☆Open the My Favorites category/open a favorite.

Manage the favorites.

Traffic Jump
The functions of the navigation bar symbols can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 23.
Managing a subscription
To be able to enable or unsubscribe from the channels, you must have reception. It is usually at its best when you have an unobstructed view of the sky. The channel name is displayed in the status line.
Enabling channels
The Unsubscribed Channels category contains all disabled channels.
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- "Category"

text_image
Satellite radio Category Snow Patrol Chasing Cars All channels 001 Sirius Hits 1 ✓ 002 StarLite 003 Sirius Love 004 Movin EZ- Select the Unsubscribed Channels category.
- Select the desired channel. The phone number and an electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.
- Select the phone number to have the channel enabled.

text_image
Subscribe to Sirius Call Sirius to subscribe. ESN: 020 373 371 411 1 888-539-SIRIUSYou can unsubscribe from the channels again via this phone number.
Unsubscribing from channels
- "Radio"
-
"Satellite radio"
-
Open "Options".
- "Manage subscription"

text_image
Options Store channel Satellite radio Display Owner's Manual Manage subscription Set jump Radio Select rear source- The phone number and an electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.
- Call Sirius to unsubscribe from the channels.
Selecting channels
You can only listen to enabled channels.
The selected channel is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Via iDrive
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- Select "All channels" or the desired category.
- Select the desired channel.

text_image
Satellite radio Snow Patrol Chasing Cars All channels 001 Sirius Hits 1 ✓ 002 StarLite 003 Sirius Love 004 Movin EZVia the buttons on the center console

Press the button.
The next channel is selected.
Via direct channel entry
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- "Set channel"
- Turn the controller until the desired channel is reached and press the controller.
Storing a channel
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- If necessary, open "All channels" or the desired category.
- Select the desired channel.
- Press the controller again.
- Press the controller again to confirm the highlighted channel.

text_image
Store Store in presets 001 Sirius Hits 1 Store in favorites The Fray: Over My Head (Cable...- Select the desired memory location.
The channels are stored for the remote control currently in use.
The channels can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 23.
Changing the list view
The list view changes every time the first symbol on the navigation bar is pressed.
Information on the channel is displayed.
Symbol Meaning

Channel name

Artist

Track
Selecting a category
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- "Category"
- Select the desired category.
Timeshift
Approx. one hour of the program being broadcast on the channel currently being listened to is stored in a buffer. Prerequisite: the signal must be available.
The stored audio track can be played with a delay following the live broadcast. When the buffer is full, the older tracks are overwritten. The buffer is cleared when a new channel is selected.
Opening the timeshift function
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- "Replay - Time shift"

text_image
Replay - Time shift Snow Patrol Chasing Cars -4:07The red arrow shows the current playback position.
The time difference to the live broadcast is displayed next to the buffer bar.
For live transmissions: "live".
Timeshift menu
Symbol Function

Go to the live broadcast

| |Playback/pause

Next track

Previous track
Symbol Function

Fast forward

Reverse

Automatic timeshift deactivated/activated
Automatic timeshift
When the function is activated, audio playback is stopped automatically in the event of:
▶ Incoming and outgoing telephone calls.
▶ Activation of the voice activation system.
▶ Muting.
The audio playback then continues with a time delay.
To activate:
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- 🔒 "Replay - Time shift"
- "Automatic time shift"
To deactivate: Automatic time shift".
Storing favorites
Upto 30 favorites can be stored in the favorites list. Available favorites are artist, track, game, league, and team.
Storing the artist, track, or game
It is only possible to store favorites that are currently being broadcast. The channel information must be available.
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- If necessary, open "All channels" or the desired category.
- Select the desired channel.
- Press the controller again.
- Select the artist, track, or game.
Storing the league or team
Leagues or teams can be added to the favorites from a selection list.
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- ☆+ "Manage favorites"
- "Add sports information"

text_image
Favorites ✓ Activate alert Artists The Fray; Titles Proud Mary (1969) Livin' On A Prayer (1987) Add sports information- Select the league.
- Select "Add all teams" or the desired team.
Opening the favorites
If an activated favorite is played back, the following message appears for approx. 20 seconds: "Favorite alert!".

"Favorites"
Select the symbol while the message is shown.

text_image
Satellite radio Favorite alert! Proud Mary (1969) All Channels Favorites 001 Sirius Hits 1 002 StarLite 003 Sirius Love 004 Movin EZThe displayed favorite is played.
If there is no message, the system changes to theMy Favorites category. All favorites currently being broadcast can be selected from a list.
Managing the favorites
Activating/deactivating the favorites
Favorites can be activated and deactivated globally and individually.
- "Satellite radio"
- ☆+ "Manage favorites"
- Select "Activate alert" or the desired favorites.
The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Deleting favorites
- "Satellite radio"
- "Manage favorites"
- Highlight the desired favorite.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete entry"
Traffic Jump
Traffic and weather information for a selected region is broadcast every few minutes.
Selecting a region
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- Open "Options".
- "Set jump"
- Select the desired region.
The region is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Activating/deactivating the jump
- "Radio"
- "Satellite radio"
- "Jump to:"
Information for the selected region is broadcast as soon as it is available.
A new panel opens.
Canceling the Traffic Jump: "Cancel".
Symbol Meaning
Information will be broadcast shortly.
Information is currently being broadcast.
Select one of the symbols to deactivate Traffic Jump.
Automatic update
About twice a year, Sirius performs an update of the channel names and positions. The update takes place automatically and may take several minutes.
Notes
▶ Reception may not be available in some situations, such as under certain environmental or topographic conditions. The satellite radio has no influence on this.
The signal may not be available in tunnels or underground garages next to tall buildings or near trees, mountains or other powerful sources of radio interference.
Stored stations
General information
It is possible to store up to 40 stations.
Calling up a station
- "Radio"
- "Presets"
- Select the desired station.
Storing a station
The station currently selected is stored.
- "Radio"
-
"Presets"
-
"Store station"

text_image
Presets Store station 1 Hit Radio FM 2 Classic Radio FM 3 Chart Radio FM 4 News Radio FM- Select the desired memory location.
The list of stored stations is stored for the remote control currently in use.
The stations can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 23.
Deleting a station
- "Radio"
- "Presets"
- Select the desired station.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete entry"
CD/multimedia
Controls

text_image
1 2 3 4 MODE FROM 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 51 Change the entertainment source
2 CD/DVD* drive
3 Eject CD/DVD
4 Change station/track
5 Programmable memory buttons
6 Volume, on/off
Sound output
Switching on/off
When the ignition is switched off: press ON/OFF button on the radio.
Muting
When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running: press the ON/OFF button on the radio.
CD/DVD\*
Playback
Filling the CD/DVD\* player
Insert the CD/DVD with the printed side up.
Playback begins automatically.
Reading can take a few minutes with compressed audio files.
Starting playback
A CD/DVD is located in the CD/DVD player or DVD changer*.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the desired CD or DVD.

text_image
CD/DVD ✓ Best off Brothers in arms CD-Rom Mezzanine Reload Beautiful Black Market MusicSymbol Meaning
CD/DVD* player
©1 ... ©DVD changer*
playable formats
DVD: DVD-ROM, DVD-R, DVD+R, DVD-RW, DVD+RW, DVD-R DL, DVD+R DL, DVD audio (video part only), DVD video*.
CD: CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, CD-DA, VCD*, SVCD*.
▶ Compressed audio files: MP3, WMA, AAC*, M4A*.
Audio playback
Selecting the track using the button

Press the button repeatedly until the desired track is played.
Selecting a track via iDrive
Audio CDs

text_image
Audio CD Bruce Springsteen Magic 00:28 01/14 Store in vehicle Nowhere You'll Be Comin' Down Livin' In The FutureSelect the desired track to begin playback.
CDs/DVDs\* with compressed audio files
Depending on the data, some letters and numbers of the CD/DVD may not be displayed correctly.
- Select the directory if necessary.
To change to a higher level directory: move the controller to the left.

text_image
CD Santana Supernatural 00:38 — 223/249 Prince ✓ Santana Sportfreunde Stiller Tom Jones- Select the desired track to begin playback.

text_image
CD Santana Supernatural 00:08 223/249 Store in vehicle (Da Le) Yaleo ✓ Africa Bamba Corazon Espinado (Fe...Displaying information on the track

text_image
CD Santana Supernatural 00:38 223/249 Prince ✓ Santana Sportfreunde Stiller Tom JonesIf information about a track has been stored, it is displayed automatically:
▷ Interpret.
▶ Album track.
▶ Number of tracks on the CD/DVD*.
▶ File name of track.
Random playback
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the desired CD or DVD*.
- Open "Options".
- "Random"

text_image
Options Switch off control display CD Display Owner's Manual CD/Multimedia Select rear source □ Random Music data import/exportCDs/DVDs* with compressed audio files: All tracks in the selected directory are played in random order.
Random mode is switched off when the audio source is changed and the ignition is switched off.
Fast forward/reverse

Press and hold the button.
Automatic repeat\*
The selected CDs or DVDs are repeated automatically.
Video playback\*
Country codes
Only DVDs with the code of the home region can be played back; also refer to the information on the DVD.
Code Region
1 USA, Canada
2 Japan, Europe, Middle East, South Africa
3 Southeast Asia
4 Australia, Central and South America, New Zealand
5 Northwest Asia, North Africa
6 China
0 All regions
Playback
The video image is displayed on the front Control Display up to a speed of approx. 2 mph/3 km/h; in some countries, it is only displayed if the parking brake is set or if the automatic transmission is in position P.
DVD video
-
"CD/Multimedia"
-
"CD/DVD"
-
Select a DVD with video content.
- DVD "DVD menu"

text_image
DVD menuVCD/SVCD
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select a CD with video content.
- "Select track"
- Select the desired track.
Video menu
To open the video menu: turn the controller during playback.
Press the controller when "Back" is displayed.
Symbol Function

Open the DVD menu.

Start playback.

Pause

Stop

Next chapter

Previous chapter

Fast forward

Reverse
In fast forward/reverse: the speed increases every time the controller is pressed. To stop, start playback.
DVD menu
-
If necessary, turn the controller to open the video menu.
-
"DMP menu"
The DVD menu is displayed. The display depends on the contents of the DVD.
- To select menu items: move the controller and press it.
To change to the video menu: turn the controller and press it.
DVD/VCD settings
For some DVDs, settings can only be made via the DVD menu; refer also to the information on the DVD.
Selecting the language\*
The languages that are available depend on the DVD.
- Turn the controller during playback.
- Open "Options".
- "Audio/language"

text_image
Options Switch off control display DVD video Display Owner's Manual Audio/language Subtitles Display settings Additional options- Select the desired language.
Selecting the subtitles\*
The subtitles that are available depend on the DVD.
- Turn the controller during playback.
-
Open "Options".
-
"Subtitles"
- Select the desired language or "Do not display subtitles".

text_image
Subtitles Do not display subtitles ✓ German EnglishSetting the brightness, contrast and color
- Turn the controller during playback.
- Open "Options".
- "Display settings"
- "Brightness", "Contrast" or "Color"

text_image
Display settings Brightness Contrast Color- Turn the controller until the desired setting is reached and press the controller.
Selecting the zoom
Display the video image on the entire screen.
- Turn the controller during playback.
-
Open "Options".
-
"Additional options"
- "Zoom mode"

text_image
Options □ Zoom mode Select title Viewing angle Main menu BackSelecting a track
DVD video:
- Turn the controller when the DVD menu is displayed.
- Open "Options".
- "Additional options"
- "Select title"
- Select the desired track.
VCD/SVCD:
- "Select track"
- Select the desired track.
Selecting the camera angle\*
The availability of a different camera angle depends on the DVD and the current DVD track.
- Turn the controller during playback.
- Open "Options".
- "Additional options"
- "Viewing angle"
- Select the desired camera angle.
Opening the main menu, back
These functions are not contained on every DVD. Therefore, they may not be available for use.
DVD changer\*
In the glove compartment

natural_image
Close-up of a car interior showing the backrest door and internal air vent (no text or symbols visible)Pull the handle.
Controls and displays

text_image
1 2 3 4 2 5 DVD LOAD1 Empty DVD compartments
2 LED on DVD slot
3 Buttons for DVD compartments
4 DVD slot
5 Fill DVD compartments
Filling the DVD compartments individually

he button.
The LED on the first empty compartment flashes.
- Select another compartment if necessary.
- Wait for the LEDs on the DVD slot to flash.
- Insert a single CD or DVD in the middle.
The CD/DVD is drawn in automatically and placed into the selected compartment.

Sliding in CDs/DVDs
Do not insert the CD/DVD until the LEDs on the DVD slot are flashing; otherwise, the CD/DVD or the DVD changer could be damaged.
Do not continue to push on the CD/DVD; this may cause it to jam and prevent it from being able to eject again.
Filling all empty DVD compartments
- LOAD Hold the button down.
The LEDs on the empty CD compartments flash.
- Wait for the LEDs on the DVD slot to begin flashing and then insert each CD or DVD into the center of the slot.
The CDs/DVDs are drawn in automatically and placed into the vacant compartments.
Sliding in CDs/DVDs
Do not insert the CD/DVD until the LEDs on the DVD slot are flashing; otherwise, the CD/DVD or the DVD changer could be damaged.
Do not continue to push on the CD/DVD; this may cause it to jam and prevent it from being able to eject again.
After they are inserted, it may take several minutes for the CDs/DVDs to be read in.
Removing a single CD/DVD
-
Press the button.
-
Select the DVD compartment. The CD/DVD is partially ejected.
-
Remove the CD/DVD.
Removing all CDs/DVDs
-
the button down.
-
Remove the CDs/DVDs.
Malfunctions
If all LEDs on the DVD changer are flashing rapidly, a malfunction has occurred.
To eliminate the malfunction:
- Press one of the buttons:

The CD/DVD last inserted is ejected.
- Remove the CD/DVD.
The DVD changer is functional again after the LEDs stop flashing rapidly.
Audio playback\*
The audio track of a DVD can be played back even if video playback is not possible in the vehicle.
Only the main film without the previews or extras can be played back.
Starting playback
A DVD is located in the DVD changer.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the desired DVD.
Selecting a chapter using the button

Press the button repeatedly until the desired chapter is played.
Selecting a chapter using iDrive
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the desired DVD.
- Select the desired chapter.
Fast forward/reverse

Press and hold the button.
Selecting the language\*
The languages that are available depend on the DVD.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the desired DVD.
- Open "Options".
- "Audio/language"
- Select the desired language.
Notes
CD/DVD player and changer

Do not remove the cover BMW CD/DVD players and changers are officially designated Class 1 laser products. Do not operate if the cover is damaged; otherwise, severe eye damage may occur.
CDs and DVDs

Use of CDs/DVDs
Do not use self-recorded CDs/DVDs with labels applied, as these can become detached during playback due to heat buildup and can cause irreparable damage to the device.
▶ Only use round CDs/DVDs with a standard diameter of 4.7 in/12 cm and do not play CDs/DVDs with an adapter, e.g., single CDs; otherwise, the CDs or the adapter may jam and no longer eject.
Do not use combined CDs/DVDs, e.g., DVD Plus, as the CDs/DVDs can jam and will no longer eject.
General malfunctions
CD/DVD changers and players have been optimized for performance in vehicles. In some instances they may be more sensitive to faulty CDs/DVDs than stationary devices would be.
▶ If a CD/DVD cannot be played, first check whether it has been inserted correctly.
Humidity
High levels of humidity can lead to condensation on the CD/DVD or the laser's scan lens, and temporarily prevent playback.
Malfunctions involving individual CDs/DVDs
If malfunctions occur only with particular CDs/DVDs, this can be due to one of the following causes:
Home-recorded CDs/DVDs
Possible reasons for malfunctions with home-recorded CDs/DVDs are inconsistent data creation or recording processes, or poor quality or old age of the blank CD/DVD.
▶ Only label CDs/DVDs on the upper side with a pen intended for this purpose.
Damage
- Avoid fingerprints, dust, scratches and moisture.
Store CDs/DVDs in a sleeve.
Do not subject CDs/DVDs to temperatures over 122 °F/50 °C, high humidity or direct sunlight.
CDs/DVDs with copy protection
CDs/DVDs are often provided with a copy protection feature by the manufacturer. This can mean that some CDs/DVDs cannot be played or can only be played to a limited extent.
MACROVISION
This product contains copyrighted technology that is based on multiple registered US patents and the intellectual property of the Macrovision Corporation and other manufacturers. The use of this copy protection must be approved by Macrovision. Media protected by this product - unless otherwise agreed with Macrovision - may only be used for private purposes. Copying of this technology is prohibited.
DTS Digital Surround™

Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Numbers: 5,451,942;
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,487,535 & and other patents granted and registered in the USA and worldwide. DTS and the logo are registered trademarks & DTS Digital Surround and the DTS logos are trademarks of DTS Inc. © DTS, Inc. All rights reserved.
Music collection\*
Storing music
General information
Music tracks from CDs/DVDs and USB devices can be stored in the music collection on a hard disc in the vehicle and played from there.
▶ Audio CD: tracks are converted into a compressed audio format. If available, information on the album, such as the artist, is stored as well.
CD/DVD or USB device with compressed audio files: the entire content of the CD/DVD or the USB device is stored in the vehicle as an album. The WMA, MP3, M4A*, and AAC* formats are stored. Individual tracks and directories can be deleted later, Deleting a track and directory, refer to page 183.
Tracks with DRM copy protection can be stored but cannot be played back.

Backing up music data
Regularly back up the music data; otherwise, it could be lost if there is a fault on the hard disk.

Music recognition technology and related data are provided by Gracenote®.
Gracenote is the industry standard in music recognition technology and related content delivery. For more information, please visit www.gracenote.com.
CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright © 2000-2009 Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright © 2000-2009 Gracenote.
This product and service may practice one or more of the following U.S. Patents: #5,987,525; #6,061,680; #6,154,773, #6,161,132, #6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6,240,459, #6,330,593, and other patents issued or pending. Some services supplied under license from Open Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.
Storing from a CD/DVD
- Insert a CD or DVD into the CD/DVD player.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the symbol for the CD/DVD player.
- "Store in vehicle"

text_image
Audio CD Unknown artist Unknown album 00:28 ———— 01/14 Store in vehicle Title 01 Title 02 Title 03The music collection is displayed and the first track of the CD/DVD is played back. During the storage process, the tracks are played in sequence.
Observe the following during the storage process:
Do not switch to the CD/DVD player and do not remove the CD/DVD from the CD/DVD player as this will interrupt the storage process. You can switch to the other audio sources without interrupting the storage process. Tracks from the current CD/DVD that have already been stored can be called up.
Interrupting storage
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
3. "Storing..."

text_image
CD/DVD Storing... Best off Brothers in arms Mezzanine Audio CD Reload Beautiful4. "Cancel storing"
The storage process is interrupted and can be continued at any time.
Continuing the storage process
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "CD/DVD"
- Select the symbol for the CD/DVD player.
- "Continue storing"
Storage of the CD/DVD continues at the beginning of the track at which storage was interrupted.
Album information
During storage, information such as the name of the artist is stored with the track, if this information is available in the vehicle database or on the CD.
To update the database, contact your service center.
Storing from a USB device
To store music, a suitable device must be connected to the USB interface in the glove compartment.
Suitable devices: USB mass storage devices, such as USB flash drives or MP3 players with a USB interface.
Unsuitable devices: USB hard drives, USB hubs, USB memory card readers with multiple inserts, Apple iPod/iPhone. Music from the Apple iPod/iPhone can be played via the USB audio interface in the center armrest.
- Connect the USB device to the USB interface in the glove compartment, refer to page 132.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Open "Options".
- "Music data import/export"
- "Import music (USB)"

text_image
Import/export (USB) Import music (USB) Music collection management Backup music on USB Restore music from USBPlaying music
Music search
All tracks for which additional information has been stored can be accessed by the music search. Tracks without additional information can be called up via the corresponding album, refer to page 182.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- "Music search"

text_image
Music collection Music search Current playback Top 50 Audio-CD 1 Frank USB 1 LIEBLINGSSONGS- Select the desired category.

text_image
Music search Genre? (All genres) All artists All albums All titles Start play New search- Select the desired entry:
▶ Select "A-Z search", refer to page 24, and input the desired entry.
▶ Select the desired entry from the list.
- Select other categories if you wish.
The tracks found are listed in alphabetical order.
Not all categories need to be selected. For example, to search for all tracks by a certain artist, call up that artist only. All of the tracks by that artist are then displayed.
- "Start play"
The list of tracks is repeated automatically.
Restarting the music search
"New search"
Music search using spoken instructions\*
Instructions for the voice activation system, refer to page 25.

-
Press the button on the steering wheel.
-
»Music search«
- Open the desired category, e.g., >Select artist>.
- Say the desired entry in the list.
- Select other categories if you wish.
To select a track directly: >Title ...<.
Say the voice command and the name of the desired track in a single command.
Current playback
The list of tracks that was generated last by the music search, or the album that was selected last.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- "Current playback"

text_image
Music collection Music search Current playback Top 50 50 Audio-CD 1 ✓ Frank USB 1 LIEBLINGSSONGS- Select the desired track, if necessary.
Top 50
The 50 most frequently played tracks.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- "Top 50"
- Select the desired track, if necessary.
Albums
All stored albums, listed in order of their storage dates.
Symbol Format
Audio CD
Compressed audio files
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Select the desired album.
Depending on the album, the tracks or the subdirectories of the album are displayed.
The first track is played automatically, if possible.

text_image
Music collection Music search Current playback Top 50 50 Audio-CD 1 Hits Frank LIEBLINGSSONGS- Change directories if needed to select tracks.
To go up a level in the directory: move the controller to the left.
Random playback
All tracks of the selection are played back in random order.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Open "Options".
- "Random"

text_image
Options Display Owner's Manual Free memory Delete music collection CD/Multimedia Select rear source Random Music data import/exportManaging music
Albums
Renaming an album\*
The name of the album, if available, is automatically entered when the album is stored. If the name is not available, it can be changed later if desired.
- "CD/Multimedia"
-
"Music collection"
-
Highlight the desired album.
- Open "Options".
- "Rename album"

text_image
Options Audio-CD 1 Rename album Delete album Music collection Display Owner's Manual Free memory Delete music collection- Select the letters individually.
Deleting an album
An album cannot be deleted while a track from that album is being played.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Highlight the desired album.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete album"
Deleting a track and directory
A track cannot be deleted while it is being played.
A directory cannot be deleted while a track from that directory is being played.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Highlight the directory or track.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete folder" or "Delete track"
Free memory capacity
Display the free memory capacity in the music collection.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Open "Options".
- "Free memory"
Music collection
Backing up the music collection
The entire music collection can be stored on a USB device. Make sure there is enough free memory capacity on the USB device.
Depending on the number of tracks, backing up the music collection may take several hours. Therefore, it is best to perform the backup during a long trip.
- Starting the engine.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Open "Options".
-
"Music data import/export"
-
Connect the USB device to the USB interface in the glove compartment.

text_image
Options Display Owner's Manual Free memory Delete music collection CD/Multimedia Select rear source Random Music data import/export- "Backup music on USB"

text_image
Import/export (USB) Import music (USB) Music collection management Backup music on USB Restore music from USBStoring the music collection in the vehicle
When storing from the USB device, the existing music collection in the vehicle is replaced.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
-
Open "Options".
-
"Music data import/export"
- "Restore music from USB"
Deleting the music collection
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Music collection"
- Open "Options".
- "Delete music collection"
External devices
At a glance
Symbol Meaning
AUX-IN port
USB audio interface*
Mobile phone audio interface*
Bluetooth audio*
AUX-IN port
At a glance
For connecting audio devices, e.g., MP3 player. The sound is output on the vehicle loudspeakers.
▶ Recommendation: use medium tone and volume settings on the audio device. The tone depends on the quality of the audio files.
Connecting

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever showing the intake compartment and control panel (no text or symbols visible)The AUX-IN port is in the center armrest.
Connect the headphones or line-out connector of the device to the jack plug.
Playback
- Connect the audio device, switch it on and select a track on the audio device.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- If necessary "External devices".
- "AUX front"
Volume
The volume of the sound output is dependent on the audio device. If this volume differs markedly from the volume of the other audio sources, it is advisable to adjust the volumes.
Adjusting the volume
- "CD/Multimedia"
- If necessary "External devices".
- "AUX front"
- "Volume"

text_image
AUX front AUX active Volume - +- Turn the controller until the desired volume is set and press the controller.
USB audio interface\*/mobile phone audio interface\*
At a glance
It is possible to connect external audio devices. They can be operated via iDrive. The sound is output on the vehicle loudspeakers.
Connectors for external devices
▶ Connection via USB audio interface: Apple iPod/iPhone, USB devices, e.g., MP3 play-
ers, USB flash drives, or mobile phones that are supported by the USB audio interface.
▶ Connection via snap-in adapter when equipped with extended connectivity of the music player in the mobile phone: Apple iPhone or mobile phones.
Due to the large number of different audio devices available on the market, it cannot be ensured that every audio device/mobile phone is operable on the vehicle.
Ask your service center about suitable audio devices/mobile phones.
Audio files
Standard audio files can be played back:
MP3.
▷ WMA.
▷ WAV (PCM).
AAC*, M4A*.
▶ Playback lists: M3U, WPL, PLS.
Connection of Apple iPod/iPhone via USB audio interface

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever with a highlighted component (no text or symbols visible)The USB audio interface is in the center armrest. Connect using a flexible adapter cable.

Connect the Apple iPod/iPhone to the USB interface.
The Apple iPod/iPhone menu structure is supported by the USB audio interface.
Connection of a USB device via the USB audio interface

natural_image
Interior view of a car headrest with a white arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)The USB audio interface is in the center armrest.
Connect using a flexible adapter cable to protect the USB audio interface and the USB device against physical damage.

Connect the USB device to the USB interface.
After connecting for the first time
Information on all music tracks, e.g. artist or type of music, as well as playback lists are transmitted into the vehicle. This may take some time, depending on the USB device and the number of tracks.
During transmission, the tracks can be called up via the file directory.
Number of tracks
Information from up to four USB devices or for approx. 36,000 tracks can be stored in the vehicle. If a fifth device is connected or if more than 36,000 tracks are stored, information on existing music tracks may be deleted.
Copy protection
Music tracks with integrated Digital Rights Management (DRM) cannot be played.
Playback
-
"CD/Multimedia"
-
"External devices"
-
Select the or symbol.

text_image
External devices JUKEBOX Handy Gerät AUX frontThe playback starts with the first track.
On the split screen*, the CD cover for the music track might be displayed after a few seconds.
Track search
Selection is possible via:
▶ Playback lists.
▶ Information: type of music, artist, and, if available, composer, album, track.
In addition, for USB devices: file directory and, if available, composer.
Tracks are displayed if they have been saved in the Latin alphabet.
Starting the track search
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
- Select the ♂ or 📋 symbol.
-
"Search"
-
Select the desired category, e.g., "Genre" or "Artist".
All entries are displayed in a list.
▷ Open "A-Z search" and input the desired entry. When a letter is entered, the results are filtered using this letter as the first letter. If multiple letters are entered, all results that contain that sequence are displayed.
▶ Select the desired entry from the list.

text_image
USB audio: JUKEBOX Browse directory Genre? (All genres) All artists All composers All albums All tracks Start play- Select other categories if you wish.
Not all categories need to be selected. For example, if all of the tracks by a certain artist are to be displayed, call up that artist only. All of the tracks by that artist are then displayed.
- "Start play"
Restarting a track search
"New search"
Playback lists
Calling up playback lists.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
- Select the ♂ or 📋 symbol.
- "Playlists"
Current playback
List of tracks currently being played.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
- Select the or symbol.
- "Current playback"
Random playback
The current list of tracks is played back in random order.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
- Open "Options".
- "Random"
Fast forward/reverse

Press and hold the button.
Video playback\*
At a glance
Video playback via snap-in adapter possible. They can be operated via iDrive. The sound is output on the vehicle loudspeakers.
Playback
The video image is displayed on the front Control Display up to a speed of approx. 2 mph/3 km/h; in some countries, it is only displayed if the parking brake is set or if the automatic transmission is in position P.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
- Select the symbol.
- "Video"
- Select the directory if necessary.
To change to a higher level directory: move the controller to the left.
- Select the desired video file to begin play-back.
Video menu
Symbol Function
▷ Next video file
Previous video file
Double-click on an icon to play back previous video file.
Notes
Do not expose the audio device to extreme environmental conditions, such as very high temperatures; refer to the audio device operating instructions.
Depending on the configuration of the audio files, e.g., bit rates greater than 256 kbit/s, the files may not play back correctly in each case.
Information on connection
The connected audio device is supplied with a max. power of 500 mA if supported by the device. Therefore, do not additionally connect the device to a socket in the vehicle; otherwise, playback may be compromised.
Do not use force when plugging the connector into the USB interface.
Do not connect devices such as fans or lamps to the USB audio interface.
Do not connect USB hard drives.
Do not use the USB audio interface to recharge external devices.
Bluetooth audio\*
At a glance
▶ Music files on external devices such as audio devices or mobile phones can be played back via Bluetooth.
Use of a mobile phone as an audio source, refer to page 197.
The sound is output on the vehicle loudspeakers.
The volume of the sound output is dependent on the device. If necessary, adjust the volume on the device.
▶ Up to four external devices can be paired with the vehicle.
Requirements
The device is suitable. Information under www.bmwusa.com/bluetooth.
The device is ready for operation.
The ignition is switched on.
▶ Bluetooth is activated on the vehicle, refer to page 197, and on the device.
Bluetooth presettings must be made on the device, such as for a connection without confirmation or visibility; refer to the device operating instructions.
▶ A number with at least four and a maximum of 16 digits is defined as the Bluetooth pass-key. It is only required once for pairing.
Pairing and connecting

Pairing a device
To avoid becoming distracted and posing an unnecessary hazard both to your own vehicle's occupants and to other road users, only pair the device while the vehicle is stationary.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Bluetooth® (audio)"
- If necessary, "Bluetooth® audio".
- "Add new phone"
The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is displayed.

text_image
Bluetooth® (audio) Add new phone Connected: Handy 1 Paired: Gerät 1- Perform additional steps on the device, refer to the device operating instructions: for instance, search for or connect the Bluetooth device or a new device.
The Bluetooth name of the vehicle appears on the device display.
- Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle on the device display.
Prompt via iDrive or the device to enter the same Bluetooth passkey.
- Enter the passkey and confirm.

text_image
Enter same passkey for vehicle and Bluetooth® phone.- Select the desired functions with which the device is to be connected, for instance "Audio".
- "OK"

text_image
BT function Select function for Bluetooth device: ✓ Telephone ✓ Audio OKIf pairing was successful, the device is displayed as connected.
Whitesymbol ♪ : the device is active as an audio source.
If pairing was unsuccessful: What to do if..., refer to page 190.
Connecting a specific device
A device that has already been paired can be connected as an active audio source.
Connecting is not possible when data is exchanged via a mobile phone connected via Bluetooth.
Requirements
If necessary, activate the audio connection of the desired device from the list of paired devices.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Bluetooth® (audio)"
- If necessary, "Bluetooth® audio".
- Select the desired device from the list of paired devices.
- Open "Options".
- "Configure phone"
- "Audio"
- "OK"
Connecting the device
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Bluetooth® (audio)"
- If necessary, "Bluetooth® audio".
- Select the desired device from the list of paired devices.

text_image
Bluetooth® (audio) Add new phone Connected: Handy 1 Paired: Gerät 1White symbol ♪: the device is active as an audio source.
Playback
General information
The display of music track information depends on the device.
▶ Operation can takes place on the device or iDrive.
▶ Playback is interrupted when data is exchanged via a mobile phone connected via Bluetooth.
Starting playback
- Connect the device.
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "External devices"
4. Select the symbol.

text_image
External devices JUKEBOX Handy Gerat AUX front- Select the desired track from the list, if necessary.
Playback menu\*
Depending on the particular device, some of the functions may not be available.
Symbol Function
▷ Next track
Fast forward: press and hold the symbol.
Previous music track
Reverse: press and hold the symbol.
Disconnecting the audio connection
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Bluetooth® (audio)"
- Highlight the desired device.
- Open "Options".
- "Configure phone"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display Gerät 2 Configure phone Remove phone from list Bluetooth® (audio) Display Owner's Manual- "Audio"
- "OK"
Unpairing a device
- "CD/Multimedia"
- "Bluetooth® (audio)"
- If necessary, "Bluetooth® audio".
- Highlight the device that is to be unpaired.
- Open "Options".
- "Remove phone from list"
What to do if...
Information on suitable devices can be found at www.bmwusa.com/bluetooth.
Suitable mobile phones, refer to page 196.
The device is not supported by the vehicle.
▶ Perform a software update*, refer to page 191, if needed.
The device could not be paired or connected.
Do the Bluetooth passkeys on the device and the vehicle match? Enter the same passkey on the device and via iDrive.
Did it take longer than 30 seconds to enter the passkey? Repeat the pairing procedure.
Are too many Bluetooth devices connected to the device or vehicle? Delete connections with other devices if necessary.
Is the mobile phone in power-save mode or does it have only a limited remaining battery life? Charge the mobile phone in the snap-in adapter or via the charging cable.
▶ Depending on the mobile phone, it is possible that only one device can be connected to the vehicle. Unpair the connected device from the vehicle and pair and connect only one device.
The device no longer reacts? Switch the device off and on again.
▷ Repeat the pairing procedure.
Music cannot be played back.
▶ Start the program for playing back music data on the device and select a track on the device if necessary.
▷ Switch the radio off and on again.
Music files can only be played back softly.
Adjust the volume settings on the device.
Playback is disturbed when buttons are pressed or by other messages on the device.
▶ Switch off the button tones and other signal tones on the device.
Playback is interrupted by a telephone call or traffic bulletin and is not resumed automatically.
▶ Switch the radio off and on again.
Playback is not possible if the mobile phone is connected both via Bluetooth Audio and via the extended connectivity of the music player in the mobile phone*.
▷ Disconnect one of the two connections; for example, disconnect the audio connection, refer to page 190, and restart playback.
If all points in this list have been checked and the required function is still not available, please contact the hotline or service center.
Software Update\*
The vehicle supports various external devices depending on the current software version. With a software update, the vehicle can support new cell phones* or new external devices*.
The updating of the software is done via:
USB*.
Updates and related current information is available at www.bmw.com/update.
▶ TeleService*.
Existing software can be updated directly via the vehicle.
Displaying the current version
The currently installed software is displayed.
- "Settings"
- "Software update"
- "Show current version"
SelectDesired version* to displayAdditional information*.
Updating software via USB\*
The software may only be updated when the vehicle is stationary.
- Store the file for the software-update in the main director of a USB flash drive.
- Insert the USB flash drive into the USB interface of the USB audio interface in the center armrest. An update via the USB interface in the glove compartment is not possible.
- "Settings"
- "Software update"
- "Update software"

text_image
Software update Software update for the support of external devices Show current version Update software Restore previous version- If necessary. "USB".
- "Start update"
- "OK"
All listed software updates are installed.
Updating software via TeleService\*
The software may only be updated when the vehicle is stationary.
- Switch on the ignition.
- "Settings"
- "Software update"
- "Update software"
- If necessary "TeleService".
- If necessary, "Start update".
- "Start update"
- "OK"
All listed software updates are installed.
To interrupt updating: "Cancel".
Restoring the previous version
If it should become necessary, the software version prior to the last software update can be restored.
The previous version may only be restored when the vehicle is stationary.
- "Settings"
- "Software update"
- "Restore previous version"
- "OK" Double-click.
All listed software updates are removed.
Note
While the software is being updated or a previous version is being restoredBMW Assist*, Office functions* and the connected devices are temporarily unavailable. Wait several minutes for the functions to become available again.

text_image
TELEPHONE TELEPHONE Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 606 521 - 03 11 490Communication
All of the options available to you for mobile communication with family, friends, business partners, and service providers are described in this chapter.
Telephone\*
At a glance
The concept
Mobile phones or other external devices such as audio players can be connected to the vehicle via Bluetooth.
After these devices are paired once, they are recognized automatically when the ignition is switched on as soon as they are inside the vehicle and can be operated via iDrive, the buttons on the steering wheel, and via voice activation*.
Depending on their functionality, external devices can be used via the vehicle as a telephone or as an audio source.
The telephone functions are described in the following. Operating the audio functions, refer to page 188.
Up to four external devices can be paired.
Certain functions may need to be enabled by the mobile phone provider or service provider.

Using the mobile phone while driving
Make entries only when traffic and road conditions allow. Do not hold the mobile phone in your hand while you are driving; use the hands-free system instead. If you do not observe this precaution, you can endanger the vehicle occupants and other road users.
Snap-in adapter\*
The snap-in adapter is used to:
Hold the mobile phone.
▶ Recharge the battery.
▷ Connect the mobile phone to an outside antenna of the vehicle.
This provides for better network reception and consistent sound quality.
Approved mobile phones
Details on which mobile phones and external devices with a Bluetooth interface are supported by the mobile phone preparation package can be obtained at www.bmwusa.com/bluetooth.
Displaying the vehicle identification number and software part number
The vehicle identification number and software partnumber are needed to determine which mobile phones are supported by the mobile phone preparation package. The software version of the mobile phone may also be required.
- "Telephone"
- Open "Options".
- "Bluetooth® info"
- "Display system information"
These approved mobile phones with a certain software version, support the vehicle functions described below.
Malfunctions may occur with other mobile phones or software versions.
Do not operate a mobile phone that is connected to the vehicle on the mobile phone keypad, as this may lead to a malfunction.
A software update can be performed if necessary.
Pairing/unpairing the mobile phone
General information
The following functions are available:
▶ Use of a mobile phone as a telephone.
▶ Use of a mobile phone as an additional telephone.
▶ Use of a mobile phone as an audio source.
▶ Use of an audio device as an audio source, refer to page 188.
Requirements
The mobile phone is suitable.
The mobile phone is ready for operation.
▶ Bluetooth is activated in the vehicle and on the mobile phone.
▶ Bluetooth presettings may need to be made on the mobile phone, e.g., for a connection without confirmation or visibility, refer to the mobile phone operating instructions.
▶ Deactivate Bluetooth audio if necessary.
A number with at least four and a maximum of 16 digits was defined as the Bluetooth passkey. It is only required once for pairing.
The ignition is switched on.
Activating/deactivating Bluetooth
Bluetooth is not permitted everywhere. Comply with all safety guidelines and regulations.
- "Telephone"
- Open "Options".
- "Bluetooth®"
Additional functions
General information
Activate the functions before pairing to be able to use them in the vehicle. Information on suitable mobile phones, refer to page 196, that support these functions.
Additional telephone
A mobile phone can be used as an additional telephone.
The additional telephone can be used to accept incoming calls, refer to page 200. While a call is active on the additional telephone, incoming calls are displayed on the Control Display.
Audio source
A mobile phone can be used as an audio source.
Activating/deactivating the additional functions
- "Telephone"
-
"Bluetooth® (phone)"
-
Open "Options".
- Select the desired additional function.
▶ "Additional telephone"
"Office"
▶ "Bluetooth® audio"
Pairing and connecting a device

Pairing a device
To avoid becoming distracted and posing an unnecessary hazard both to your own vehicle's occupants and to other road users, only pair the device while the vehicle is stationary.
- "Telephone"
- "Bluetooth® (phone)"
- "Add new phone"
The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is displayed. - To perform additional steps on the mobile phone, refer to the mobile phone operating instructions: for instance, search for or connect the Bluetooth device or a new device.
The Bluetooth name of the vehicle appears on the mobile phone display. - Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle on the mobile phone display.
Prompt via iDrive or the mobile phone to enter the same Bluetooth passkey. - Enter the passkey and confirm.

text_image
Enter same passkey for vehicle and Bluetooth® phone.-
Select the functions for which the mobile phone is to be used.
-
"OK"
If the pairing was successful, the mobile phone appears at the top of the list of mobile phones.
The functions supported by the mobile phone and audio device are displayed as symbols when paired.
White symbol: the function is active.
Gray symbol: the function is inactive.
Symbol Function

Telephone.

Additional telephone.

Audio source.
Four devices can be paired with the vehicle at once. Three devices can be connected with the vehicle at once.
If pairing was unsuccessful: What to do if..., refer to page 198.
Following the initial pairing
The mobile phone is detected/connected in the vehicle within a short period of time when the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.
The phone book entries of the telephone stored on the SIM card* or mobile phone are transmitted to the vehicle after detection, depending on the mobile phone.
▶ Four devices can be paired.
▶ Specific settings may be necessary in some mobile phones, e.g., authorization or a secure connection; refer to the mobile phone operating instructions.
Connecting a specific device
If more than one device is detected by the vehicle, the device at the top of the list is connected. A different device can be connected by selecting it.
- "Telephone"
- "Bluetooth® (phone)"
- Select the device that is to be connected.
The functions that were assigned to the device before unpairing are assigned to the device
when it is reconnected. If the device is already connected, these functions are deactivated.
Configuring the devices
Additional functions can be activated or deactivated for paired and connected devices.
- "Telephone"
- "Bluetooth® (phone)"
- Highlight the device to be configured.
- Open "Options".
- "Configure phone"
-
At least one function must be selected.
"Telephone"
▶ "Additional telephone"
▷ "Audio" -
"OK"
If a function is assigned to a device, the function will be deactivated where appropriate for a device that is already connected and the device will be unpaired.
Swapping the telephone and additional telephone
The function of the telephone and additional telephone can be swapped automatically.
- "Telephone"
- "Bluetooth® (phone)"
- "Swap phone/addit. phone"
Unpairing a device
- "Telephone"
- "Bluetooth® (phone)"
- Highlight the device that is to be unpaired.
- Open "Options".
- "Remove phone from list"
What to do if...
Information on suitable mobile phones, refer to page 196.
The mobile phone could not be paired or connected.
▷ Is Bluetooth activated in the vehicle and on the mobile phone? Activate Bluetooth in the vehicle and on the mobile phone.
Do the Bluetooth passkeys on the mobile phone and the vehicle match? Enter the same passkey on the mobile phone and via iDrive.
Did it take longer than 30 seconds to enter the passkey? Repeat the pairing procedure.
Are too many Bluetooth devices connected to the mobile phone or vehicle? Delete connections with other devices if necessary.
▷ Is the audio connection activated? Deactivate the audio connection.
Is the mobile phone in power-save mode or does it have only a limited remaining battery life? Charge the mobile phone in the snap-in adapter* or via the charging cable.
▷ Depending on the mobile phone, it is possible that only one device can be connected to the vehicle. Unpair the connected device from the vehicle and pair and connect only one device.
The mobile phone no longer reacts? Switch the mobile phone off and on again. Repeat the pairing procedure.
The telephone functions are not available.
▷ Is the mobile phone paired as an additional telephone and is the additional telephone function deactivated? Activate the function.
Is an outgoing call not possible? Connect the mobile phone as a telephone.
No or not all phone book entries are displayed, or they are incomplete.
▶ Transmission of the phone book entries is not yet complete.
It is possible that only the phone book entries of the mobile phone or the SIM card* are transmitted.
It may not be possible to display phone book entries with special characters.
The number of phone book entries being stored is too high.
Is the data volume of the contact too large, e.g., due to stored information such as notes? Reduce the data volume of the contact.
▷ Is the mobile phone connected as an audio source or additional telephone? The mobile phone must be connected as a telephone.
The phone connection quality is poor.
The strength of the Bluetooth signal on the mobile phone can be adjusted, depending on the mobile phone.
▶ Insert the mobile phone into the snap-in adapter* or place it in the area of the center console.
Adjust the volume of the microphone and loudspeakers separately.
If all points in this list have been checked and the required function is still not available, please contact the hotline or service center.
Controls
Adjusting the volume
Turn the knob until the desired volume is selected. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.
The vehicle automatically adjusts the volume of the microphone on the telephone and the volume of the called party. Depending on the mobile phone, the volumes may need to be adjusted. The settings can only be created during a call and must be adjusted separately for each telephone. The settings are deleted when the telephone is unpaired.
- "Settings"
- "Tone"
- "Volume settings"
- Select the desired setting: "Microphone" or "Loudspeak."
- To adjust: turn the controller.
- To store: press the controller.
Incoming call
Receiving calls
If the number of the caller is stored in the phone book and is transmitted by the network, the name of the contact is displayed. Otherwise, only the phone number is displayed.
If more than one phone number is assigned to a contact, only the name of the contact is displayed.
For calls on the additional telephone, the number is only displayed if it is transmitted by the network.
An incoming call to the additional telephone is automatically rejected if there is an active call on the other telephone.
Accepting a call
Via iDrive
"Accept"

text_image
Incoming call Accept +4989123456789 calling Device: Handy 1Via the button on the steering wheel

Press the button.
Via the instrument cluster\*
"Accept"
Rejecting a call
Via iDrive
% "Reject"
Via the instrument cluster\*
"Reject"
Ending a call
Via iDrive

text_image
Active calls Hang up +4989123456789 00:55"End call"
Via the button on the steering wheel

Press the button.
Via the instrument cluster\*
"End call"
Entering a phone number
Dialing a number
- "Telephone"
- "Dial number"
- Select the digits individually.
- Select the symbol.

text_image
08912 #The phone number can also be entered by voice.
Calls with multiple participants
General information
You can switch between calls or connect two calls to a single conference call. These functions
must be supported by the mobile phone and service provider.
Accepting a call while speaking to another party
This function might have to be activated by the service provider and the mobile phone must be adjusted accordingly.
If a second call comes in during an ongoing call, a call waiting signal is sounded where appropriate.

"Accept"
The call is accepted and the existing call is put on hold.
Establishing a second call
Establish an additional call during an active call.
- "Telephone"
- "Active calls"
- "Hold"
The existing call is put on hold.

text_image
Active calls Hold 23456789 01:03- Dial the new phone number or select it from a list.

"Return"
The call on hold is resumed.
Switching between two calls, hold call
The active call is displayed in color.
The call on hold is displayed in gray.

"Swap calls"
The call on hold is resumed.
Establishing a conference call
Two calls can be connected to a single telephone conference call.
-
Establish two calls.
-
"Conference call"
When terminating a conference call, both calls are ended. If one call is terminated by another party, the other call can be continued.
Switching the microphone to mute
When a call is active, the microphone can be muted.
- "Telephone"
- "Active calls"
- "Microphone mute"
A microphone that has been switched to mute is automatically reactivated:
When a new connection is established.
▶ When switching between call parties.
DTMF suffix dialing
DTMF suffix dialing can be used for gaining access to network services or for controlling devices, e.g., to make a remote inquiry of an answering machine. The DTMF code is needed for this purpose.
- "Telephone"
- Select the contact from a list or "Dial number".
- "Keypad dialing"
- Enter the DTMF code via iDrive.
Phone book
Displays
The phone book accesses the contacts and shows all contacts for which a phone number has been stored. The entries can be selected to make a call.
- "Telephone"
- "Phone book"
A symbol indicates the storage location of the contacts.

text_image
Phone book A-Z search Angi BMW Service Christoph Dr. Tom Mustermann OfficeCalling a contact
| Symbol Meaning | |
| Contact with one stored phone number. | |
| Contact with more than one stored phone number. | |
| Call not possible; mobile phone without reception or network, or Service Request* is active. | |
For contacts with one stored phone number: select the required contact. The connection is being established.
For contacts with more than one stored phone number: select the required contact and the phone number. The connection is being established.
Editing a contact
Changing the entries in "Contacts". When a contact is changed, the changes are not stored on the mobile phone. A copy of the entry is stored in the vehicle.
- Highlight the contact.
- Open "Options".
- "Edit entry"
The contact can be edited.
Redialing
General information
The list of dialed numbers in the mobile phone is transmitted to the vehicle depending on the mobile phone. The 20 phone numbers dialed last are displayed. The sorting order of the phone numbers depends on the particular mobile phone.
Dialing the number via the instrument cluster
This is possible when there is no active call.
- Press the button on the steering wheel.
- Select the desired phone number.
The connection is established.
Dialing a number via iDrive
- "Telephone"
- "Redial"
- Select the desired entry and the phone number if necessary.
The connection is established.
Saving an entry in the contacts
- Highlight the entry.
- Open "Options".
- "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact"
- Select 🔍 "New phone number" or contact.
- Select the type of number: "Home", "Business", "Mobile" or "Other"
- Complete the entries if necessary.
- If necessary, "Store contact in vehicle".
Received calls
Displaying calls
The 20 calls that were last received are displayed.
-
"Telephone"
-
"Received calls"

text_image
Telephone Active calls Phone book Redial ✓ Received calls Dial number Messages Bluetooth® (phone)Calling a number from the list
Selecting an entry.
The connection is established.
Saving an entry in the contacts
- Highlight the entry.
- Open "Options".
- "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact"
- Select 🔍 "New phone number" or contact.
- Select the type of number: "Home", "Business", "Mobile" or "Other"
- Complete the entries if necessary.
- If necessary, "Store contact in vehicle".
Hands-free system
General information
Calls that are being made on the hands-free system can be continued on the mobile phone and vice versa.
From the mobile phone to the hands-free system
Calls that were begun outside of the Bluetooth range of the vehicle can be continued on the hands-free system with the ignition switched on.
Depending on the mobile phone, the system automatically switches to the hands-free system.
If the system does not switch over automatically, follow the instructions on the mobile phone display; refer also to the mobile phone operating instructions.
From the hands-free system to the mobile phone
Calls that are made on the hands-free system can in some cases be continued on the mobile phone; this depends on the mobile phone.
Follow the instructions on the mobile phone display; refer also to the mobile phone operating instructions.
Voice operation\*
Vehicles equipped with the voice activation system: operation, refer to page 25.
Vehicles not equipped with the voice activation system: depending on the equipment, the mobile phone can be voice operated as described below.
The list of short commands in the operating manual does not apply to this type of voice operation.
The concept
The mobile phone can be operated without taking your hands from the steering wheel.
In many cases, the entries are accompanied by announcements or questions.
▷ >...< Verbal instructions for voice operation.
Using voice activation
Activating the voice activation system
-
Briefly press the button on the steering wheel.
-
Say the command.
Terminating the voice activation system
Briefly press the button on the steering wheel or >Cancel.
Possible commands
Having possible commands read aloud
Press the button. »Help«. Possible commands are announced.
The digits from zero to nine are recognized. The digits can be spoken separately or combined in a sequence to accelerate the entry.
Using alternative commands
The system often recognizes a number of different commands to run a function; for instance:
Dial name< or >Name<
Example: dialing a phone number

Briefly press the button on the wheel.
- »Dial number«
The system says: »Please say the number«
- E.g., >123 456 790
The system says: »123 456 790. Continue?«
-
Diak
The system says: »Dialing number«
Calling
Dialing a phone number
- »Dial number«
- Say the phone number.
-
Dialk
Correcting the phone number
The sequence of digits can be deleted after the system has repeated the digits.
Correct number
The command can be repeated as often as necessary.
Deleting a phone number
Delete<
All digits entered up to that point are deleted.
Redialing
Redial
Voice phone book\*
Depending on how your vehicle is equipped, it may be necessary to create your own voice phone book.
The entries must be entered using voice activation and are separate from the memory in the mobile phone. Up to 50 entries can be set up.
Saving an entry
- »Save name«
- Say the name. Do not exceed the speaking duration of approx. 2 seconds.
- Say the phone number after being prompted to do so by the system.
-
Save
Deleting an entry
-
Delete name
- Say the name after being prompted to do so.
- Confirm the query with >Yes.
Deleting all entries
- »Delete phonebook«
The dialog for deleting the phone book is opened. - Confirm the query with »Yes«.
- Confirm the query again with >Yes<.
Reading and selecting entries
- »Read phonebook«
The dialog for reading the phone book is opened. - Say »Dial number« when the desired entry is read.
Selecting an entry
- »Dial name«
- Say the name after being prompted to do so.
- Confirm the query with >Yes<.
Adjusting the volume
Turn the knob during an announcement.
The volume remains constant even if the volume of other audio sources is changed.
The volume is stored for the remote control currently in use.
Notes
Do not use the voice operation to initiate an Emergency Request. In stressful situations, the voice and vocal pitch can change. This can unnecessarily delay the establishment of a telephone connection.
Instead, use the SOS button*, refer to page 248, in the vicinity of the interior mirror.
Environmental conditions
▷ Say the commands, numbers, and letters smoothly and with normal volume, emphasis, and speed.
▶ Always say commands in the language of the system. The language for the mobile phone voice operation is preset and cannot be changed in the Control Display.
Keep the doors, windows, and convertible top closed to prevent noise interference.
▶ Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.
Snap-in adapter\*
Installation position
In the center armrest.
Inserting the snap-in adapter
- Press the button and remove the cover.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a black arrow pointing to the seat area (no text or symbols visible)- Insert the snap-in adapter at the front, arrow 1, and press down, arrow 2, until it engages.

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no text or symbols visible)Inserting the mobile phone
- Depending on the mobile phone, remove the protective cap from the antenna connector of the mobile phone.
- Slide the mobile phone with the buttons facing up in the direction of the electrical connections, arrow 1, and push downward, arrow 2 until it engages.

natural_image
Interior view of a car intake console with labeled parts (no text or symbols visible)Removing the mobile phone

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a mobile phone slot and a white arrow pointing to the top panel (no text or symbols visible)Press the button and remove the mobile phone.
Office\*
At a glance
General information
Contacts, appointments, tasks, notes, text messages, and e-mails from the mobile phone can be displayed on the Control Display if the mobile phone provides compatible support of these functions and the necessary Bluetooth standards.
Information about which mobile phones support the Office functions can be found at www.bmwusa.com/bluetooth. A limited number of compatible mobile phones is available for Office.
Contents are only displayed in full length when the vehicle is stationary.
The mobile phone has read-access only.

Do not use Office while driving
To avoid becoming distracted and posing an unnecessary hazard to your vehicle's occupants and to other road users, never attempt to use the controls or enter information unless traffic and road conditions allow this.
Requirements
A suitable mobile phone is paired with the vehicle and connected. In some mobile phones, data access must be confirmed on the mobile phone.
The time, time zone, and date, refer to page 79, are correctly set on the Control Display and on the mobile phone to correctly display appointments, for example.
▶ Office is activated, refer to page 197.
Updating
Data are updated every time the mobile phone is connected to the vehicle. Appointment entries, tasks, notes and reminders can be updated separately.
- "Office"
- "Current office", "Calendar", "Tasks", "Notes" or "Reminders"
- Open "Options".
- "Update data"
Cell phone data are transmitted again to the vehicle.
Office information
The number of unread messages and active tasks as well as the upcoming appointments are displayed.
- "Office"
- "Current office"
- Select the desired entry to display details.

text_image
Current office Unread messages: 2 1 Active tasks: 3 09:00 Team Meeting 10:30 OfficeContacts
At a glance
Contacts can be created and edited. The contacts from the mobile phone* are displayed as well if this function is supported by the mobile phone. Addresses can be adopted as destinations for navigation and the phone numbers can be dialed.
Displaying contacts
General information
- "Office"
2. "Contacts"

text_image
Office ✓ Current office Contacts Messages Calendar Tasks Notes RemindersAll contacts are listed in alphabetical order. Depending on the number of contacts, an A-Z search is offered, refer to page 24.
A symbol indicates the storage location of the contacts:
Symbol Storage location
No symbol In the vehicle; the address has not been checked as a destination.
Ⓐ In the vehicle; the address has been checked as a destination.
Mobile phone.
Dialing phone numbers\*
- Select the desired contact.
- Select the phone number.
The connection is established.
Editing a contact
- Select the desired contact.
- "Edit contact"

text_image
Edit contact Bauer Melanie +49897654321 +49891234567 017088776655 +4917088776655- Change the entries.
- "Store contact in vehicle"
When a contact is edited, the changes are not stored on the mobile phone. A copy of the entry is stored in the vehicle.
Selecting the contact as a navigation destination\*
- Select the desired contact.
- Select the address.
When contacts from the mobile phone are used, the address may need to be matched to the navigation data contained in the vehicle. In this case:
Correct the address.
- "Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Checking the address as a destination\*
An address that is to be used for destination guidance must match the navigation data contained in the vehicle. The address can be checked for this purpose.
- Select the desired contact and highlight the address.
- Open "Options".
- "Check as destination"
- Correct and store the address if necessary.
If the address is corrected and stored, a copy of it is stored in the vehicle. The address is not changed on the mobile phone.
New contact
General information
A contact can have up to 8 phone numbers, 2 addresses, 3 e-mail addresses and one Internet address.
- "Office"
- "Contacts"
- Open "Options".
4. "New contact"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display Contacts New contact Delete all contacts Display: first, last name Office- The entry fields are still filled with the previous entries: "Delete input fields"
- Fill in the entry fields: select the symbol next to the entry field.
- Enter the text and assign the contact type.
- If the vehicle is equipped with a navigation system: Enter the address. Only addresses contained in the navigation data in the vehicle can be entered. This ensures that destination guidance is possible for all addresses.
If necessary, "Accept address".
- "Store contact in vehicle"
Contact types
Various contact types can be assigned to phone numbers and addresses.
Symbol Meaning

Home phone number.

Business phone number.

Mobile phone number.

Other phone number.

Home address.

Business address.
Specifying the home address
A home address can be stored. It appears at the top of the contact list.
- "Home"
-
Create a contact.
-
"Store contact in vehicle"
Selecting the sorting order of the names\*
Names can be displayed in a different order.
- "Office"
- "Contacts"
- Open "Options".
- "Display: last, first name" or "Display: first, last name"
Depending on how the contacts were stored on the mobile phone, the sorting order of the names may differ from the selected sorting order.
Show contact pictures
Pictures stored with the contacts are stored in the vehicle when the mobile phone is connected to the vehicle. The number of transmitted pictures depends on the mobile phone. The mobile phone must support this function.
- "Office"
- "Contacts"
- Open "Options".
- "Show images"
Display of all contact pictures is activated or de-activated.
Exporting/importing contacts
Contacts can be exported and imported via the Personal Profile, refer to page 33. The contacts stored in the vehicle are exported, but not those from the mobile phone.
Deleting contacts
Only contacts that are stored in the vehicle are deleted. The contacts on the mobile phone* cannot be deleted.
- "Office"
- "Contacts"
- Highlight the contact.
-
Open "Options".
-
"Delete contact" or "Delete all contacts".
- If necessary. "Yes"
Messages
General information
Whether or not text messages and e-mails from the mobile phone are displayed depends on whether transmission from the mobile phone to the vehicle is supported. Text messages and e-mails may not be supported by the service provider, or the function may need to be enabled separately. After the mobile phone is first paired, transmission may take several minutes. Messages are only displayed in full length when the vehicle is stationary. Messages from the additional telephone are not transmitted.
Display of different messages:
▷ Text messages.
My Info* messages from the BMW Assist Portal.
▶ Messages from the BMW Assist Concierge service*.
▶ Messages from BMW Info*.
▶ E-mails from the mobile phone.
Displaying messages
- "Office"
- "Messages"
A symbol identifies the type of message.
Symbol Message type
Text messages.
My Info
Message from the Concierge service.
Message from BMW Info.
E-mail from mobile phone.
Filtering the message list
The message list can be filtered, when more than one type of message exists.
- "Filter:"

- Select the type of message.
▷ "All"
All messages are displayed.
"E-mail"
Only e-mails from the mobile phone are displayed.
▷ "Service message"
Only messages from the BMW Assist Concierge service, My Info and BMW Info are displayed.
▷ "Text message"
Only text messages from the mobile phone are displayed.
Deleting messages
Messages from the Concierge service, My Info, and BMW Info can be deleted.
Delete a message:
- "Office"
- "Messages"
- Select the desired message.
- Open "Options".
-
"Delete message"
Delete all messages: -
"Office"
-
"Messages"
-
Open "Options".
- "Delete all messages" or "Delete service messages"
Text messages
Calling the sender of a text message
- Select the desired message.
- Select the symbol.
Saving the sender in the contacts
- Highlight the desired message.
- Open "Options".
- "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact"
Reading the text message out loud\*
Read the text messages out loud, refer to page 214.
My Info
Starting destination guidance
- Select the message.
- "Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Dialing the number in the message
Up to 4 phone numbers can be transmitted with a message.
- Select the desired message.
- "Call":
If the message contains a number, the connection is established.
☐ "Select phone number":
If the message contains more than one number, select the desired number from the list.
The connection is established.
Message from the Concierge service
Starting destination guidance
-
Select the desired message.
-
"Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"

text_image
Concierge 442km Start guidance Deutschland 80788 München Petuelring 130 08912345678- Start destination guidance, if necessary.
Dialing the number in the message
Up to 4 phone numbers can be transmitted with a message.
- Select the desired message.
- "Call":
If the message contains a number, the connection is established.
"Select phone number":
If the message contains more than one number, select the desired number from the list. The connection is established.
Storing an address
- Select the desired message.
- Open "Options".
- "Store contact in vehicle"
Displaying additional information
- Select the desired message.
- "Further information"
BMW Info
Starting destination guidance
- Select the desired message.
- "Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Dialing the number in the message
Up to 4 phone numbers can be transmitted with a message.
-
Select the desired message.
-
"Call":
If the message contains a number, the connection is established.
"Select phone number":
If the message contains more than one number, select the desired number from the list. The connection is established.
E-mail\*
Displaying e-mails
- "Office"
- "Messages"
- Select the desired e-mail.
Displaying e-mail contacts
If the sender and recipient of an e-mail are transmitted by the mobile phone, this information is displayed in the e-mail.
"Sender/Recipient"
If the e-mail addresses are stored in the contacts, the contact is displayed. Select the contact to display details.
If the e-mail addresses are not stored in the contacts, only the e-mail address is displayed.
Using contact data
Contact data from appointments, e-mails and notes can be saved or selected*, refer to page 214.
Deactivating the full display
When an e-mail is opened in the vehicle, the e-mail is fully transmitted to the vehicle. This may result in charges.
- "Office"
- "Messages"
- Open "Options".
- "Fully download e-mails"
Only a part of the email from the cell phone is loaded into the vehicle.
Reading the e-mail out loud\*
Read the e-mail out loud, refer to page 214.
Calendar
Display the calendar
Appointments during the last 20 and the next 50 days can be displayed.
- "Office"
- "Calendar"
The appointments on the current day are displayed.
Selecting the calendar day
- Select the date.

text_image
Calendar Thursday , 03.07. 09:00 Team Meeting 10:30 Office- Select the desired day or date.
▷ "Next day"
"Date:"
▶ "Previous day"
▶ "Today"
Display the appointment
- Select the desired appointment.
- Scroll through the appointment if necessary:
▶ Turn the controller.
Select the symbol.
Using contact data
Contact data from appointments, e-mails and notes can be saved or selected*, refer to page 214.
Reading the appointment out loud\*
Read the appointment out loud, refer to page 214.
Tasks
Displaying the task list
Display tasks that are due within the next 90 days.
- "Office"
- "Tasks"
Sorting the task list
- Select the header in the task list.

text_image
Subjects Subject Due Auto test... 13.09. Task 1 26.06. Task 3 03.06.- Select the sorting criterion:
▷ "Priority (!)"*
▶ "Subject"
▶ "Due date"
Displaying the task
- Select the desired task.
- Scroll in the task if necessary:
▶ Turn the controller.
▶ Select the symbol.
Using contact data
Contact data from appointments, e-mails and notes can be saved or selected*, refer to page 214.
Reading the task out loud\*
Read the task out loud, refer to page 214.
Notes
Displaying notes
- "Office"
- "Notes"
All notes are displayed.
Displaying the note
- Select the desired note.

text_image
Notes Name Team Meeting organisieren Fahrzeug buchen- Scroll in the note if necessary:
▶ Turn the controller.
▶ Select the symbol.
Using contact data
Contact data from appointments, e-mails and notes can be saved or selected*, refer to page 214.
Reading the note out loud\*
Read the note out loud, refer to page 214.
Reminders
Displaying reminders
Reminders of pending appointments and tasks are displayed. After an appointment or after a task is due, the reminder is no longer displayed.
- "Office"
- "Reminders"
- Select the desired reminder.
The corresponding appointment or the task are displayed.
Using contact data
At a glance
Contact data from calendar entries, appointments, tasks, emails and notes can be stored or selected*.
Displaying contact or selecting phone number
- "Use contact data"
- Display the contact or select the phone number:
▶ Select the contact to display contact details.
▶ Select the phone number to establish a connection directly.
Storing contact data
- "Use contact data"
- Highlight the phone number or e-mail address.
- Open "Options".
- "Add to existing contact" or "Store as new contact"
Reading out loud\*
Text messages, e-mails, appointment entries, tasks, and notes can be read out loud.
- Select the desired message, appointment, task, or note.
- Select the symbol.
The following options are available during reading:
▶ "Hause"
Interrupt reading. Select again to restart reading.
▶ "Back to beginning"
Start reading message again from the beginning.
▶ \$Select the symbol.
Skip a paragraph.
▶ \$Select the symbol.
Go back one paragraph.
To end reading, tilt the controller to the left.
What to do if...
Information on suitable mobile phones, refer to page 196.
Appointments, tasks, notes, text messages, or e-mails from the mobile phone are not displayed.
The mobile phone is not capable of the missing function or is not connected correctly.
The Office function is deactivated.
The mobile phone is connected as an additional phone.
- Appointments are older than 20 days or are more than 50 days in the future.
The tasks have been marked as completed or have a due date that lies more than 90 days in the future.
▶ Depending on the number of stored appointments, task notes, and messages in the mobile phone, not all are displayed in the vehicle.
Not all appointments and tasks from the mobile phone are displayed at the right time?
The time zone, time or date is incorrectly set on the Control Display and mobile phone.
The e-mail attachment is not displayed.
▶ E-mails are transmitted without an attachment.
Entries are not displayed in full length.
▶ Text were already transmitted from the mobile phone in a shortened form.
▶ Synchronization between the mobile phone and vehicle may take several minutes.
The contact pictures are not being displayed?
▶ A max. of 200 contact pictures can be stored in the vehicle.
The E-mail is displayed with a delay?
▶ Check the e-mail settings on the telephone and adjust if necessary. If all points in this list have been checked and the required function is still not available, please contact the hotline or service center.
Contacts\*
General information
Contacts can be created and edited and the addresses can be adopted as destinations for navigation.
New contact
- "Contacts"
- "New contact"

text_image
Contacts ✓ New contact My contacts- The entry fields are still filled with the previous entries: "Delete input fields"
- Fill in the entry fields: select the symbol next to the entry field.

text_image
New contact Delete input fields Store contact in vehicle Last name First name Home Business Mobile- Enter the text, refer to page 24.
-
If the vehicle is equipped with a navigation system: Enter the address. Only addresses contained in the navigation data in the vehicle can be entered. This ensures that destination guidance is possible for all addresses.
-
If necessary, "Store".
-
"Store contact in vehicle"
Specifying the home address
A home address can be stored. It appears at the top of the contact list.
- "Home"
- Create a contact.
- "Store contact in vehicle"
My contacts
General information
List of all contacts stored in the vehicle.
Displaying contacts
- "Contacts"
- "My contacts"

text_image
Contacts New contact ✓ My contactsAll contacts are listed in alphabetical order. Depending on the number of contacts, an A-Z search is offered, refer to page 24.
A symbol indicates the storage location of the contacts:
Symbol Storage location
No symbol In the vehicle; the address has not been checked as a destination.
Ⓐ In the vehicle; the address has been checked as a destination*.
Editing a contact
- Select the desired contact.
- "Edit contact"

text_image
Contact Edit contact MUSTERMANN MÜNCHEN, MÜNCHEN (STA PETUELRING 130 DEUTSCHLAND- Change the entries.
- Move the controller to the left.
- "Yes"
Selecting the contact as a navigation destination\*
- Select the desired contact.
- Select the address.
- "Start guidance" or "Add as another destination"
Checking the address as a destination\*
An address that is to be used for destination guidance must match the navigation data contained in the vehicle. The address can be checked for this purpose.
- Select the desired contact and highlight the address.
- Open "Options".
- "Check as destination"
- Correct and store the address if necessary.
Selecting the sorting order of the names
Names can be displayed in a different order.
- "My contacts"
- Highlight the contact.
- Open "Options".
- "Display: last, first name" or "Display: first, last name"
Exporting/importing contacts
Contacts can be exported and imported via the Personal Profile, refer to page 33.
Deleting contacts
- "My contacts"
- Highlight the contact.
- Open "Options".
- "Delete contact" or "Delete all contacts"
BMW ConnectedDrive
BMW Assist\*
General information
BMW Assist provides you with certain services, e.g., transmission of the position data of your vehicle to the BMW Assist Response Center if an Emergency Request* has been initiated.
Many BMW Assist services depend on the individually agreed upon contract.
After your contract has expired, the BMW Assist system will be deactivated by the BMW Assist Response Center without your having to visit a service center. After the BMW Assist system has been deactivated, no BMW Assist services will be available. The BMW Assist system can be reactivated by a service center after you sign a new contract.
Requirements
The installed BMW Assist system is logged in to a wireless communications network. This network must be capable of transmitting the services.
To transmit position data, the vehicle must be able to determine the current position.
The BMW Assist service contract was signed with your service center or with the BMW Assist Response Center. Enabling must have been completed.
▶ BMW Assist is activated.
Services offered
Emergency Request: when you press the SOS button, a connection to the BMW Assist Response Center is established. The BMW Assist Response Center then speaks with you and takes further steps to help you.
▶ Automatic Collision Notification: under certain conditions, a connection is established to the BMW Assist Response Center after a serious accident. If possible, the BMW As-
sist Response Center then speaks with you and takes further steps to help you.
▶ Enhanced Roadside Assistance: BMW Roadside Assistance* can be contacted if assistance is needed in the event of a breakdown. If possible, the vehicle and position data are transmitted in the process.
▶ Customer Relations: connection with Customer Relations for information on all aspects of your vehicle.
▶ TeleService: data on your vehicle's service status or required inspections are transmitted to your service center, either automatically before a service due date or when you request a BMW service appointment.
▶ Remote Door Unlock: the BMW Assist Response Center provides assistance if, for example, the remote control is not available and the vehicle needs to be opened.
Stolen Vehicle Recovery: after you report that your vehicle was stolen to the police, the BMW Assist Response Center can determine its position.
In addition to these services, the optional Convenience Plan offers Concierge service and information for route planning, traffic, and weather. A limited number of calls can be made via the BMW Assist Response Center with Critical Calling if, for example, the mobile phone is not available or discharged.
Press the SOS button to contact the BMW Assist Response Center.
BMW TeleService\*
General information
TeleService supports communication with your service center.
Data on the vehicle's service requirements can be sent directly to the service center. In this way, the service center can plan its work
in advance. This shortens the duration of the service appointment.
In the event of a breakdown, data on the vehicle's condition can be sent directly to Roadside Assistance.
The service varies by country.
▷ Connection costs may ensue.
▶ Services may be restricted abroad.
Requirements
▶ BMW Assist is activated.
▶ Wireless reception is available.
The engine is running.
Use of BMW TeleService\*
The TeleServices are typically activated in the vehicle.
Even TeleService Customer Service is not active, a voice contact to Roadside Assistance is still possible.
To continue using or to deactivate the services, please contact your service partner or the BMW customer hotline.
Concierge service\*
General information
The BMW Assist Concierge service offers information on events, gas stations or hotels, and provides phone numbers and addresses. Hotels can be booked directly by the BMW Assist Concierge service. The Concierge service is part of the optional BMW Convenience Plan.
Starting the Concierge service
-
"ConnectedDrive"
-
"Concierge"

text_image
ConnectedDrive BMW Assist ✓ Concierge Messages Roadside Assistance BMW Online Customer Relations Service Request- "Start service"
A voice connection is established with the BMW Assist Concierge service. Phone numbers and addresses can be transmitted to the vehicle.
Roadside Assistance
At a glance
BMW Roadside Assistance* can be contacted if assistance is needed in the event of a break-down.
Roadside Assistance* can also be contacted via a Check Control message, refer to page 82.
Starting Roadside Assistance
Vehicles not equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Roadside Assistance"
The Roadside Assistance number is displayed. If the mobile phone* is paired, a connection is established to Roadside Assistance.

text_image
ConnectedDrive BMW Assist Concierge Messages ✓ Roadside Assistance BMW Online Customer Relations Service RequestVehicles equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Roadside Assistance"
- "Start service"

text_image
Roadside Assistance Start service Service readyTeleService Diagnosis\*
TeleService Diagnosis enables the wireless transmission of detailed vehicle data that are important for vehicle diagnosis. These data are transmitted automatically.
After the data are transmitted, the voice connection to Roadside Assistance is re-established.
TeleService Help\*
TeleService Help enables an in-depth diagnosis of the vehicle by Roadside Assistance via wireless transmission.
TeleService Help can be started after a prompt by Roadside Assistance and the termination of the voice connection.
Starting TeleService Help
- Park the vehicle in a safe place.
- Set the parking brake.
- The engine is running.
- "TeleService Help"
After completion of TeleService Help, a voice connection is established to Roadside Assistance.
BMW Online\*
At a glance
A business search can be opened via BMW Online.
License conditions
This product contains NetFront Browser software of ACCESS Co., Ltd. Copyright © 2007 ACCESS Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.
NetFront is a trademark or registered trademark of ACCESS CO., LTD., in Japan and other countries.
This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.
Requirements
▶ Subscription to the optional Convenience Plan.
The date setting, refer to page 80, on the Control Display is current.
The vehicle is located within wireless network coverage.
Starting BMW Online
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "BMW Online"

text_image
ConnectedDrive BMW Assist Concierge Messages Roadside Assistance ✓ BMW Online Customer Relations Service Request- If necessary, "OK".
The BMW Online home page is displayed.
Operating BMW Online
To start a search:
▶ Turn the controller to highlight an element.
▷ Press the controller to display an element.
Opening the start page
- Open "Options".
- "Display start page"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display Current page Display start page Reload Cancel loading BMW OnlineLoading a new page
- Open "Options".
- "Reload"
Cancel
- Open "Options".
- "Cancel loading"
Customer Relations
At a glance
Contact Customer Relations for information on all aspects of your vehicle.
Calling Customer Relations
Vehicles not equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Customer Relations"
The Customer Relations phone number is displayed. If the mobile phone* is paired, a connection is established to Customer Relations.

text_image
Customer Relations Please call this number: 08912345678Vehicles equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Customer Relations"
- "Start service"
Service Request\*
At a glance
Sends information to your service partner to request the arrangement of a service appointment. The TeleService data is transmitted during a Service Request. If possible, your service partner will establish contact with you.
Starting a Service Request
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Service Request"
- "Start service"

text_image
Service Request Start service Service readyA Service Request can be started via a Check Control message, refer to page 82.
Automatic Service Request\*
The TeleService data necessary for servicing the vehicle are automatically sent to your service partner prior to the service deadline. If possible, the service partner will contact you and a service appointment can be arranged.
To check when your service partner was notified:
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"

text_image
Vehicle Info Quick reference Search by pictures Owner's Manual Onboard info Trip computer ✓ Vehicle status- Open "Options".
- "Last Service Request"

text_image
Options Split screen Switch off control display Flat Tire Monitor Display Owner's Manual Reset Vehicle Info Last Service RequestServices status\*
General information
Check services status.
Displaying available services
Display of all services available in the vehicle.
- "ConnectedDrive"
-
"Service Status"
-
"Available services"

text_image
Service Status Update BMW Assist Available servicesUpdating BMW Assist
Manual update of TeleService* and BMW Assist*.
"Update BMW Assist"
Data transfer\*
During the updating of BMW services, display the status of the data transfer.
- "ConnectedDrive"
- Open "Options".
- "Data transfer"
Apps\*
At a glance
Certain software applications of a suitable cell phone can be integrated in the vehicle. These software applications are displayed on the Control Display.
They are operated via iDrive.
Requirements
The mobile phone is suitable.
The cell phone operating system supports the software applications of Apps.
▶ Software applications are installed on the cell phone and ready to use.
Corresponding mobile wireless contract.
Any additionally incurred costs are not a part of Apps.
▶ Use only BMW approved software applications; otherwise, it may result in malfunctions.
Information about suitable cell phones, available software applications and their installation can be found at www.bmw.com/connectivity or at the service center.

Create the entries.
Make entries only when traffic and road conditions allow. Otherwise, the vehicle occupants and other road users may be put in danger because of the distraction from driving.
For reasons of safety, some software applications are usable only while the vehicle is stationary.
Operate Apps
- Connect the cell phone via the snap-in adapter or via the USB audio interface.
- "ConnectedDrive"
- Select the desired software application.
Displaying status
Information about the currently available software applications can be displayed.
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "BMW apps"
PlugIn\*
Selected functions of the cell phone are displayed on the Control Display. They can be operated via iDrive.
- Connect cell phone via the snap-in adapter.
- "ConnectedDrive"
- "Plugin"
- "Activate PlugIn"
- Navigate to the displayed functions via the controller and select, for example, a desired category or track.

Press button to switch within the cell phone functions to a higher level or back.

Press button twice to switch back to the main menu.
Notes
The ranges of Apps that can be displayed on the Control Display depend on the range of installed software applications on the cell phone.
The data transmission of the software applications from the cell phone to the vehicle can last some time. Some software applications depend on the speed of the available Internet connection of the cell phone.
▶ Some cell phones cannot simultaneously use Apps and the Bluetooth hands-free system.
If necessary, restart the software application on the cell phone after a phone conversation.
TeleService Report\*
Transmits technical data that is evaluated for the ongoing development of BMW products from your vehicle to BMW in regular intervals if necessary.
TeleService Report is activated in vehicles that meet certain technical requirements and have a valid Assist contract; this feature is free of charge.
Neither personal data nor position data is transmitted.
Indicate when the last Teleservice Report was transmitted:
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- Open "Options".
- "Last Teleservice Info"

natural_image
Close-up of a metallic pipette dispensing liquid into a dark circular container (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Abstract blurred image with no discernible text, symbols, or structured content.Mobility
To ensure that you remain mobile at all times, this chapter supplies you with important information on the topics of fuels and lubricants, wheels and tires, service, maintenance, and Roadside Assistance.
Refueling
Fuel cap
Opening
- Briefly press the rear edge of the fuel filler flap.

natural_image
Black square button with a white arrow symbol pointing left, on a gradient gray background (no text or symbols)- Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise.

natural_image
Diagram of a mechanical component with an arrow indicating direction, no visible text or symbols- Place the fuel cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler flap.

natural_image
Diagram of a device with a magnified inset showing internal components (no text or symbols)Closing
-
Fit the cap and turn it clockwise until you clearly hear a click.
-
Close the fuel filler flap.
Do not pinch the retaining strap Do not pinch the retaining strap attached to the cap; otherwise, the cap cannot be closed properly and fuel vapors can escape.
A message is displayed if the cap is loose or missing.
Manually unlocking fuel filler flap
In the event of an electrical malfunction, for example.
- Open the cover on the right side trim.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear compartment with a black plastic component and an arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols visible)- Pull the green knob with the fuel pump symbol. This releases the fuel filler flap.

natural_image
Interior view of a car door frame showing the lid and vent, with no visible text or symbols.Observe the following when refueling
The fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicks off the first time.
Handling fuels Obey safety regulations posted at the gas station.
Fuel tank capacity
Fuel tank capacity: approx. 18.5 US gal/70 liters.

Refuel promptly
Refuel below a range of 30 miles/50 km; otherwise, engine functions are not ensured and damage may occur.
Fuel
Fuel quality

Refuel with unleaded fuel only
Do not use leaded fuel as this would permanently damage the catalytic converter.

Do not refuel with ethanol
Do not refuel with E85, i.e., fuel with an ethanol content of 85 %, or with Flex Fuel, as this would damage the engine and fuel supply system.
Required fuel
Super Premium Gasoline/AKI 91 or AKI 89
BMW recommends AKI 91 or 89.
Gasoline with lower AKI
The minimum AKI Rating is 89.
If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rating, the engine may produce knocking sounds when starting at high outside temperatures.
This has no effect on the engine life.

Minimum fuel grade
Do not use any gasoline below the minimum specified fuel grade; otherwise, engine damage may occur.
Use high-quality brands
Field experience has indicated significant differences in fuel quality: volatility, composition, additives, etc., among gasolines offered for sale in the United States and Canada.
Fuels containing up to and including 10 % ethanol or other oxygenates with up to 2.8 % oxygen by weight, that is, 15 % MTBE or 3 % methanol plus an equivalent amount of co-solvent, will not void the applicable warranties with respect to defects in materials or workmanship.

Minimum fuel grade
The use of poor-quality fuels may result in driveability, starting and stalling problems especially under certain environmental conditions such as high ambient temperature and high altitude.
Should you encounter driveability problems which you suspect could be related to the fuel you are using, we recommend that you respond by switching to a recognized high-quality brand such as gasoline that is advertised as Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Failure to comply with these recommendations may result in unscheduled maintenance.
BMW recommends BP fuels

Wheels and tires
Tire inflation pressure
Safety information
The tire characteristics and tire inflation pressure influence the following:
The service life of the tires.
Road safety.
▶ Driving comfort.
Checking the pressure
Only check the tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold. This means after driving no more than 1.25 miles/2 km or when the vehicle has been parked for at least 2 hours. When the tires are warm, the tire inflation pressure is higher.
Check the tire inflation pressure regularly Regularly check the tire inflation pressure and correct it as needed: at least twice a month and before a long trip. If you fail to observe this precaution, you may be driving on tires with incorrect tire pressures, a condition that may not only compromise your vehicle's driving stability, but also lead to tire damage and the risk of an accident.
After correcting the tire inflation pressure, reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor.
After correcting the tire inflation pressure, reinitialize the Tire Pressure Monitor.
Pressure specifications
The tire inflation pressure table, refer to page 230, contains all pressure specifications for the specified tire sizes at the ambient temperature. Pressure specifications apply to approved tire sizes and recommended tire brands. This information can be obtained from your service center.
To identify the correct tire inflation pressure, please note the following:
▶ Tire sizes of your vehicle.
▶ Vehicle load.
▶ Maximum allowable driving speed.
Tire inflation pressures up to 100 mph/160 km/h
For speeds of up to 100 mph/160 km/h and for optimum driving comfort, note the pressure values in the tire inflation pressure table, refer to page 230, and adjust as necessary.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the side panel and seat area (no text or symbols visible)These pressure values can also be found on the tire inflation pressure label on the driver's door pillar.
Maximum permissible speed Do not exceed 100 mph/160 km/h; otherwise, tire damage and accidents may result.
Tire inflation pressure values up to 100 mph/160 km/h
650i
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in psi/ kilopascal with cold tires

text_image
Diagram showing human silhouette icons and a car with directional arrows indicating movement or orientation.245/45 R 18 100 V M 2.3 / 33 2.6 / 38
+S XL A/S
245/40 R 19 98 V M
+S XL A/S
245/45 R 18 96 Y
245/45 R 18 100 V M
+S XL
| F: 245/45 R 18 96 Y | 2.3 / 33 | - |
| R: 275/40 R 18 99 Y | - | 2.4 / 35 |
| F: 245/40 R 19 94 Y | 2.4 / 35 | - |
| R: 275/35 R 19 96 Y | - | 2.6 / 38 |
| F: 245/35 R 20 95 | 2.6 / 38 | - |
| Y XL | - | 2.9 /42 |
| R: 275/30 R 20 97 | ||
| Y XL |
Tire inflation pressures at max. speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h

Speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h
In order to drive at maximum speeds in excess of 100 mph/160 km/h, please observe, and, if necessary, adjust tire pressures for speeds exceeding 100 mph/160 km/h from the relevant table on the following pages. Otherwise tire damage and accidents could occur.
Tire inflation pressure values over 100 mph/160 km/h
650i
Without high-speed tuning feature
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires

text_image
Diagram showing human silhouette and car with directional arrows indicating movement or orientation, likely illustrating a vehicle safety or safety concept.245/45 R 18 100 V M 2.3 / 33 2.8 / 41
+S XL A/S
245/45 R 18 96 Y
245/45R 18 100 V M
+S XL
245/40 R 19 98 V M 2,5 / 363 3.0 / 44 +S XL A/S
F: 245/45 R 18 96 Y 2.3 / 33 -
R: 275/40 R 18 99 Y - 2.4 / 35
F: 245/40 R 19 94 Y 2.4 / 35 -
R: 275/35 R 19 96 Y - 2.6 / 38
F: 245/35 R 20 95 2.6 / 38 -
Y XL - 2.9/42
R: 275/30 R 20 97 Y XL
With high-speed tuning feature
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires

text_image
Diagram showing human silhouette icons above a car and a box, with arrows indicating movement or orientation.245/45 R 18 96 Y 2,5 / 363 3.0 / 44
245/45 R 18 100 2.7 / 39 3.2 / 46 V M+S XL
F: 245/45 R 18 96 Y 2,5 / 363 R: 275/40 R 18 99 Y - 2.7 / 39
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
| F: 245/40 R 19 94 Y 2.6 / 38 | - | |
| R: 275/35 R 19 96 Y - | 3.0 / 44 | |
| F: 245/35 R 20 95 | 2.8 / 41 | - |
| Y XL | - | 3,3 / 48 |
| R: 275/30 R 20 97 | ||
| Y XL | ||
Tire identification marks
Tire size
255/50 R 19 103 Y
255: nominal width in mm
50: aspect ratio in %
R: radial tire code
19: rim diameter in inches
103: load rating, not for ZR tires
Y: speed rating, before the R on ZR tires
Speed letter
T = up to 118 mph, 190 km/h
H = up to 131 mph, 210 km/h
V = up to 150 mph, 240 km/h
W = up to 167 mph, 270 km/h
Y = up to 186 mph, 300 km/h
Tire Identification Number
DOT code: DOT xxxx xxx 3510
xxxx: manufacturer code for the tire brand
xxx: tire size and tire design
3510: tire age
Tires with DOT codes meet the guidelines of the U.S. Department of Transportation.
Tire age
DOT ... 3510: the tire was manufactured in the 35th week in 2010.
Recommendation
Regardless of wear, replace tires at least every 6 years.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
For example: Treadwear 200; Traction AA; Temperature A
DOT Quality Grades
Treadwear
Traction AA A B C
Temperature A B C
All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades.
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half, 1 g, times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.
Temperature
The temperature grades are A, the highest, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades Band A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

Temperature grade for this tire
The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.
If necessary, have the vehicle towed.
RSC - Run-flat tires
Run-flat tires, refer to page 234, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the sidewall.
M+S
Winter and all-season tires with better cold weather performance than summer tires.
Tire tread
Summer tires
Do not drive with a tire tread depth of less than 0.12 in/3 mm.
There is an increased danger of hydroplaning if the tread depth is less than 0.12 in/3 mm.
Winter tires
Do not drive with a tire tread depth of less than 0.16 in/4 mm.
Below a tread depth of 0.16 in/4 mm, tires are less suitable for winter operation.
Minimum tread depth

natural_image
3D rendering of a mechanical component with grid-like surfaces and two black square components (no text or symbols)Wear indicators are distributed around the tire's circumference and have the legally required minimum height of 0.063 in/1.6 mm.
They are marked on the side of the tire with TWI, Tread Wear Indicator.
Tire damage
General information
Inspect your tires often for damage, foreign objects lodged in the tread, and tread wear.
Notes
Indications of tire damage or other vehicle defects:
▶ Unusual vibrations during driving.
▶ Unusual handling such as a strong tendency to pull to the left or right.

In case of tire damage
If there are indications of tire damage, reduce your speed immediately and have the wheels and tires checked right away; otherwise, there is the increased risk of an accident.
Drive carefully to the next service center or tire shop.
If necessary, have the vehicle towed.

Repair of tire damage
For safety reasons, the manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that you do not have damaged tires repaired; they should be re-
placed. Otherwise, damage can occur as a result.
Changing wheels and tires
Mounting

Information on mounting tires
Have mounting and balancing performed only by a service center or tire specialist.
If this work is not carried out properly, there is the danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.
Wheel and tire combination
Information on the correct wheel-tire combination and rim versions for your vehicle can be obtained from your service center.
Incorrect wheel and tire combinations impair the function of a variety of systems such as ABS or DSC.
To maintain good handling and vehicle response, use only tires with a single tread configuration from a single manufacturer.
Following tire damage, have the original wheel and tire combination remounted on the vehicle as soon as possible.

Approved wheels and tires
The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that you use only wheels and tires that have been approved for your particular vehicle model.
For example, despite having the same official size ratings, variations can lead to body contact and with it, the risk of severe accidents.
The manufacturer of your vehicle cannot evaluate non-approved wheels and tires to determine if they are suited for use, and therefore cannot ensure the operating safety of the vehicle if they are mounted.
Recommended tire brands

natural_image
Close-up of a car tire with visible texture and star marking (no text or symbols)For each tire size, the manufacturer of your vehicle recommends certain tire brands. These can be identified by a star on the tire sidewall.
With proper use, these tires meet the highest standards for safety and handling.
New tires
Due to technical factors associated with their manufacture, tires do not achieve their full traction potential until after an initial breaking-in period.
Drive conservatively for the first 200 miles/300 km.
Retreaded tires
The manufacturer of your vehicle does not recommend the use of retreaded tires.

Retreaded tires
Possibly substantial variations in the design and age of the tire casing structures can limit service life and have a negative impact on road safety.
Winter tires
The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends winter tires for winter roads or at temperatures below +45 °F/+7 °C.
Although so-called all-season M+S tires do provide better winter traction than summer tires, they do not provide the same level of performance as winter tires.
Maximum speed of winter tires
If the maximum speed of the vehicle is higher than the permissible speed for the winter tires, then display a corresponding sign in the field of vision. You can obtain this sign from the tire specialist or from your service center.

Maximum speed for winter tires
Do not exceed the maximum speed for the winter tires; otherwise, tire damage and accidents can occur.
Run-flat tires
For your own safety, only use run-flat tires. No spare tire is available in the case of a flat tire. Your service center will be glad to advise you.
Rotating wheels between axles
The manufacturer of your vehicle advises against swapping wheels between the front and rear axles.
This can impair the handling characteristics.
Storage
Store wheels and tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible.
Always protect tires against all contact with oil, grease and fuels.
Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure indicated on the side wall of the tire.
Run-flat tires\*
Label

natural_image
Close-up of a car tire with a logo on the rim, showing tread pattern and side teeth (no text or symbols)RSC label on the tire sidewall.
The wheels are composed of special rims and tires that are self-supporting, to a limited degree.
The support of the sidewall allows the tire to remain drivable to a restricted degree in the event of a pressure loss.
Continued driving with a damaged tire., refer to page 93
Changing run-flat tires
For your own safety, only use run-flat tires. No spare tire is available in the case of a flat tire. Your service center will be glad to advise you.
Snow chains
Fine-link snow chains
Only certain types of fine-link snow chains have been tested by the manufacturer of your vehicle, classified as road-safe and recommended.
Consult your service center for more information.
Use
Use only in pairs on the rear wheels, equipped with the tires of the following size:
225/55 R 17.
▷ 245/45 R 18.
Follow the chain manufacturer's instructions.
Make sure that the snow chains are always sufficiently tight. Retighten as needed according to the chain manufacturer's instructions.
Do not initialize the Flat Tire Monitor after mounting snow chains, as doing so may result in incorrect readings.
Do not initialize the Tire Pressure Monitor after mounting snow chains, as doing so may result in incorrect readings.
When driving with snow chains, briefly activate Dynamic Traction Control if necessary.
Maximum speed with snow chains
Do not exceed a speed of 30 mph/50 km/h when using snow chains.
Snow chain detection\*
The concept
When using snow chains, you should set whether you are driving with or without snow chains via the iDrive.
The snow chain detection system supports you by automatically showing the detected state on the Control Display.
When snow chains are in use, the rear axle steering of the Integral Active Steering* is deactivated automatically.
At speeds above the maximum allowable speed with snow chains of 30 mph/50 km/h, the rear axle steering is activated again automatically.
Activating the status
- "Settings"
- "Tire chains"
- "Tire chains installed"
Automatic detection
If functioning properly:
▶ Snow chains are mounted. The setting is not activated □.
After you drive a short distance, a Check Control message is shown and the state is activated automatically.
Confirm the automatic activation.
▶ Snow chains are not mounted. The setting is activated √
At speeds above 30 mph/50 km/h, a Check Control message is displayed. Deactivate the status manually.
If not functioning properly:
▶ Snow chains are mounted. The setting is not activated ☐
A Check Control message is not displayed.
The automatic detection system is malfunctioning. Activate the status manually.
Activating/deactivating rear axle steering
If the status indicating that snow chains are in use is activated, the rear axle steering is deactivated automatically.
At speeds above 30 mph/50 km/h, the rear axle steering is activated again, even though snow chains are in use.
Engine compartment
Important features in the engine compartment

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 61 Vehicle identification number*
2 Jump starting, negative terminal
3 Washer fluid reservoir
4 Jump starting, positive terminal
5 Oil filler neck
6 Coolant reservoir
Hood
Opening the hood

Working in the engine compartment
Never attempt to perform any service or repair operations on your vehicle without the necessary professional technical training.
If you are unfamiliar with the statutory guidelines, have any work on the vehicle performed only by a service center.
If this work is not carried out properly, there is the danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.

Never reach into the engine compartment
Never reach into the intermediate spaces or gaps in the engine compartment. Otherwise, there is risk of injury, e.g. from rotating or hot parts.
- Pull the lever.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the side door, seatbelt, and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)- Press the release handle and open the hood.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's front grille with BMW logo and a white arrow pointing to a specific area (no text or symbols visible)- Be careful of protruding parts on the hood.

natural_image
3D rendering of a satellite dish with visible solar panels and antennae (no text or symbols)Danger of injury when the hood is open There is a danger of injury from protruding parts when the hood is open.
Closing the hood

natural_image
Front view of a car's head with grille and headlights, showing a white arrow pointing to the grille (no text or symbols visible)Let the hood drop from a height of approx. 16 in/40 cm and push down on it to lock it fully. The hood must audibly engage on both sides.
Hood open when driving If you see any signs that the hood is not completely closed while driving, pull over immediately and close it securely.
Danger of pinching Make sure that the closing path of the hood is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.
Engine oil
General information
The engine oil consumption is dependent on the driving style and driving conditions.
Therefore, check the engine oil level after every refueling using the electronic engine oil level check.
Checking the oil level
The concept
The oil level is monitored electronically and displayed on the Control Display.
Requirements
The engine must be running and warm after the vehicle has been driven for at least 6 miles/10 km.
The vehicle is stopped or being driven on a level roadway.
Displaying the oil level
- "Vehicle Info"
- "Vehicle status"
- "Engine oil level"

text_image
Vehicle status Engine oil levelPossible messages
▶ "Engine oil level OK"
▶ "Measurement not possible at this time."
▶ "Measuring engine oil level..."
Duration with the engine running: approx. 3 minutes.
Duration while driving: approx. 5 minutes.
▶ "Engine oil level below minimum. Add 1 quart!"
Add oil within the next 125 miles/200 km.
▶ "Engine oil level too high! Have this checked."
Have the vehicle checked immediately.

Too much engine oil
Have the vehicle checked immediately; otherwise, surplus oil can lead to engine damage.
▶ "Measurement inactive. Have this checked."
Note the newly calculated remaining mileage until the next oil service. Have the system checked as soon as possible.
Adding engine oil
Filler neck

natural_image
Close-up of a car engine bay with a wrench and a highlighted component (no visible text or symbols)When the indicator lights up in the instrument cluster, add 1 US quart/liter of engine oil within the next 125 miles/200 km.
Recommended oil types, refer to page 239.

Protect children
Keep oil, grease, etc., out of reach of children and heed the warnings on the containers to prevent health risks.
Oil types
Note

No oil additives
Oil additives may lead to engine damage.
Approved oil types
Your service center can advise you on which engine oils have been approved by the manufacturer of your vehicle.
The engine oil quality is critical for the life of the engine.
Only use approved BMW High Performance oil.
Approved oils belong to the viscosity grades SAE 0W-40, SAE 0W-30, SAE 5W-40 and SAE 5W-30.
Alternative oil types
If the approved engine oils are not available, up to 1 US quart/liter of another oil with the following specification may be used.
API SM quality standards or higher.
BMW recommends
Castrol
Coolant
General information

Danger of burns from hot engine
Do not open the cooling system while the engine is hot; otherwise, escaping coolant may cause burns.

Suitable additives
Only use suitable additives; otherwise, engine damage may occur. The additives are harmful to your health.
Coolant consists of water and additives.
Not all commercially available additives are suitable for your vehicle. Ask your service center for suitable additives.
Coolant level
Checking
-
Let the engine cool.
-
Turn the cap of the coolant reservoir slightly counterclockwise to allow any excess pressure to dissipate, and then open it.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular arrow indicating rotation (no visible text or symbols)- The coolant level is correct if it lies between the minimum and maximum marks in the filler neck.

text_image
max min-
If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant up to the specified level; do not overfill.
-
Turn the cap until there is an audible click.
-
Have the cause of the coolant loss eliminated as soon as possible.
Disposal

Comply with the relevant environmental protection regulations when disposing of coolant and coolant additives.
Maintenance
BMW Maintenance System
The maintenance system directs you to required maintenance measures and thereby supports you in maintaining road safety and the operational reliability of the vehicle.
Condition Based Service CBS
Sensors and special algorithms take into account the driving conditions of your vehicle. Based on this, Condition Based Service determines the maintenance requirements.
The system makes it possible to adapt the amount of maintenance you need to your user profile.
Details on the service requirements, refer to page 81, can be displayed on the Control Display.
Service data in the remote control
Information on the required maintenance is continuously stored in the remote control. Your service center will read out this data and suggest the right array of service procedures for your vehicle.
Therefore, hand your service specialist the remote control that you used most recently.
Storage periods
Storage periods during which the vehicle battery was disconnected are not taken into account.
If this occurs, have a service center update the time-dependent maintenance procedures, such as checking brake fluid and, if necessary, changing the engine oil and the microfilter/activated-charcoal filter.
Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models
Please consult your Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models for additional information on service requirements.
Maintenance and repair should be performed by your service center. Make sure to have regular maintenance procedures recorded in the vehicle's Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models, and in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models. These entries are proof of regular maintenance.
Socket for OBD Onboard Diagnosis

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)There is an OBD socket on the driver's side for checking the primary components in the vehicle emissions.
Emissions

The warning lamp lights up:
Emissions are deteriorating. Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible.

The warning lamp flashes under certain circumstances:
This indicates that there is excessive misfiring in the engine.
Reduce the vehicle speed and have the system checked immediately; otherwise, serious engine misfiring within a brief period can seriously damage emission control components, in particular the catalytic converter.
Fuel cap

The indicator lamp lights up.
If the fuel cap is not properly tightened, the OBD system may conclude that fuel
vapor is escaping. If the cap is then tightened, the display should go out in a short time.
Data memory
Your vehicle records data relating to vehicle operation, faults and user settings. These data are stored in the remote control and can be read out with suitable devices, particularly when the vehicle is serviced. The data obtained in this way provide valuable information for service processes and repair or for optimizing and developing vehicle functions further.
In addition, if you signed a service contract for Assist, certain vehicle data can be sent directly from the vehicle to facilitate the desired services.
Replacing components
Tool kit

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a black panel and white warning symbol on the side panel (no text or symbols present)The tool kit is stored under the cargo floor cover in the cargo area.
Wiper blade replacement

Do not fold down the wipers without wiper blades
Do not fold down the wipers if wiper blades have not been installed; this may damage the wind-shield.
Replacing the wiper blades
- To change the wiper blades, fold up, refer to page 71, the wiper arms.
- Fold up the wipers.

natural_image
Diagram of a car interior showing two curved black lines with white arrows indicating direction (no text or symbols)- Position the wiper blade in a horizontal position.
- Remove the wiper blade toward one side.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing steering wheel and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)Lamp and bulb replacement
General information
Lamps and bulbs make an essential contribution to vehicle safety.
The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that you entrust corresponding procedures to your service center if you are unfamiliar with them or they are not described here.
You can obtain a selection of replacement bulbs at your service center.

Danger of burns
Only change bulbs when they are cool; otherwise, there is the danger of getting burned.

Working on the lighting system
When working on the lighting system, you should always switch off the lights affected to prevent short circuits.
To avoid possible injury or equipment damage when replacing bulbs, observe any instructions provided by the bulb manufacturer.

Do not touch the bulbs
Do not touch the glass of new bulbs with your bare hands, as even minute amounts of contamination will burn into the bulb's surface and reduce its service life.
Use a clean tissue, cloth or something similar, or hold the bulb by its base.
Light-emitting diodes (LEDs)
Light-emitting diodes installed behind a cover serve as the light source for controls, display elements and other equipment.
These light-emitting diodes, which are related to conventional lasers, are officially designated as Class 1 light-emitting diodes.

Do not remove the covers
Do not remove the covers, and never stare into the unfiltered light for several hours; otherwise, irritation of the retina could result.
Headlamp glass
Condensation can form on the inside of the external lamps in cool or humid weather. When the light is switched on, the condensation evaporates after a short time. The headlamp glasses do not need to be changed.
If there is a large amount of moisture, e.g., water droplets form in the lamp, have it checked by your service center.
Front lamps, bulb replacement
Xenon headlamps
Because of the long life of these bulbs, the likelihood of failure is very low. Switching the lamps on and off frequently shortens their life.
If a bulb fails, switch on the front fog lamps* and continue the trip with great care. Comply with local regulations.

Do not perform work/bulb replacement on xenon headlamps
Have any work on the xenon lighting system, including bulb replacement, performed only by a service center.
Due to the high voltage present in the system, there is the danger of fatal injuries if work is carried out improperly.
For checking and adjusting headlamp aim, please contact your BMW center.
LEDs or light modules
The following lamps are equipped with LED technology or are designed as light modules:
▶ Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps
▶ Turn signal lamps
▷ Front fog lamps*
Daytime running lights*
Contact your service center in the event of a malfunction.
Follow the general instructions on lamps and bulbs, refer to page 243.
Corner-illuminating lamps\*
Follow the general instructions on lamps and bulbs, refer to page 243.
The illustration shows the left side of the engine compartment.
55-watt bulb, H3
- Unscrew the cap and remove it.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the intake manifold and engine compartment with an arrow pointing to a specific component (no text or symbols visible)- Detach the wire bracket.

natural_image
Diagram of a mechanical component inside a circular housing, showing internal components and structural details (no text or labels)- Disconnect the cable at the plug-in connection and remove the bulb.
- Insert the new bulb. Ensure that the bulb has the correct orientation. Because of its shape, the bulb can only be inserted in one direction.
- Secure the bulb with the wire bracket.
- Connect the bulb.
- Mount the cap.
Tail lamps, bulb replacement
At a glance

text_image
1 2 6 4 5 4 31 Turn signal
2 Backup lamp
3 Inside brake lamp*
4 Tail lamp
5 Outside brake lamp
6 Rear reflector*
Turn signal, outer brake, tail, and license plate lamps
Follow the general instructions on lamps and bulbs, refer to page 243.
These lights are made using LED technology.
Contact your service center in the event of a malfunction.
Lamps in the trunk lid
Access to the lamps

natural_image
Interior view of a car trunk with a white arrow pointing to the rear panel (no text or symbols visible)Remove the five screws using the screwdriver from the tool kit and fold away the cover.
Inside brake lamp\*
Follow the general instructions on lamps and bulbs, refer to page 243.
24-watt bulb, HP24W
- Squeeze the bulb holder and pull it out.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing internal components with no visible text or symbols-
Pull off the connector.
-
Replace the bulb.
- Mount the bulb holder and the cover of the trunk lid in reverse order.
Backup lamp
Follow the general instructions on lamps and bulbs, refer to page 243.
16-watt bulb, W16W
- Unscrew the bulb holder counterclockwise.

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing internal parts with an arrow indicating a specific part (no text or symbols present)- Pull out the bulb and replace it.
- Mount the bulb holder and the cover of the trunk lid in reverse order.
Changing wheels
Notes
The vehicle equipment does not include a spare tire.
When using run-flat tires* or tire sealants, a tire does not need to be changed immediately in the event of pressure loss due to a flat tire.
The tools for changing wheels are available as accessories from your service center.
Jacking points for the vehicle jack

natural_image
Side view of a car showing two side panels with upward arrows indicating alignment or damage points (no text or symbols present)The jacking points for the vehicle jack are located in the positions shown.
Lug bolt lock\*

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a car trunk and dashboard with a white arrow pointing to a section (no text or symbols visible)The lug bolt lock is in the tool kit or in a storage compartment close to the tool kit.

natural_image
Two 3D mechanical components with arrows indicating assembly or callouts (no text or symbols present)▶ Lug bolt, arrow 1.
Adapter, arrow 2.
Removing
- Attach the adapter to the wheel lug.
- Unscrew the lug bolt.
Remove the adapter after screwing the lug bolt back on.
Vehicle battery
Maintenance
The battery is maintenance-free, i.e., the electrolyte will last for the life of the battery.
Your service center will be glad to advise you on questions regarding the battery.
Battery replacement

Use approved vehicle batteries only.
Only use vehicle batteries that have been approved for your vehicle by the manufacturer; otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged and systems or functions may not be fully available.
After a battery replacement, have the battery registered on the vehicle by your service center to ensure that all comfort functions are fully available.
Charging the battery
In the vehicle, only charge the battery via the terminals, refer to page 250, in the engine compartment with the engine off.
Power failure
After a temporary power loss, some equipment needs to be reinitialized.
Individual settings need to be reprogrammed:
▶ Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory: store the positions again.
Time: update.
Date: update.
Radio station: save again.
▶ Navigation system: wait for the operability of the navigation.
Disposing of old batteries

Have old batteries disposed of by your service center or bring them to a recycling center.
Maintain the battery in an upright position for transport and storage. Secure the battery so that it does not tip over during transport.
Fuses
Notes

Replacing fuses
Never attempt to repair a blown fuse and do not replace a defective fuse with a substitute of another color or amperage rating; this could lead to a circuit overload, ultimately resulting in a fire in the vehicle.
Plastic tweezers and information on the fuse types and locations are stored in the fuse box in the cargo area.
In the glove compartment

text_image
Diagram of car interior showing two labeled arrows pointing to a device panel with numbered annotationsPush the handle to the side, arrow 1, and open the lid, arrow 2.
In the cargo area

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the door frame and internal compartments (no text or symbols visible)Open the cover on the right side trim.
Information on the fuse types and locations is found on a separate sheet.
Breakdown assistance
Hazard warning flashers

natural_image
Top-down view of a car air intake console with warning sign and control buttons (no text or symbols visible)The button is located in the center console.
Emergency Request\*
Requirements
▶ Equipment version with full preparation package mobile phone.
An Emergency Request can be made, even if no mobile phones are paired with the vehicle.
▶ BMW Assist is activated.
The radio ready state is switched on.
The BMW Assist system is logged in to a wireless communications network supported by BMW Assist.
The Assist system is functional.
Only press the SOS button in an emergency.

Emergency Request not guaranteed
For technical reasons, the Emergency Request cannot be guaranteed under unfavorable conditions.
Service contract
▶ After your contract with BMW Assist has expired, the BMW Assist system can be deactivated by the service center without you having to visit a workshop.
After deactivation, an Emergency Request is no longer possible.
▶ Under certain circumstances, the system can be reactivated by a service center after you sign a new contract.
Initiating an Emergency Request

natural_image
Top-down view of a car air conditioner unit panel with control buttons and display (no text or symbols visible)- Press the cover briefly to open it.
- Press the SOS button until the LED in the button lights up.
The LED lights up: an Emergency Request was initiated.
If the situation allows, wait in your vehicle until the voice connection has been established.
The LED flashes if the connection to the BMW Assist Response Center has been established.
After the Emergency Request arrives at the BMW Assist Response Center, the BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you.
Even if you are unable to respond, the BMW Assist Response Center can take further steps to help you under certain circumstances.
For this purpose, data that are used to determine the necessary rescue measures, such as the current position of the vehicle if it can be established, are transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center.
If the LED is flashing but the BMW Assist Response Center cannot be heard on the hands-free system, the hands-free system may be malfunctioning. However, the BMW
Assist Response Center may still be able to hear you.
Initiating an Emergency Request automatically
Under certain conditions, an Emergency Request is automatically initiated immediately after a severe accident. Automatic Collision Notification is not affected by pressing the SOS button.
Warning triangle\*

natural_image
Close-up of a car door panel with white arrows pointing to a black clip (no text or symbols visible)The warning triangle is located under a cover on the left side of the cargo area.
Press against the lower edge of the cover and remove the cover.
First aid kit\*
The first aid kit is located in the insert in the rear seat backrest.
- Pull the release and remove the insert from the front.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with a black plastic buckle and white arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)- Remove the first aid kit.

natural_image
Close-up of a medical device with a black label and cross symbol, mounted on a white stand (no visible text or symbols)When replacing the insert, place both pins into the rail at the bottom and press the insert back in place. Ensure that the rear seat backrest upholstery is not damaged.
Some of the articles have a limited service life.
Check the expiration dates of the contents regularly and replace any items promptly.
Roadside Assistance
Service availability
Roadside Assistance can be reached around the clock in many countries. You can obtain assistance there in the event of a vehicle breakdown.
Roadside Assistance
The Roadside Assistance, refer to page 219 phone number can be viewed on the iDrive or a connection to Roadside Assistance* can be established directly.
Jump starting
Notes
If the battery is discharged, an engine can be started using the battery of another vehicle and two jumper cables. Only use jumper cables with fully insulated clamp handles.
To prevent personal injury or damage to both vehicles, adhere strictly to the following procedure.

Do not touch live parts
To avoid the risk of potentially fatal injury, always avoid all contact with electrical components while the engine is running.
Preparation
- Check whether the battery of the other vehicle has a voltage of 12 volts. This information can be found on the battery.
- Switch off the engine of the assisting vehicle.
- Switch off any electronic systems/power consumers in both vehicles.

Bodywork contact between vehicles
Make sure that there is no contact between the bodywork of the two vehicles; otherwise, there is the danger of short circuits.
Starting aid terminals

Connecting order
Connect the jumper cables in the correct order; otherwise, there is the danger of injury from sparking.

natural_image
Close-up of a car engine bay with a mounted sensor or connector (no visible text or symbols)The so-called starting aid terminal in the engine compartment acts as the battery's positive terminal.

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing a bolt and lever mechanism (no text or symbols)The body ground or a special nut acts as the negative terminal.
Connecting the cables
- Pull off the cap of the BMW starting aid terminal.
- Attach one terminal clamp of the positive jumper cable to the positive terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding starting aid terminal of the vehicle providing assistance.
- Attach the other end of the cable to the positive terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding starting aid terminal of the vehicle to be started.
- Attach one terminal clamp of the negative jumper cable to the negative terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding engine or body ground of the vehicle providing assistance.
- Attach the other end of the cable to the negative terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding engine or body ground of the vehicle to be started.
Starting the engine
Never use spray fluids to start the engine.
- Start the engine of the assisting vehicle and let it run for several minutes at an increased idle speed.
If the vehicle being started has a diesel engine: let the engine of the assisting vehicle run for approx. 10 minutes.
- Start the engine of the vehicle being started in the usual way.
If the first starting attempt is not successful, wait a few minutes before making another
attempt in order to allow the discharged battery to recharge.
- Let both engines run for several minutes.
- Disconnect the jumper cables in the reverse order.
Check the battery and recharge if necessary.
Tow-starting and towing
Manual transmission
Observe before towing your vehicle

The parking brake is blocked
The parking brake cannot be released manually.
When the parking brake is blocked, do not tow with the front axle lifted or the vehicle can be damaged.
Contact your service center.
Gearshift lever in neutral position.
Towing

Follow the towing instructions
Follow all towing instructions; otherwise, vehicle damage or accidents may occur.
Make sure that the ignition is switched on; otherwise, the low beams, tail lamps, turn signals, and windshield wipers may be unavailable.
Do not tow the vehicle with the rear axle tilted, as the front wheels could turn.
When the engine is stopped, there is no power assist. Consequently, more force needs to be applied when braking and steering.
▶ Larger steering wheel movements are required.
Tow truck

text_image
Diagram showing three types of car loading modes: truck, flatbed truck, and sedan, with no text labels.Have your vehicle transported with a tow truck with a so-called lift bar or on a flat bed.

Do not lift the vehicle
Do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting or body and chassis parts; otherwise, damage may result.
Automatic transmission\*: transporting your vehicle
Note
Your vehicle is not permitted to be towed.
Therefore, contact a service center in the event of a breakdown.

Do not have the vehicle towed
Have your vehicle transported on a loading platform only; otherwise, damage may occur.
Tow truck

natural_image
Illustration of three cars with a roof tricycle and two crossed lanes, no text or symbols present
Do not lift the vehicle
Do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting or body and chassis parts; otherwise, damage may result.
Use the tow fitting screwed in at the front for maneuvering the vehicle only.
Towing other vehicles
General information

Light towing vehicle
Your vehicle must not be lighter than the vehicle being towed; otherwise, it will not be possible to control vehicle response.

Attaching the tow bar/tow rope correctly
Attach the tow bar or tow rope to the tow fitting; connecting it to other vehicle parts may cause damage.
▶ Switch on the hazard warning system, depending on local regulations.
▶ If the electrical system has failed, clearly identify the vehicle being towed by placing a sign or a warning triangle in the rear window.
Tow bar
The tow fittings used should be on the same side on both vehicles.
Should it prove impossible to avoid mounting the tow bar at an offset angle, please observe the following:
▶ Maneuvering capability is limited during cornering.
The tow bar will generate lateral forces if it is secured with an offset.
Tow rope
When starting to tow the vehicle, make sure that the tow rope is taut.
To avoid jerking and the associated stresses on the vehicle components when towing, always use nylon ropes or nylon straps.

Attaching the tow rope correctly
Only secure the tow rope on the tow fitting; otherwise, damage can occur when it is secured on other parts of the vehicle.
Tow fitting

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel with a white arrow pointing to a dark rectangular object (no text or symbols visible)The screw-in tow fitting should always be carried in the vehicle. It can be screwed in at the front or rear of the BMW. It is contained in the tool kit under the cargo floor cover.

Tow fitting, information on use
▶ Use only the tow fitting provided with the vehicle and screw it all the way in.
▶ Use the tow fitting for towing on paved roads only.
▶ Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, e.g., do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting.
Otherwise, damage to the tow fitting and the vehicle can occur.
Screw thread

natural_image
Front view of a car showing the grille, dashboard, and front grille (no visible text or symbols)
natural_image
Close-up of a white car's side profile showing front and rear panels with a small black square marker (no text or symbols visible)Push out the cover by pressing on the top edge.
Tow-starting
Automatic transmission\*
Do not tow-start the vehicle.
Due to the automatic transmission, the engine cannot be started by tow-starting.
Have the cause of the starting difficulties remedied.
Manual transmission
If possible, do not tow-start the vehicle but start the engine by jump-starting, refer to page 249. If the vehicle is equipped with a catalytic converter, only tow-start while the engine is cold.
- Switch on the hazard warning system and comply with local regulations.
- Ignition, refer to page 65, on.
- Engage third gear.
- Have the vehicle tow-started with the clutch pressed and slowly release the clutch. After the engine starts, immediately press on the clutch again.
- Stop at a suitable location, remove the tow bar or rope, and switch off the hazard warning system.
- Have the vehicle checked.
Care
Car washes
Notes

Steam jets or high-pressure washers When using steam jets or high-pressure washers, hold them a sufficient distance away and use a maximum temperature of 140 °F/60 °C.
Holding them too close or using excessively high pressures or temperatures can cause damage or preliminary damage that may then lead to long-term damage.
Follow the operating instructions for the high-pressure washer.

Cleaning sensors/cameras with high-pressure washers
When using high-pressure washers, do not spray the exterior sensors and cameras, e.g., Park Distance Control*, for extended periods of time and only from a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm.
Wash your vehicle frequently, particularly in winter.
Intense soiling and road salt can damage the vehicle.
Washing in automatic car washes
Your vehicle can be washed in automatic car washes right from the start.
Give preference to cloth car washes or those that use soft brushes in order to avoid paint damage.
Notes
Note the following:
▶ Make sure that the wheels and tires are not damaged by the transport mechanisms.
▶ Fold in the exterior mirrors; otherwise, they may be damaged, depending on the width of the vehicle.
▶ Deactivate the rain sensor, refer to page 70, to avoid unintentional wiper activation.
Do not treat the convertible top with wax. Ensure that a cycle without wax or a special cycle for convertibles is available.
In some cases, an unintentional alarm can be triggered by the interior motion sensor of the alarm system*. Follow the instructions on avoiding an unintentional alarm, refer to page 43.

Guide rails in car washes
Avoid car washes with guide rails higher than 4 in/10 cm; otherwise, the vehicle body could be damaged.
Before driving into a car wash
The vehicle is able to roll when the following steps are taken:
Manual transmission:
- Shift to neutral.
- Release the parking brake, refer to page 67.
- Switch the engine off.
- Switch on the ignition.
Automatic transmission*:
- Depress the brake pedal.
- Engage transmission position N.
- Release the parking brake, refer to page 67, or deactivate Automatic Hold, refer to page 67.
- Switch the engine off.

Transmission position P with the ignition off
When the ignition is switched off, position P is engaged automatically. When in an automatic car wash, for example, ensure that the ignition is not switched off accidentally.
The vehicle cannot be locked from the outside when in transmission position N.
A signal is sounded when an attempt is made to lock the vehicle.
Transmission position
Transmission position P is engaged automatically:
▶ When the ignition is switched off.
▶ After approx. 15 minutes.
Headlamps
Do not rub dry and do not use abrasive or caustic cleansers.
Soak areas that have been soiled e.g. due to insects, with shampoo and wash off with water.
- Thaw ice with de-icing spray; do not use an ice scraper.
After washing the vehicle
After washing the vehicle, apply the brakes briefly to dry them; otherwise, braking action can be reduced and corrosion of the brake discs can occur.
Vehicle care
Car care products
BMW recommends using cleaning and care products from BMW, since these have been tested and approved.

Car care and cleaning products
Follow the instructions on the container.
When cleaning the interior, open the doors or windows.
Only use products intended for cleaning vehicles.
Cleansers can contain substances that are dangerous and harmful to your health.
Vehicle paint
Regular care contributes to driving safety and value retention.
Environmental influences can act on the vehicle paint. Tailor the frequency and extent of your car care to these influences.
Caring for the convertible top
The appearance and life of the convertible top depend on correct care and operation.
Note the following instructions:
To avoid water stains, mildew spots, and chafe marks, do not fold and stow the convertible top in the convertible top well while the top is wet or frozen.
Remove water stains that may nevertheless have appeared on the headliner using a microfiber cloth and an interior cleaner.
▷ When the vehicle is parked in enclosed areas for lengthy periods, ensure that the area is well ventilated.
Remove bird droppings immediately as their corrosive effect will otherwise attack the convertible top and damage the rubber seals.

Do not use spot remover, paint thinner, solvent, benzine, or similar products to remove spots on the convertible top. These products may destroy the rubber coating. Incorrect care and cleaning may cause the convertible top and its seams to become leaky.
To remove heavy soiling, use a special convertible top cleaner.
Follow the instructions for use from the manufacturer.
Treat the convertible top with an impregnating agent after it has been washed three to five times.
Leather care
Remove dust from the leather often, using a cloth or vacuum cleaner.
Otherwise, particles of dust and road grime chafe in pores and folds, and lead to increased wear and premature degradation of the leather surface.
To guard against discoloration, such as from clothing, provide leather care roughly every two months.
Clean light-colored leather more frequently as dust and dirt are more noticeable.
Use leather care products; otherwise, dirt and grease will gradually break down the protective layer of the leather surface.
Suitable care products are available from the service center.
Upholstery material care
Vacuum regularly with a vacuum cleaner.
If they are very dirty, e.g., beverage stains, use a soft sponge or microfiber cloth with a suitable interior cleaner.
Clean the upholstery down to the seams using large sweeping motions. Avoid rubbing the material vigorously.

Damage from Velcro® fasteners
Open Velcro® fasteners on pants or other articles of clothing can damage the seat covers. Ensure that any Velcro® fasteners are closed.
Caring for special components
Light-alloy wheels
Use wheel cleaner, particularly during the winter months. Do not use aggressive, acidic, strongly alkaline or abrasive cleaners, or steam jets above 140 °F/60 °C ; follow the manufacturer's instructions.
Chrome surfaces\*
Carefully clean components such as the radiator grille or door handles with an ample supply of water, possibly with shampoo added, particularly when they have been exposed to road salt.
Rubber components
Aside from water, treat only with rubber cleansers.
When cleaning rubber seals, do not use any silicon-containing car care products in order to avoid damage or reduced noise damping.
Fine wood parts\*
Clean fine wood facing and fine wood components only with a moist rag. Then dry with a soft cloth.
Plastic components
These include:
▶ Imitation leather surfaces.
▷ Headliner.
▷ Lamp lenses.
▶ Instrument cluster cover.
▶ Matte black spray-coated components.
Clean with a microfiber cloth.
Moisten the cloth lightly and use plastic cleanser, if necessary.
Do not soak the headliner.

Do not use cleansers that contain alcohol or solvents
Do not use cleansers that contain alcohol or solvents, such as lacquer thinners, heavy-duty grease removers, fuel, or such; this could lead to surface damage.
Safety belts
Dirty belt straps impede the reeling action and thus have a negative impact on safety.

Chemical cleaning
Do not clean chemically; this can destroy the webbing.
Use only a mild soapy solution, with the safety belts clipped into their buckles.
Do not allow the reels to retract the safety belts until they are dry.
Floor carpets and floor mats\*

No objects in the area around the pedals
Keep floor mats, carpets, and any other objects out of the area of motion of the pedals; otherwise, the function of the pedals could be impeded while driving
Do not place additional floor mats over existing mats or other objects.
Only use floor mats that have been approved for the vehicle and can be properly fixed in place.
Ensure that the floor mats are securely fastened again after they were removed for cleaning, for example.
Floor mats can be removed from the passenger compartment for cleaning.
If the floor carpets are very dirty, clean with a microfiber cloth and water or a textile cleaner. To prevent matting of the carpet, rub back and forth in the direction of travel only.
Sensors/cameras
To clean sensors and cameras, use a cloth moistened with a small amount of glass cleaner.
Displays/screens
Clean the displays with a microfiber cloth.

Cleaning displays
Do not use chemical or household cleans-
ers.
Keep all fluids and moisture away from the unit.
Otherwise, they could affect or damage surfaces or electrical components.
Avoid pressing too hard when cleaning and do not use abrasive materials; otherwise, damage can result.
Long-term vehicle storage
Your service center can advise you on what to consider when storing the vehicle for longer than three months.

text_image
T M V Z M P D N S M U H G I K E D C R H E D Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 606 521 - 03 11 490Reference
This chapter contains technical data, short commands for the voice activation system, and an index that will quickly take you to the information you need.
Technical data
Dimensions
Width, height

text_image
1 2 31 Vehicle height: 53.8 inches / 1,365 mm
2 Vehicle width without mirrors: 74.6 inches / 1,894 mm
3 Vehicle width with mirrors: 81.9 inches / 2,081 mm
Length, wheel base

natural_image
Side profile line drawing of a sedan car with dimension annotations (no text or symbols on the car itself)1 Wheel base: 112.4 inches / 2,855 mm
2 Length: 192.8 inches / 4,896 mm
Smallest turning circle
Dia.: 38 ft 5 inches/11.7 m
Weights
| 650i | ||
| Approved gross vehicle weight | ||
| Manual transmission | Ibs/kg | 5,401/2,450 |
| Sport automatic transmission | Ibs/kg | 5,401/2,450 |
| Load Ibs/kg 772/350 | ||
| Approved front axle load Ibs/kg 2,679/1,215 | ||
| Approved rear axle load Ibs/kg 2,910/1,320 | ||
| Cargo area capacity | cu ft/l | 10.6/300 |
| With cargo area partition flipped up | cu ft/l | 12.4/350 |
Capacities
| Notes | ||
| Fuel tank US gal/liters approx. 18.5/70 Fuel quality, refer | to page 228 | |
| Windshield and headlamp washer system | US quarts/liters approx. 5.3/5.0 | |
Short commands of the voice activation system\*
General information
Instructions for voice activation system, refer to page 25.
To have the available spoken instructions read out loud: »Voice commands«
Adjusting
Vehicle
| Function Command |
| Open the main menu. >Main menu< |
| Open the options. >Options< |
| Open the settings. >Settings< |
| Info display of the instrument cluster. >Info Display< |
| Settings on the Control Display. >Control display< |
| Open the time and date. >Time and date< |
| Open the language and units. >Language and units< |
| Open the speed limit. >Speed< |
| Open the light. >Lighting< |
| Open the door lock. >Door locks< |
| Open the profiles. >Profiles< |
Equipment*
| Function Command |
| Open the air conditioning settings. »Climate« |
| Open the Head-up Display. »head up display« |
Vehicle information
Owner's Manual
Function Command
Open the Owner's Manual. »Display Owner's Manual«
Open the Quick Reference Guide. »Quick reference«
Open the index. »Owner's Manual«
Open the search by pictures. >Search by pictures
Computer
Function Command
Open the computer. >Onboard info
Open the trip computer. >Trip computer
Vehicle
Function Command
Open the vehicle information. >Vehicle info
Open the vehicle status. >Vehicle status
Navigation\*
General information
Function Command
Navigation menu. »Navigation«
Open the destination entry. »Enter address«
Enter the address. »Enter address«
Open destination guidance. »Guidance«
Start destination guidance. >Start guidance
Terminate destination guidance. >Stop guidance
Open the home address. »Home address«
Open the route criteria.
»Route preference«
Function Command
Open the route. »Route information«
Switch on the spoken instruction. »Switch on voice instructions«
Repeat the spoken instruction. »Repeat voice instructions«
Switch off the spoken instruction. »Switch off voice instructions«
Display the address book. »Address book«
Display the most recent destinations. »Last destinations«
Open the traffic bulletins. >Traffic Info
Special destinations. »Points of interest«
Map
| Function Command | |
| Display the map. >Map< | |
| Map facing north. >Map facing north< | |
| Map facing the direction of travel. >Map in direction of travel< | |
| Perspective map. >Map perspective view< | |
| Automatic scaling of the map. >Map with automatic scaling< | |
| Scale...feet. >Map scale ... feet< | |
| Scale...meters. >Map | scale ... meters< e.g., map scale 100 meters |
| Scale...kilometers. | >Map scale ... kilometers< e.g., map scale 5 kilo-meters |
| Scale...miles. | >Map scale ... miles< e.g., map scale 5 miles |
Split screen settings
| Function Command | |
| Split screen. | >Switch on splitscreen< |
| Switch off the split screen. | >Turn off split screen< |
| Adjust the split screen. | >Split screen content< |
| Split screen, map facing north. | >Split screen map facing north< |
| Split screen, current position. | >Split screen current position< |
| Split screen, facing the direction of travel. >Split screen map in direction of travel | |
| Split screen, perspective. >Split screen perspective | |
| Split screen, expanded intersection zoom. >Splitscreen Exit ramp view | |
| Split screen scale...feet. >Split screen scale ... feet e.g., split screen scale 100 feet | |
| Split screen scale...meters. >Split screen scale ... meters e.g., split screen scale 100 meters | |
| Split screen scale...kilometers. >Split screen scale ... kilometers e.g., split screen scale 5 kilometers | |
| Split screen scale...miles. >Split screen scale ... miles e.g., split screen scale 5 miles | |
| Split screen, highlight the traffic situation. >Split screen, Traffic conditions | |
| Split screen, computer. >Split screen on board info | |
| Split screen, trip computer. >Splitscreen trip computer | |
| Split screen, scale automatically. >Split screen automatic scaling | |
Destination guidance with intermediate destinations
| Function Command |
| Enter a new destination. >Enter address< |
| Trip list. >Stored trips< |
Radio
FM
| Function Command | |
| Open a frequency. | »Frequency ... megahertz« e.g., 93.5 megahertz or frequency 93.5 |
| Open the radio. | »Radio« |
| Open the FM stations. | »F M« |
| Open the manual search. | »Manual« |
Function Command
Select a frequency range. >Select frequency
Open a station. >Select station
AM
Function Command
Open a frequency. »Frequency ... Kilohertz« e.g., frequency 753 or 753 kilohertz
Open the AM stations. >A M
Open the manual search. >Manual
Weather Band
Function Command
Open the Weather Band. >Weather band
Switch on the Weather Band. >Weather band on
Select a Weather Band station. >Select a weather channel
Satellite radio\*
Function Command
Open the satellite radio. >Satellite radio
Switch on the satellite radio. >Satellite radio on
Select a satellite radio channel. >Select
satellite radio e.g., satellite radio channel
2
Stored stations
Function Command
Open the stored stations. »Presets«
Choose a stored station. »Select preset«
Select a stored station. >Preset ...< e.g., stored station 2
CD/Multimedia\*
CD/DVD drive
Function Command
Select a track. >Track ...< e.g., track 5
or
C D track ...< e.g., CD track 5
Play back a CD. >C D on
Select a CD. >Select C D
Select a CD and track. >C D ... track ...< e.g., CD 3 track 5
Open the CD and Multimedia menu. >C D and multimedia
CD and DVD. >C D<
Select a DVD. >D V D ...< e.g. DVD 3
Display the entertainment details on a split screen.
Music collection
Function Command
Search for music, open a menu. »Music search«
Open the current playback. >Current playback
Open the music collection. »Music collection«
Play back the music collection. »Music collection on«
Play back the most frequently played tracks. >Top fifty
External devices
Function Command
Open the external devices. >External devices
Open the Bluetooth devices. »Bluetooth«
AUX at front. »AUX front«
Tone
Function Command
Open the tone settings. > Tone
Telephone\*
Function Command
Dial a phone number. >Dial number
Open the Telephone menu. >Telephone
Display the phone book. »Phonebook«
Redialing. >Redial<
Display received calls. >Received calls
List of messages »Messages«
Open the Bluetooth devices. »Bluetooth«
Office\*
Function Command
Open the Office menu. >Office
Display Office Today. >Current office
Display the contacts. >Contacts
Display the messages. »Messages«
Display the calendar. >Calendar
Display the tasks. >Tasks
Display the reminders. >Reminders
Contacts\*
Function Command
Select a name. >Choose name<
My contacts. »My contacts«
Open the contacts. >Contacts<
New contact. >New contact
BMW ConnectedDrive\*
Function Command
Open BMW ConnectedDrive. >Connected Drive
Open BMW Search. >B M W Online
Everything from A to Z
Index
A
ABS, Antilock Brake System 101
Activated-charcoal filter 126
Active Blind Spot Detection 98
Active seat, front 55
Active seat ventilation, front 55
Active Steering, integral 102
Adaptive brake lights, refer to Brake force display 100
Adaptive drive 102
Adaptive light control 85
Additional telephone 196
Additives, oil 239
Adjustments, seats/head re- straints 53
Airbags 88
Airbags, indicator/warning light 89
Air circulation, refer to Recirculated-air mode 125
Air distribution, manual 123
Air drying, refer to Cooling function 125
Air pressure, tires 229
Air vents, refer to Ventilation 126
Air volume, automatic climate control 124
Alarm system 42
Alarm, unintentional 43
All around the center console 17
All around the interior rearview mirror 18
All around the steering wheel 12
ALL program, automatic climate control 125
All-season tires, refer to Winter tires 233
Alternating-code hand-held transmitter 129
Alternative oil types 239
AM/FM station 166
Announcement, navigation, refer to Spoken instructions 155
Antifreeze, washer fluid 71
Antilock Brake System, ABS 101
Anti-slip control, refer to DSC 101
Appointments 212
Approved engine oils 239
Apps 222
Armrest, refer to Center arm-rest 132
Arrival time 78
Ashtray 129
Assist 218
Assistance, Roadside Assistance 249
Assistance when driving off 101
Audio playback 173
Audio playback, Bluetooth 188
AUTO intensity 124
Automatic car wash 254
Automatic Curb Monitor 59
Automatic deactivation, front passenger airbags 89
Automatic headlamp control 85
Automatic Hold 67
Automatic locking 39
Automatic recirculated-air control 125
Automatic Soft Closing, doors 40
Automatic transmission with Steptronic 72
AUTO program, automatic climate control 124
AUTO program, intensity 124
AUX-IN port 184
Average fuel consumption 77
Average speed 77
Axle loads, weights 261
B
Backrest curvature, refer to Lumbar support 54
Backrest, seats 53
Backrest, width 54
Backup camera 110
Backup lamps, bulb replacement 245
Balance 164
Band-Aids, refer to First aid kit 249
Bar for tow-starting/towing 252
Bass 164
Battery replacement, vehicle battery 247
Battery replacement, vehicle remote control 32
Battery, vehicle 247
Before entering the car wash 254
Belts, safety belts 56
Beverage holder, cu- pholder 133
Bluetooth audio 188
BMW Apps 222
BMW Apps, video play-back 187
BMW Assist 218
BMW EfficientDynamics, refer to Saving fuel 141
BMW homepage 6
BMW Internet page 6
BMW Maintenance System 241
BMW Online 220
Bottle holder, refer to Cupholder 133
Brake assistant 101
Brake discs, breaking in 138
Brake force display 100
Brake lamps, brake force display 100
Brake lamps, bulb replacement 245
Brake lights, adaptive 100
Brake pads, breaking in 138
Braking, notes 139
Breakdown assistance 248, 249
Breaking in 138
Brightness of Control Display 80
Bulb replacement 243
Bulb replacement, front 244
Bulb replacement, rear 245
Bulbs and lamps 243
Button, Start/Stop 65
Bypassing, refer to starting aid 249
C
Calendar 212
California Proposition 65 Warning 7
Camera, backup camera 112
Camera, care 257
Camera, Side View 115
Camera, Top View 114
Can holder, refer to Cu-pholder 133
Car battery 247
Car care products 255
Care, displays 257
Care, vehicle 255
Cargo 140
Cargo area, cargo area partition 47
Cargo area lid 40
Cargo area partition 47
Cargo area, storage compartments 134
Cargo straps, securing cargo 141
Car key, refer to Remote control 32
Carpet, care 256
Car wash 254
Catalytic converter, refer to Hot exhaust system 138
CBS Condition Based Service 241
CD/DVD 173
CDs, storing 180
Cell phone 196
Center armrest 132
Center console 17
Central locking system 35
Centralscreen, refer to Control Display 19
Changes, technical, refer to Safety 7
Changing parts 243
Changing wheels/tires 233
Check Control 82
Children, seating position 62
Children, transporting safely 62
Child restraint fixing sys- tem 62
Child restraint fixing system LATCH 63
Child restraint fixing systems, mounting 62
Child seat, mounting 62
Child seats 62
Chrome parts, care 256
Cigarette lighter 129
Cleaning, displays 257
Climate control 123
Climate control wind-shield 139
Clock 76
Closing/opening from inside 39
Closing/opening via door lock 38
Closing/opening with remote control 36
Combination instrument 14
Combination instrument, electronic displays 16
Combination switch, refer to Turn signals 69
Combination switch, refer to Wiper system 69
Comfort Access 41
COMFORT program, Dynamic Driving Control 105
Computer 76
Concierge service 219
Condensation on windows 124
Condensation under the vehicle 140
Condition Based Service CBS 241
Confirmation signal 37
Contacts 207, 216
Control Display 19
Control Display, settings 79
Controller 19
Control systems, driving stability 101
Convenient closing 37
Convenient opening 36
Convertible, convertible top 45
Convertible mode, automatic climate control 124
Convertible program, automatic climate control 124
Convertible top 45
Convertible top, care 255
Convertible top, cargo area partition 47
Convertible top, emergency operation 47
Convertible top, rollover protection system 91
Convertible top tool 47
Coolant 239
Coolant temperature 75
Cooling function 125
Cooling, maximum 124
Cooling system 239
Corrosion on brake discs 140
Cruise control 106
Cruising range 74
Cupholder 133
Current fuel consumption 75
Current location, storing 148
Customer Relations 221
D
Damage, tires 232
Damping control, dynamic 102
Data, technical 260
Date 76
Daytime running lights 85
Defrosting, refer to Windows, defrosting 124
Destination distance 77
Destination guidance 153
Destination guidance with intermediate destinations 152
Destination input, navigation 146
Digital clock 76
Digital radio 167
Dimensions 260
Dimmable interior rearview mirror 60
Direction indicator, refer to Turn signals 69
Display in front wind-shield 121
Display, instrument cluster 74
Display lighting, refer to Instrument lighting 87
Displays 14
Displays, cleaning 257
Disposal, coolant 240
Disposal, vehicle battery 247
Distance control, refer to PDC 107
Distance to destination 77
Divided screen view, split screen 23
Door lock, refer to Remote control 32
Doors, Automatic Soft Closing 40
Drive-off assistant 101
Drive-off assistant, refer to DSC 101
Driving instructions, breaking in 138
Driving notes, general 138
Driving stability control systems 101
Driving tips 138
DSC Dynamic Stability Control 101
DTC Dynamic Traction Control 101
DVD/CD 173
DVD/CD notes 179
DVD changer 177
DVD settings 176
DVDs, storing 180
DVD, video 175
Dynamic Damping Control 102
Dynamic destination guidance 159
Dynamic Drive 102
Dynamic Driving Control 103
Dynamic Stability Control DSC 101
Dynamic Traction Control DTC 101
E
EfficientDynamics, refer to Saving fuel 141
Electronic displays, instrument cluster 16
Electronic engine oil level check 238
Electronic Stability Program ESP, refer to DSC 101
Emergency detection, remote control 33
Emergency operation, convertible top 47
Emergency release, door lock 39
Emergency release, fuel filler flap 226
Emergency Request 248
Emergency service, refer to Roadside Assistance 249
Emergency start function, engine start 33
Emergency unlocking, trunk lid 41
Energy Control 75
Energy recovery 76
Engine compartment 236
Engine compartment, working in 236
Engine coolant 239
Engine oil 238
Engine oil, adding 238
Engine oil additives 239
Engine oil filler neck 238
Engine oil temperature 75
Engine oil types, alternative 239
Engine oil types, approved 239
Engine start during malfunction 33
Engine start, refer to Starting the engine 66
Engine start, Starting aid 249
Engine stop 66
Engine temperature 75
Entering/exiting vehicle, assistance, steering wheel 61
Equalizer 164
Equipment, interior 128
ESP Electronic Stability Program, refer to DSC 101
Exchanging wheels/tires 233
Exhaust system 138
Exterior mirror, automatic dimming feature, dimmable exterior mirrors 60
Exterior mirrors 59
External devices 184
External start 249
External temperature display 75
External temperature warning 75
Eyes for securing cargo 141
F
Fader 164
Failure message, refer to Check Control 82
False alarm, refer to Unintentional alarm 43
Fan, refer to Air volume 124
Fault displays, refer to Check Control 82
Filler neck for engine oil 238
Fine wood, care 256
First aid kit 249
Fitting for towing, refer to Tow fitting 252
Flat Tire Monitor FTM 95
Flat tire, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 91
Flat tire, warning lamp 93, 95
Flat tire, wheel change 246
Flooding 139
Floor carpet, care 256
Floor mats, care 256
FM/AM station 166
Fold-out position, windshield wipers 71
Foot brake 139
Front airbags 88
Front fog lamps 87
Front lamps 244
Front passenger airbags, automatic deactivation 89
Front passenger airbags, indicator lamp 90
Front seats 53
FTM Flat Tire Monitor 95
Fuel cap 226
Fuel consumption, current 75
Fuel consumption, refer to Average fuel consumption 77
Fuel filler flap 226
Fuel gauge 74
Fuel quality 228
Fuel, tank capacity 262
Fuse 247
G
Garage door opener, refer to Integrated universal remote control 128
Gas station recommendation 155
Gear change, automatic transmission 72
Gear shift indicator 79
General driving notes 138
Glove compartment 132
GPS navigation, refer to Navigation system 146
Gross vehicle weight, approved 261
Gross weight, permissible for trailer towing 261
H
Hand brake, refer to Parking brake 67
Hand-held transmitter, alternating code 129
Hazard warning flashers 248
HD Radio 167
Headlamp control, automatic 85
Headlamp courtesy delay feature 84
Headlamp courtesy delay feature via remote control 37
Headlamp flasher 69
Headlamp glass 244
Headlamps 244
Headlamps, care 255
Headlamp washer system 69
Head restraints 53
Head restraints, front 57
Head-up Display 121
Head-up Display, care 257
Heavy cargo, stowing 141
Height, seats 53
Height, vehicle 260
High-beam Assistant 86
High beams 69
High beams/low beams, refer to High-beam Assistant 86
Hills 140
Hill start assistant, refer to Drive-off assistant 101
Hints 6
Holder for beverages 133
Homepage 6
Hood 236
Horn 12
Hotel function 39
Hot exhaust system 138
House number, entering for navigation 147
Hydroplaning 139
|
Ice warning, refer to External temperature warning 75
Icy roads, refer to External temperature warning 75
Identification marks, tires 231
Identification number, refer to Engine compartment 236
iDrive 19
Ignition key, refer to Remote control 32
Ignition off 65
Ignition on 65
Indication of a flat tire 93, 95
Indicator and warning messages 14
Indicator lamps 14
Individual air distribution 123
Individual settings, refer to Personal Profile 33
Inflation pressure, tires 229
Inflation pressure warning FTM, tires 95
Info display, refer to Computer 76
Information on the navigation data 160
Initialization, Integral Active Steering 103
Initializing, Flat Tire Monitor FTM 95
Initializing, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 92
Instrument cluster 14, 74
Instrument cluster, electronic displays 16
Instrument lighting 87
Integral Active Steering 102
Integrated key 32
Integrated universal remote control 128
Intensity, AUTO program 124
Interactive map 150
Interior equipment 128
Interior lamps 87
Interior lamps via remote control 37
Interior motion sensor 43
Interior rearview mirror 60
Interior rearview mirror, automatic dimming feature 60
Intermediate destinations 152
Internet page 6
Intersection, entering for navigation 147
Interval display, service requirements 81
iPod/iPhone 185
J
Jacking points for the vehicle jack 246
Jack, refer to Vehicle jack 246
Joystick, automatic transmission 72
K
Key/remote control 32
Keyless Go, refer to Comfort Access 41
Key Memory, refer to Personal Profile 33
Kickdown, automatic transmission 72
Knee airbag 88
L
Lamp replacement 243
Lamp replacement, front 244
Lamp replacement, rear 245
Lamps 84
Lamps and bulbs 243
Lane departure warning 97
Lane margin, warning 97
Language on Control Dis- play 80
Lashing eyes, securing cargo 141
LATCH child restraint fixing system 63
Leather, care 255
LEDs, light-emitting diodes 244
Length, vehicle 261
Letters and numbers, entering 24
License plate lamp, bulb replacement 245
Light-alloy wheels, care 256
Light control 85
Light-emitting diodes, LEDs 244
Lighting 84
Lighting via remote control 37
Light switch 84
Load 141
Loading 140
Lock, door 38
Locking/unlocking from inside 39
Locking/unlocking via door lock 38
Locking/unlocking with remote control 36
Locking, automatic 39
Locking, central 35
Locking via trunk lid 41
Low beams 84
Low beams, automatic, refer to High-beam Assistant 86
Lower back support 54
Lug bolt lock 246
Lumbar support 54
M
Maintenance 241
Maintenance requirements 241
Maintenance, service requirements 81
Maintenance System, BMW 241
Malfunction displays, refer to Check Control 82
Manual air distribution 123
Manual air volume 124
Manual brake, refer to Parking brake 67
Manual mode, transmission 73
Manual operation, backup camera 110
Manual operation, door lock 39
Manual operation, exterior mirrors 59
Manual operation, fuel filler flap 226
Manual operation, Park Distance Control PDC 108
Manual operation, Side View 114
Manual operation, Top View 113
Manual transmission 71
Map, destination entry 150
Map in split screen 157
Map view 155
Marking on approved tires 233
Marking, run-flat tires 234
Massage seat, front 55
Master key, refer to Remote control 32
Maximum cooling 124
Maximum speed, winter tires 234
Measure, units of 80
Medical kit 249
Memory for seat, mirrors, steering wheel 58
Menu in instrument cluster 76
Menus, operating, iDrive 19
Menus, refer to iDrive operating concept 20
Message list, traffic bulletins 157
Messages 210
Messages, refer to Check Control 82
Microfilter 126
Minimum tread, tires 232
Mirror 59
Mirror memory 58
Mobile communication devices in the vehicle 139
Mobile phone 196
Modifications, technical, refer to Safety 7
Moisture in headlamp 244
Monitor, refer to Control Display 19
Mounting of child restraint fixing systems 62
MP3 player 184
Multifunction steering wheel, buttons 12
Multimedia 173
Music collection 180
Music search 181
Music, storing 180
N
Navigation 146
Navigation data 160
Neck restraints, front, refer to Head restraints 57
New wheels and tires 233
Night Vision with pedestrian detection 118
NORMAL program, Dynamic Driving Control 105
Notes 213
Nylon rope for tow-starting/towing 252
0
OBD Onboard Diagnostics 241
Obstacle marking, backup camera 111
Odometer 76
Office 207
Oil 238
Oil, adding 238
Oil additives 239
Oil change interval, service requirements 81
Oil filler neck 238
Oil level check 238
Oil types, alternative 239
Oil types, approved 239
Old batteries, disposal 247
Onboard Diagnostics OBD 241
Onboard monitor, refer to Control Display 19
Online, refer to BMW On-line 220
Opening/closing from inside 39
Opening/closing via door lock 38
Opening/closing with remote control 36
Operating concept, iDrive 19
Outside air, refer to Automatic recirculated-air control 125
Overheating of engine, refer to Coolant temperature 75
P
Paint, vehicle 255
Panic mode 37
Parallel parking assistant 115
Park Distance Control PDC 107
Parked-car ventilation 126
Parked vehicle, condensation 140
Parking aid, refer to PDC 107
Parking assistant 115
Parking brake 67
Parking lamps 84
Parking with Auto Hold 67
Passenger side mirror, tilting downward 59
Pathway lines, backup camera 110
PDC Park Distance Control 107
Pedestrian detection, refer to Night Vision 118
People detection, refer to Night Vision 118
Permissible axle load 261
Personal information 207
Personal Profile 33
Phone 196
Pinch protection system, windows 44
Plastic, care 256
Plugin 223
Position, storing 148
Postal code, entering in navigation 146
Power failure 247
Power windows 43
Pressure, tire air pressure 229
Pressure warning FTM, tires 95
Profile, refer to Personal Profile 33
Programmable memory buttons, iDrive 23
Protective function, windows 44
Push-and-turn switch, refer to Controller 19
R
Radiator fluid 239
Radio 166
Radio-operated key, refer to Remote control 32
Radio ready state 65
Rain sensor 70
Random 174
Random playback 174
RDS 167
Reading out loud 214
Rear axle steering 102
Rear lamps 245
Rearview mirror 59
Rear window defroster 125
Recirculated-air mode 125
Recommended tire brands 233
Refueling 226
Remaining range 74
Reminders 213
Remote control/key 32
Remote control, malfunction 38
Remote control, universal 128
Replacement fuse 247
Replacing parts 243
Replacing wheels/tires 233
Reporting safety defects 8
Reserve warning, refer to Range 74
Resetting, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 92
Residual heat, automatic climate control 125
Retaining straps, securing cargo 141
Retreaded tires 233
Roadside Assistance 219
Roadside parking lamps 85
Rollover protection system 91
Roll stabilization, refer to Adaptive Drive 102
Roll stabilization, refer to Dynamic Drive 102
Roof load capacity 261
Rope for tow-starting/towing 252
Route 154
Route criteria, route 153
Route, displaying 154
Routes, avoiding 154
Route section, bypassing 155
RSC Runflat System Component, refer to Run-flat tires 234
Rubber components, care 256
Run-flat tires 234
S
Safe braking 139
Safety 7
Safety belt reminder 56
Safety belts 56
Safety belts, care 256
Safety systems, airbags 88
Satellite radio 168
Saving fuel 141
Scale, changing during navigation 156
Screen, refer to Control Display 19
Screwdriver 243
Screw thread for tow fitting 252
Seat belts, refer to Safety belts 56
Seat heating, front 55
Seating position for children 62
Seat, mirror, and steering wheel memory 58
Seats 53
Seat ventilation, front 55
Selection list in instrument cluster 76
Selector lever, automatic transmission 72
Sensors, care 257
Service and warranty 7
Service requirements, CBS Condition Based Service 241
Service requirements, display 81
Service, Roadside Assistance 249
Settings on Control Display 79
Settings, storing for seat, mirrors, steering wheel 58
Shifting, automatic transmission 72
Shifting, manual transmission 71
Shift paddles on steering wheel 73
Short commands 263
Shoulder support 54
Side airbags 88
Side View 114
Signaling, horn 12
Signals when unlocking 37
Sitting safely 53
Size 260
Ski bag 131
Smallest turning circle 261
Smoker's package 129
Snap-in adapter, mobile phone 205
Snow chains 234
Socket 130
Socket, OBD Onboard Diagnostics 241
Software applications, iPhone 222
Software update 191
Spare fuse 247
Special destinations, navigation 149
Specified engine oil types 239
Speed, average 77
Speed limit, setting 78
Speedometer 14
Split screen 23
Split screen map settings 157
Spoken instructions, navigation 155
SPORT+ program, Dynamic Driving Control 104
Sport automatic transmission 73
SPORT program, Dynamic Driving Control 104
Sport program, transmission 73
Stability control systems 101
Start/Stop button 65
Start function during malfunction 33
Starting aid 249
Starting the engine 66
State/province, selecting for navigation 146
Stations, stored 172
Station, storing 166
Status display, tires 92
Status information, iDrive 22
Status of Owner's Manual 6
Steering, Integral Active Steering 102
Steering wheel, adjusting 60
Steering wheel heating 61
Steering wheel memory 58
Steptronic, automatic transmission 72
Stopping the engine 66
Storage compartments 132
Storage compartments, locations 132
Storage, tires 234
Storing the vehicle 257
Street, entering for navigation 147
Summer tires, tread 232
Supplementary text mes- sage 82
Surround View 110
Suspension settings 103
Switch for Dynamic Driving Control 103
Switch-on times, parked-car ventilation 126
Switch, refer to Cockpit 12
Symbols 6
T
Tachometer 75
Tail and brake lamps 245
Tailgate 40
Tailgate via remote control 37
Tail lamps 245
Tail lamps, bulb replacement 245
Tasks 213
Technical changes, refer to Safety 7
Technical data 260
TeleService 218
Temperature, automatic climate control 124
Temperature display, external temperature 75
Temperature, engine oil 75
Terminal, starting aid 250
Text messages 210
Text message, supplementary 82
Theft alarm system, refer to Alarm system 42
Theft protection, lug bolts 246
Theft protection, refer to Central locking system 35
Thermal camera, refer to Night Vision 118
Thigh support 54
Tilt alarm sensor 43
Tilt, seats 53
Time of arrival 78
Tire damage 232
Tire identification marks 231
Tire inflation pressure 229
Tire inflation pressure monitor, refer to FTM 95
Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 91
Tires, changing 233
Tires, everything on wheels and tires 229
Tires, run-flat tires 234
Tire tread 232
Toll roads, route 154
Tone 164
Tool kit 243
Tools 243
Top View 112
Total vehicle weight 261
Tow fitting 252
Towing 251
Town/city, navigation 146
Tow-starting 251
Tow truck 251
TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 91
Traction control 101
TRACTION program, Dynamic Driving Control 104
Traffic bulletins, navigation 157
Traffic situation/gray card 158
Transmission, automatic 72
Transmission, manual 71
Transporting children safely 62
Tread, tires 232
Treble, tone 164
Trip computer 78
Triple turn signal activation 69
Trip odometer 76
Truck for tow-starting/towing 251
Trunk, cargo area partition 47
Trunk lid 40
Trunk lid, emergency unlocking 41
Trunk lid, hotel function 39
Trunk lid via remote control 37
Turning circle 261
Turning circle lines, backup camera 111
Turn signals, operation 69
Turn signals, rear, bulb replacement 245
U
Unintentional alarm 43
Units of measure 80
Universal remote control 128
Unlock button, automatic transmission 72
Unlocking/locking from inside 39
Unlocking/locking via door lock 38
Unlocking/locking with remote control 36
Updates made after the editorial deadline 6
Updating software 191
Upholstery care 256
USB audio interface 185
USB interface 132
V
Variable steering, Integral Active Steering 102
Vehicle battery 247
Vehicle battery, replacing 247
Vehicle, breaking in 138
Vehicle care 255
Vehicle identification number, refer to Identification number in the engine compartment 236
Vehicle jack 246
Vehicle paint 255
Vehicle storage 257
Vehicle wash 254
Ventilation 126
Ventilation, refer to Parked-car ventilation 126
Version of the navigation data 160
Video playback 175
Video playback, iPhone 187
Video playback, snap-in adapter 187
Voice activation, mobile phone 203
Voice activation, short commands 263
Voice activation system 25
Volume, setting 164
W
Warning lamps 14
Warning messages, refer to Check Control 82
Warning triangle 249
Washer fluid 71
Washer fluid reservoir, capacity 262
Washer nozzles, wind-shield 71
Washer system 69
Washing, vehicle 254
Water on roads 139
Weather Band 168
Weights 261
Welcome lamps 84
Wheel base, vehicle 261
Wheel change 246
Wheels, changing 233
Wheels, everything on wheels and tires 229
Wheels, Flat Tire Monitor FTM 95
Wheels, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 91
Width, vehicle 260
Wind deflector 50
Window defroster, rear 125
Windows, powered 43
Windshield, climate control 139
Windshield washer fluid 71
Windshield washer nozzles 71
Windshield washer system 69
Windshield wiper 69
Windshield wipers, fold-out position 71
Winter storage, care 257
Winter tires, suitable tires 233
Winter tires, tread 232
Wiper blades, replacing 243
Wiper fluid 71
Wiper system 69
Wood, care 256
Word match concept, navigation 24
Wrench 243
X
Xenon headlamps, bulb replacement 244
Y
Your individual vehicle 6

text_image
More about BMW bmwusa.com The Ultimate Driving MachineMore about BMW
bmwusa.com

The Ultimate Driving Machine